Omron Thermostat V022 E3 1 User Manual

NT-series  
Programmable Terminal  
Operation Manual  
Cat. No. V022-E3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OMRON Product References  
All OMRON products are capitalized in this manual. The word “Unit” is also capitalized when it refers to an  
OMRON product, regardless of whether or not it appears in the proper name of the product.  
The abbreviation “Ch,” which appears in some displays and on some OMRON products, often means  
“word” and is abbreviated “Wd” in documentation in this sense.  
The abbreviation “PC” means Programmable Controller and is not used as an abbreviation for anything  
else.  
The abbreviation “Host” means a controller such as an FA computer which controls a PT (programmable  
terminal).  
Visual Aids  
The following headings appear in the left column of the manual to help you locate different types of informa-  
tion.  
Note Indicates information of particular interest for efficient and convenient operation of  
the product.  
1, 2, 3... 1. Indicates lists of one sort or another, such as procedures, checklists, etc.  
OMRON, 1997  
ꢀꢀꢀ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢀꢁ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
PRECAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi  
SECTION 2  
Functions of the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2
SECTION 3  
Hardware Settings and Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
SECTION 4  
System Menu Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65  
SECTION 5  
NT600S Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 6  
Using Host Link/NT Link/C200H Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153  
SECTION 7  
Using the RS-232C Interface Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201  
SECTION 8  
Troubleshooting and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241  
APPENDICES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255  
A. Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
B. Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
C. Handling the RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
D. NT600S Installation Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
E. Method for Making the Cable for Connection to the PC/Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
255  
260  
262  
264  
266  
278  
280  
281  
283  
286  
291  
294  
295  
F
Connecting to an RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit (1:1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
G. Function Restrictions Depending on the Support Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
H. Making the Cable for Connection to the Support Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
I. NT600S Internal Processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
J. Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
K. Option List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
L. PC Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
M. Special Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299  
ꢀꢁ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About this Manual:  
This manual describes the installation and operation of the NT600S Programmable Terminals (PTs) and  
includes the sections described below. Further information is provided in manuals on the Host Interface  
Units and Support Tool. Refer to the list in Section 1 Introduction.  
Please read this manual completely and be sure you understand the information provide before attempting  
to install and operate a Programmable Terminal.  
Section 1 introduces the PTs, describes the terminology used in this manual, and provides examples of  
system configurations for programming and operation.  
Section 2 provides procedures and specifications required to set up a PT system, including hardware  
switch settings and installation.  
Section 3 provides steps required for initial PT operation.  
Section 4 describes functions used to create screens and control display attributes on the PT.  
Included is automatic transfer of data from the host computer via character string and numeral tables.  
Section 5 describes functions used to input data on-screen and transfer it to the host computer via the  
numeral table.  
Section 6 describes basic data transfer and maintenance functions.  
Section 7 describes transferring screens online to and from the host computer.  
Section 8 provides troubleshooting and basic maintenance methods, including battery replacement.  
Appendices of OMRON products used with PTs, PT specifications, and a memory check table are provided  
at the back of the manual.  
ꢁꢀꢀ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manuals:  
The related manuals are indicated below.  
The symbol at the end of the manual number is the revision history symbol.  
Operating the Programmable terminal and Communicating with the Host  
NT600S Programmable Terminal Operation Manual  
V022-E1-  
(this manual)  
This operation manual is the manual for the NT600S itself.  
The NT600S is a unit which integrates a programmable terminal body and host  
interface unit. However, note that a C200H interface unit is required for com-  
munications using the C200H direct communication function. This operation  
manual describes the functions and handling of both the programmable termi-  
nal body and the host interface function.  
Creating and Transferring Screen Data  
NT Series Support Tool Ver.2 Operation Manual  
V028-E1-  
The screens displayed on the NT600S are created with the support tool and  
transferred to the NT600S. This manual describes how to create and transfer  
screen data.  
ꢁꢀꢀꢀ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRECAUTIONS  
ꢀꢂ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
2
Intended Audience  
This manual is intended for the following personnel, who must also have knowl-  
edge of electrical systems (an electrical engineer or the equivalent).  
Personnel in charge of installing FA systems.  
Personnel in charge of designing FA systems.  
Personnel in charge of managing FA systems and facilities.  
General Precautions  
The user must operate the product according to the performance specifications described  
in the operation manuals.  
Before using the product under conditions which are not described in the manual or apply-  
ing the product to nuclear control systems, railroad systems, aviation systems, vehicles,  
combustion systems, medical equipment, amusement machines, safety equipment, and  
other systems, machines, and equipment that may have a serious influence on lives and  
property if used improperly, consult your OMRON representative.  
Make sure that the ratings and performance characteristics of the product are sufficient for  
the systems, machines, and equipment, and be sure to provide the systems, machines,  
and equipment with double safety mechanisms.  
his manual provides information for using the Programmable Terminal. Be sure to read this  
manual before attempting to use the software and keep this manual close at hand for ref-  
erence during operation.  
WARNING It is extremely important that Programmable Terminals and related devices be  
used for the specified purpose and under the specified conditions, especially in  
applications that can directly or indirectly affect human life. You must consult  
with your OMRON representative before applying Programmable Terminals to  
the above mentioned applications.  
WARNING Do not use input functions such as PT touch switches for applications where  
danger to human life or serious damage is possible, or for emergency switch  
applications.  
3
Safety Precautions  
Read these safety precautions carefully and make sure you understand them before using  
the Programmable Terminal so that you can use it safely and correctly.  
Safety Conventions and their Meanings: This operation manual uses the following con-  
ventions and symbols to indicate cautions, warnings, and dangers in order to ensure safe  
use of the PT. The cautions, warnings, and dangers shown here contain important informa-  
tion related to safety. The instructions in these cautions, warnings, and dangers must be  
observed. The conventions used and their meanings are presented below.  
DANGER! Indicates information that, if not heeded, is likely to result in loss of life or seri-  
ous injury.  
WARNING Indicates information that, if not heeded, could possibly result in loss of life or  
serious injury.  
CAUTION Indicates information that, if not heeded, could result in relatively serious or minor  
injury, damage to the product, or faulty operation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Precautions (continued)  
WARNING:  
Do not attempt to take the NT600S apart and do not touch any internal parts  
while the power is being supplied. Doing either of these may result in electri-  
cal shock.  
Switch off the power before replacing the backlight, or you could sustain an  
electric shock.  
Caution:  
Select a proper location referring to Appendix D Installation Environment  
(page 262).  
Always switch OFF the power before assembling equipment or connecting  
cables. Otherwise you could sustain an electric shock or equipment could be  
damaged.  
Fit crimp-style terminals to the power cable. Connecting the wires of the  
cable to the terminal block directly after merely twisting them together could  
cause fire and other hazards.  
The combined lengths of each of the I/O connecting cables must not exceed  
a total of 12 m (or 6 m for C  
H models).  
Do not use input functions such as PT touch switches for applications where  
danger to human life or serious damage is possible, or for emergency switch  
applications.  
On unpacking the NT600S, check its external appearance and confirm that  
there is no damage. Also confirm that there is no abnormal noise on shaking  
the unit lightly. The product may malfunction if it is damaged.  
If the DIP switch settings have been changed when the NT600S is powered,  
reset the power to the NT600S. The changes with the DIP switches become  
effective only after the power supply is reset.  
In order to ensure system safety, be sure to periodically read the PT operat-  
ing status bit at the host during operation to confirm that the PT is always  
operating correctly.  
During work at the panel, take care to ensure that no metal scraps enter the  
unit. Otherwise, the product may malfunction.  
For the connection to the power supply terminal block, twisted wires of 2  
2
mm or greater cross sectional area and M 3.5 size crimp terminals must be  
used. Use crimp terminals to connect the power supply to the power input  
terminals. Recommended crimp terminals for M3.5 are given below. Tighten  
the screws on the terminal block to a torque of 0.8 N·m. Otherwise fire may  
occur.  
After connecting a communication cable, always secure it with the screws, or  
the cable may disconnect, causing operation to fail.  
ꢂꢀ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Precautions (continued)  
The cable’s tensile load is 30 N. Do not subject it to loads greater than this.  
Otherwise a discontinuity may occur, causing operation to fail.  
Do not install the NT600S at sites subject to the following conditions, or the  
product may malfunction:  
Severe temperature variations  
Temperatures or humidities outside the ranges stated in the specifications  
High humidity, condensation  
Splashing chemical agents  
Severe oil splashing  
Corrosive or flammable gases  
Strong vibrations or shocks  
Direct exposure to wind and rain (outdoor sites)  
Strong ultra-violet irradiation  
Take adequate measures to ensure shielding if the NT600S is used at a loca-  
tion subject to any of the following conditions, or the product may malfunc-  
tion:  
Static electricity, or noise from other equipment  
Strong electromagnetic fields  
Nearby power cables  
Potential exposure to radioactivity.  
Carry out grounding correctly in order to prevent misoperation due to noise.  
Confirm system safety before turning the power ON/OFF or resetting. Other-  
wise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Carefully check the operation of all screen data and host programs before  
using them. If incorrect, the system may operate unpredictably. Otherwise  
the system may operate unpredictably.  
Turn off the NT600S power supply when connecting or disconnecting con-  
nectors.  
Check that the current capacity of the equipment to be supplied is within 150  
mA before using the +5V output of pin No.6, or the product may malfunction.  
The current capacity of +5 V output of NT600S is:  
+5 V  
+5 V  
5%, 150 mA max. with ST211(B)-V , and  
5%, 100 mA max. with ST121(B)-V  
.
Press touch switches with a force of no greater than 20 N. Applying higher  
force may cause glass to break, cause injuries, and prevent operation.  
Do not press touch switches carelessly while the backlight is off or while  
nothing is displayed on the screen, or the system may operate unpredictably.  
Only press touch switches after confirming system safety.  
In a system where the user program operates according to the PC cycle  
time, the system operation may not be constant because of cycle time fluc-  
tuations. Consider this point when designing the system.  
ꢂꢀꢀ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Precautions (continued)  
Do not disassemble for repairs or modification, or the product may malfunc-  
tion.  
The disposal of the NT600S (and used backlights) may be regulated by na-  
tional or local authorities. Dispose of them in accordance with the laws and  
regulations of the relevant country and local authority.  
Never short the + and -- terminals of the battery. Do not recharge, take apart,  
deform, or discharge it into open flame. Attempting any of these will lead to  
hazards such as fire, leakage of electrolyte, rupture, etc.  
Depending on how the power is switched ON/OFF, the entire system may  
stop. Follow the correct procedure when switching the power ON/OFF.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Always turn off the power at both the PC and PT before connecting the  
C200H interface cable. Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Switch off the power to the NT600S and PC before disconnecting/connecting  
the cable.  
Set so that there is no overlap between the PT status control area and PT  
status notify area. Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
When transferring the data in units of screens, if there are changes in  
memory table and/or direct connection, transfer such data along with the  
screen data. Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
ꢂꢀꢀꢀ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢂꢀꢁ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 2  
Functions of the NT600S  
NT600S is a new programmable terminal (PT) which incorporates a host interface unit and a RS-232C interface unit  
in a programmable terminal body. It can be easily installed and used.  
This section gives the operation examples and characteristics of the NT600S so that you will understand the ap-  
plications of the NT600S.  
2-1 Role and Operation of NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-1-1 Operations of NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2 Functions of NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2-1 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2-2 Principal Functions of NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2-3 Comparison between NT600S and NT600M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-2-4 Differences Between Existing Models and NT600S-ST121/ST211-EV3 . . . . . . .  
2-2-5 Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-3 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-4 Direct Connection Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-4-1 What is the NT Link (1:N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-4-2 C200H Direct Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-5 Functions of the Allocated Bits and Words . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-6 Communications by RS-232C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2-7 Before Operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
2
3
4
4
6
7
8
9
10  
13  
14  
15  
16  
19  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-1  
2-1  
Role and Operation of NT600S  
NT600S is a programmable terminal used to display and transmit the information  
in an FA site. The following gives a general description of the role and operation of  
the NT600S for those who use a programmable terminal (PT) for the first time.  
Production Line Status  
Monitoring  
The NT600S displays real-time information about the system and equipment  
operating status, etc.  
Production Control  
Product  
1994/1/25  
NT600M  
NT20M  
560 units  
441 units  
Today’s target  
275 units  
63.0 %  
Current Production  
% achieved  
305 units  
54.5 %  
Messages  
The NT600S warns of system or equipment failures and prompts the appropriate  
remedial action.  
Alarm  
Assembly line B  
Positioning pin  
is defective.  
Panel Switch Functions  
Setting touch switches on the NT600S allows workers to use the NT600S as an  
operating panel. Production data input to the NT600S can be transmitted to a PC.  
Electroplating Control  
Transport  
Clamp  
UnClamp  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-1  
2-1-1  
Operations of NT600S  
Displays Screens  
The information to be displayed (screen data) can be created on a computer by  
using support tools and stored in the NT600S. The screen data can be displayed  
on the NT600S in response to the instructions from a PC/Host or touch switch op-  
eration.  
Host  
PC  
The screen data designated by  
instructions from PC/Host or  
touch switch operation is  
displayed.  
The NT600S can be connected to a PC/Host, and receive necessary data from it,  
by using the host link function, the NT link function, the C200H direct communica-  
tion function, or RS-232C.  
Receives Data from a PC/  
Host  
Host link, NT link, C200H direct  
communication, RS-232C  
Host  
PC  
OMRON’s PC  
Sends Data to a PC  
Data input through a touch panel can be sent to a PC.  
PC  
Touch panel  
ON/OFF information,  
numeric data, etc.  
Screen Data  
The screen data to be displayed on the NT600S can be created by a computer by  
using support tools. Connect the NT600S to a PC/AT with an RS-232C cable so  
that the screen data are transferred to the NT600S.  
Create screen data.  
RS-232C  
PC/AT  
(support tools)  
Screen data  
This connection is made only to  
transmit the screen data by using  
NT600S and tools.  
(If C200H direct communication is  
used, the support tool and Host  
can both be connected at the  
same time.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-2  
2-2  
Functions of NT600S  
The NT600S has the following features which are different from those of existing  
NT600M;  
2-2-1  
Features  
Downsized Body  
The NT600S has thin depth (64 mm or less in the panel) in the NT series.  
The width is shorter by 50 mm, maintaining the existing display area.  
The tool connectors are located at the rear of the unit.  
The communication cable connectors are housed in the unit so that they do not  
protrude from the unit.  
The tool connectors and the PC/Host communication connectors are used in  
common.  
Construction Best Suited to the FA Environment  
Easy-to-read screen even in direct sunlight.  
Two types of panel are available: the STN LCD panel with backlight and the am-  
ber EL display panel.  
Its backlight unit and battery can be replaced at the operation site.  
Waterproofed to a standard equivalent to IP65 and NEMA 4.  
640 dots  
POWER  
RUN  
400 dots  
Wide angle of visibility,  
50 to left and 40 to right  
1:1 and 1:N Communications Possible with “NT Link” Method  
Connection in 1:1 and 1:N NT link systems is possible.  
All you have to do is connect to the host; no complicated installation work is nec-  
essary.  
A flash memory is used for the screen data memory, making battery backup un-  
necessary.  
The following communication methods are standard: host link (direct), NT link  
(1:1, 1:N), and RS-232C.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-2  
Availability of the C200H Direct Communication Function  
The C200H direct communication function can be used if the C200H interface unit  
(NT-LB122), which must be purchased separately, is mounted to the NT600S.  
Touch Switch Operation  
The System Menu can be displayed by using the touch switches located in four  
corners of the screen.  
Compatibility with NT600M Existing screen data, user programs, and support tools are compatible.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-2  
2-2-2  
Principal Functions of NT600S  
Functions Related to the Data Display  
Character display  
Characters of various sizes can be displayed. Characters can flash or be highlighted.  
Figure display  
Straight lines, circles, and other graphic figures can be displayed.  
Memory data display  
Contents of the character-string memory table and the numeral memory table can be dis-  
played. The memory table contents can be changed from the PC/Host.  
Bar graph display  
Bar graphs corresponding to the contents of the numeral table can be displayed.  
Lamp display  
Lamps which turn on or flash as controlled by the PC/Host can be displayed.  
Functions Related to the Data Input  
Input by the touch switch  
Data can be input by simply touching the screen.  
Numeric setting function  
The touch keys can be assigned with numeric  
values so that the numeric values can be input  
at the operation site and sent to the PC.  
Other Functions  
Buzzer  
A built-in buzzer can be used.  
Communications with a PC/Host  
The NT600S can be connected to a PC/Host to enable data to be received  
and touch switch information to be sent by using the host link function, NT  
link function, C200H direct communication function, or RS-232C.  
System function  
The system setting and maintenance can be executed by using the Sys-  
tem Menu on the screen.  
Screen data creation  
The screen data can be created by using support tools on the computer  
and stored in the unit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-2  
2-2-3  
Comparison between NT600S and NT600M  
The NT600S is a unitary PT which incorporates a system ROM, screen memory,  
and a host I/F unit (host link, NT link, and RS-232C) as the standard equipment in  
one body.  
The NT600S has the following features which are different from those of existing  
NT600M;  
Function  
Communication  
NT600S-ST121/-ST211-EV  
NT600M-DT122  
Host link/NT link/NT Link (1:1, 1:N)/RS-232C Host I/F units are required.  
incorporated.  
The C200H direct communication function can  
be used if the separately purchased C200H  
interface unit (NT-LB122) is mounted on the  
rear of the NT600S.  
Communication connec- The communication connector (9-pin) for a  
Both the support tool connector (9-pin) and  
tor  
PC/Host is shared with that for a support tool. PC connector (25-pin) are located on the  
When using the C200H direct communication back side.  
function, there are separate connectors for  
communications with the support tool and PC/  
Host.  
Host RUN input terminal/ Not provided  
Alarm output terminal  
Provided  
System keys  
Not provided  
Provided  
Contrast control  
Expanded I/O unit  
Back side (ST121)  
Expanded not possible  
None (ST211)  
None (ST211)  
Front side  
Possible with DN type  
Conforms to IP52F.  
Barely visible  
100/200 VAC  
Waterproof performance NEMA4  
Visibility in direct sunlight Good (ST121)  
Power supply  
24 VDC, more than  
15 W (ST121(B))  
24 VDC, more than  
25 W (ST211(B))  
Allowable momentary  
power interruption time  
Not guaranteed  
5 msec  
System ROM  
Built in (512 KB, not replaceable)  
System ROM compatible with host I/F unit is  
required.  
Resume function  
Provided (if optional battery is mounted)  
Provided  
History retaining function Provided (if optional battery is mounted)  
Screen transfer  
Screen data compatibility (Note 1)  
Provided  
--  
PC ladder compatibility  
Backlight replacement  
Screen data memory  
--  
(ST121 (B))  
Built in (flash memory only)  
Optional (select from EP-ROM, SRAM, and  
EEP-ROM)  
Screen data memory  
capacity  
128 KB  
256 KB max.  
Outside dimensions  
275  
192  
71mm  
325  
198  
105mm  
Note  
1. If a system key function is required on continuous screens or for numerical  
setting or buzzer stop, use a support tool and set the touch switches which  
have the system key function in such screens.  
For details, refer to “System Key Functions” on page 142.  
128 KB of screen data memory capacity is equivalent to 200 screens consist-  
ing mainly of messages, or 70 screens consisting mainly of figures.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-2  
2-2-4  
Differences Between Existing Models and  
NT600S-ST121/ST211-EV3  
Difference between direct connection Ver.4 and Ver.5  
Ver.5 of the direct connection function has the following additional functions in  
comparison with Ver.4.  
“Thumbwheel” type setting possible with the numeral setting function.  
Upper and lower limit check can be set with the numeral setting function.  
The type of operation (alternate, set, reset) can be selected for touch switch in-  
put notification.  
Indirect specification possible for numeral display and character string display  
functions.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-2  
2-2-5  
Displays  
The NT600S can display various kinds of elements such as characters, numeric  
value, lamps, touch switches, and bar graphs on a screen. The screen data dis-  
played on the NT600S are created by using support tools on a computer.  
Touch switches  
Characters  
(character string)  
Stop  
Restart  
Line A  
Machine name  
Production qty.  
:
:
NT600S-ST121  
137 units  
Characters (text)  
Numeric value  
(Numeral table)  
30%  
Bar graph  
0%  
50%  
Stage 2  
100%  
Stage 3  
Lamps  
Stage 1  
Characters (text)  
Characters and marks which do not need to be changed can be written directly to  
the screen.  
Characters (character-string memory table)  
Character-strings stored in the character-string memory table are displayed. The  
display characters can be changed by changing the data stored in the character-  
string memory table.  
Numeric Values (numeral memory tables)  
Numbers stored in the numeral memory table are displayed. The display numbers  
can be changed by changing the data stored in the numeral table. Hexadecimal  
values can also be displayed.  
Lamps  
Lamps indicate the operating status. They are controlled by the PC/Host and can  
be lit (reversed) or made flash (alternates normal with reversed displays).  
Touch Switches  
Touch switches can be set anywhere on the screen. Touchingthe screenat atouch  
switch location can switch the display (stand-alone function or display switch func-  
tion) or notify the PC/Host (notification function). The touch switches can be lit or  
made flash by controlling from the PC/Host in the same way as the lamps.  
Numeric Keys/Thumb wheel These are the touch switches used to input numeric values.  
Bar Graphs  
The bar graph extends and contracts in proportion to the data stored in the numer-  
al memory table. A percentage value can also be displayed simultaneously.  
Marks  
Marks can be designed, created, and handled like characters by the user.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-3  
2-3  
System Configuration  
This section gives the basic configuration of a system which uses an NT600S.  
Refer to the manual for individual device for information on the equipment other  
than the NT600S in the system.  
Reference  
The following four communication methods are supported for communications  
between the NT600S and PC/Host: host link, NT link, RS-232C, and C200H di-  
rect. For the setting procedure, refer to Section 4-6 Setting the Conditions of  
Communications with the PC/Host by Using the Memory Switches (page 83). It  
is impossible to connect a personal computer used to drive the support tool and  
a PC/Host at the same time.  
Typical option devices for the NT600S include the following.  
Backlight (spare for LCD type)  
NT600S-CFL01 (white lamp)  
Reflection-suppressing protective sheet NT600M-KBA04 (5 sheets/pack)  
Battery  
C500-BAT08  
Chemical-resistant cover  
NT600S-KBA01  
(made of silicone rubber)  
NT-LB122  
C200H I/F Unit  
It is also possible to use the NTM support tool Ver.4.2. However, some restric-  
tions apply when the NTM support tool is used. Refer to 4-8-5 Setting the Sup-  
port Tool Mode (page 99) and Appendix G (page 277).  
When using the Host Link/NT Link (1:1) Function  
Use an RS-232C cable for connection to the PC/Host  
OMRON’s PC  
Controls NT600S as required while controlling machines and  
monitoring the production line.  
With host link: C series, CVM1/CV series PC  
The NT600S can be connected to CPU units and  
host link units.  
However, there are some models to which  
connection is not possible (see page 31).  
With NT link:  
CPM1, CQM1, C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, CVM1/CV  
series PCs  
The NT600S can be connected to a CPU unit.  
However, there are some CPU unit models to which  
connection is not possible (see page 43).  
RS-232C cable  
(for host link)  
ool  
NT600S  
Computer (support tool)  
Gives displays of production line  
monitoring and instructions to the  
operation site and notifies the switch  
ON/OFF status and numeric value inputs  
to the PC.  
Connected to NT600S as required and used to transfer the  
NT600S screens and make settings for the NT600S.  
Computer  
: IBM PC/AT or compatible  
Support tool : Type NT-ZA3AT-EV2  
ꢃꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-3  
Reference  
Host link and NT link (1:1) communications can be performed with RS-422A by  
using an RS-232C/RS-422A converter unit (type NT-AL001), but communica-  
tions with RS-485 are not possible. For details on the wiring for RS-422A, refer to  
“Appendix F Connecting to an RS-232C/RS-422A Converter Unit” (page 275 of  
the appendix).  
NT Link (1:N) Systems  
When NT600S is connected to a PC in a 1:N connection, use an RS-232C cable  
and RS-422A/485 cables.  
C200HX/HG/HE  
1) : Total cable length: 500  
2) : For connection to an  
NT600S-ST121(B)-V  
a separate power  
,
supply is required.  
+5V (*2)  
(150mA)  
+5V (*2)  
(150mA)  
cable  
gth: 2 m)  
NT600S  
In addition to applications such as monitoring  
production lines and displaying messages such  
as instructions transmitted to the workplace,  
also notifies the ON/OFF status of switches and  
numerical input to the PC.  
Support tool  
ort tool)  
ecessary to  
T600S  
compatible  
Reference  
When connecting the C200HX/HG/HE and an RS-232C/RS-422 converter unit,  
use a converter unit whose lot number is 15Y5 or later. Converter units of lot num-  
bers previous to 15Y5 cannot be connected.  
ꢃꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-3  
When using the C200H Direct Communication Function  
Use an I/O connecting cable for the connection to the PC, and an RS-232C cable  
for connection to the Host.  
PC made by OMRON  
Controls the NT600S as required for machine control, line  
monitoring, etc.  
C200H direct communication: With C  
C200HX/HG/HE  
H, C200H, C200HS,  
I/O connecting cable  
C200H interface unit  
Type NT-LB122  
ool  
NT600S  
In addition to applications such as  
Personal computer (support tool)  
Connected to the NT600S when necessary to transmit created  
monitoring production lines and displaying screens to the NT600S, and to set NT600S settings.  
messages such as instructions  
transmitted to the workplace, also notifies  
the ON/OFF status of switches and  
numeral input to the PC.  
Personal computer : IBM PC/AT or compatible  
Support tool  
: Type NT-ZA3AT-EV2  
ꢃꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-4  
2-4  
Direct Connection Function  
The communication method applied between the NT600S and the PC is either a  
host link or NT link or C200H or RS232C direct.  
The following deals with the ”direct access” available when a host link, NT link, or  
C200H direct is used, and the communication with a PC.  
Reference  
For the communication through RS-232C, refer to “2-6 Communications by  
RS-232C” (page 19)  
The NT600S can be used to refer to the contents necessary for the display in-  
formation or to allocate the bits and words used for storing the input data to any  
area in the PC. The NT600S can directly write and read such allocated bits and  
words so as to change the display elements, control the operating status, and  
notify the status.  
This function is called the “direct connection function”. The NT600S is designed  
exclusively for use with the direct connection.  
The bits and words allocated by the direct connection function are calledallocated  
bit” and “allocated word” respectively.  
This function allows to read the information to be displayed on the NT600S from  
the memory area in the PC and to write it to the memory table in the NT600S. Also,  
the data input on the NT600S can be written to the PC’s memory area. The  
NT600S screen status can be switched according to the PC’s memory area, and  
the NT600S’s status data can be written to the PC’s memory area.  
NT600S  
PC  
DM area  
Internal relay area  
Auxiliary relay area  
Timer/counter  
Features of the Direct Connection Function  
The bits and words referring to operating status and work instruction information  
and those for storing input data can be freely allocated to almost any part of the  
PC memory. Bits and words in the PC can be referenced from any memory table.  
The NT600S can directly refer to PC bit and word data so that it can be con-  
nected to a PC without changing the PC program which controls currently run-  
ning production line.  
The area to control and notify the NT600S status, including display screens, ON/  
OFF of the backlight/EL display screen, and buzzers can be freely allocated to  
any part of the PC memory.  
The direct connection function allows the NT600S to directly read and write almost  
all bits and words in the PC and to automatically change the NT600S screen dis-  
play. This function can reduce the load on the PC so that the program development  
efficiency of the PC improves.  
ꢃꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-4  
2-4-1  
What is the NT Link (1:N)  
The NT link uses the direct connection function and can execute high-speed com-  
munications with the CPU units (with built-in host link) of the CPM1, CQM1,  
C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, or CVM1/CV series.  
When using the NT600S in an NT link, two communications modes are possible: a  
single NT600S can be connected to one PC (1:1 NT link), or alternatively, up to  
eight NT600S units can be connected to a single PC port (1:N NT link).  
However, the 1:N connection NT link can be used with C200HX/HG/HE only. In  
the following sections, the NT link communication mode in generalwill beindicated  
by the term “NT link”, a 1:1 connection NT link will be indicated by  
“NT link (1:1)”, and a 1:N connection NT link will be indicated by “NT link (1:N)”.  
Features of the NT Link  
The NT link method has the following features.  
It allows high-speed communications with a specific PC.  
Data can be written to the memory area of the PC in bit units.  
This means that different bits of the same word to which a touch switch is allo-  
cated can be used for different applications (for example the allocation of a  
lamp).  
However, since data is written to the DM area in word units, it is not possible to  
use the other bits of words to which touch switches have been allocated for other  
applications in the case of this area.  
Can be used even while the PC is in the run mode. When using a host link, the  
NT600S switches from the run mode to the monitor mode.  
With NT link (1:N), up to eight NT600S units can be connected to asingle PC port  
and used simultaneously.  
When using C200HX/HG/HE, by installing an expansion communication board  
in the option slot of the CPU unit, it is possible to connect up to three NT link (1:N)  
systems (comprising a total of 24 NT600S units). For details on communication  
boards, refer to the “SYSMAC C200HW-COM01 to C200HW-COM06-E Com-  
munication Board OPERATION MANUAL” (W304-E1- ).  
Since there is compatibility between the NT link and host link, the host link direct  
connection data can be used without alteration for the NT600S screen data and  
PC programs.  
Reference  
When communication is conducted in a 1:N NT link, RS-232C/RS-422 converter  
units (NT-AL001) must be used for the connections to the individual PTs.  
Note  
When an NT600S-ST121(B)-EV is connected, a +5 V (150 mA) power supply is  
required for the converter. Do not draw the power supply from the PT.  
ꢃꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-4  
2-4-2  
C200H Direct Communication  
C200H direct communication allows communication with C  
C200HS CPU units by using the “direct connection” function.  
H, C200H, and  
Advantage of C200H Direct Communication  
Since an I/O connecting cable is used for connection to each CPU unit, high-  
speed communication is possible.  
Data can be written to the PC memory area in bit units, This means that the un-  
used bits of words allocated to touch switches can be used for other applications  
(for example, lamp allocations.)  
The C200H direct communication function is compatible with the host link and NT  
link functions. This means that NT600S screen data and PC programs handled  
with the host link and NT link functions can also be used with the C200H direct  
communication function as they are.  
Caution  
In a system where the user program operates according to the PC cycle time, the  
system operation may not be constant because of cycle time fluctuations.  
Consider this point when designing the system.  
ꢃꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-5  
2-5  
Functions of the Allocated Bits and Words  
Elements displayed on the NT600S and the NT600S status can be allocated to the  
bits and words of the PC. By changing the contents of the bits and words, the  
NT600S can be controlled by the PC. It is also possible to send data to the PC by  
pressing the touch switches on the NT600S.  
Controlling the NT600S by a PC  
The following NT600S functions can be controlled by a PC.  
Screens  
: Display of designated screens, confirmation of  
screen numbers, etc.  
Memory tables  
Lamps and touch switches  
System control  
: Writing to a memory table, copying from a  
memory table to another memory table, etc.  
: Display instructions, confirmation of display  
status, setting of input prohibition, etc.  
: Buzzer ON/OFF, ON/OFF of backlight or EL  
display, and other NT600S status  
Notifying from the NT600S to a PC  
Data in the NT600S is sent to a PC when a touch switch is pressed. The following  
types of data are sent to a PC.  
- NT600S status  
- Touch switch status  
- Numeric values input by the numeral keys by using the touch switches  
- Changes in a memory table after copying between memory tables  
Functions of Display Elements  
Lamps  
Allocation destination: Bit  
NT600S  
PC  
Lamp #1 (Bit 000100)  
Lit  
ON (Bit 000100)  
OFF (Bit 000101)  
Unlit  
Lamp #2 (Bit 000101)  
PC’s bit status is displayed by the “Lamp” on the NT600S.  
The lamp comes on (flashes) when the PC’s bit status is ON (1), and goes off  
when it is OFF (0).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-5  
Touch switches  
Allocation destination: Bit  
Touch switch #12  
Bit 009012  
NT600S  
PC  
The lamp comes on (flashes) when the PC’s control bit is ON (1) and goes off  
when it is OFF (0). While the touch switch is pressed, the PC’s notification bit  
turns ON (1), and when it is released, the bit turns OFF (0).  
Numeral memory table  
Allocation destination: Word  
Numeral memory  
table 1 (TIM003)  
PC  
NT600S  
Numeral memory table 150 (0005CH)  
Allocate numeral memory tables to arbitrary words in the PC. If word contents  
change when corresponding numeral memory table is displayed on the screen,  
the value on the screen will also change. Monitoring of words can also be made  
easily.  
Reading and writing are executed so that the contents of allocated words are  
always the same as those of the numeral memory tables.  
Character-string memory table  
Allocation destination: Word  
NT600S  
PC  
(“a”, “b”)  
(“c”, “d”)  
(“e”, “f”)  
Character-string memory table 1  
Allocated word number: 3ch  
First word: DM0100  
Allocate character-string memory tables to arbitrary words in the PC. If word  
contents change when corresponding character-string memory table is dis-  
played on the screen, the value on the screen will also change. Messages canbe  
displayed easily.  
Reading and writing are executed so that the contents of allocated words are  
always the same as those of the character-string memory tables.  
ꢃꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-5  
Functions of the PT Status Control Area (PC to NT600S)  
The “PT status control area” is used to control the NT600S status. When data is  
written to this area in the PC, the NT600S reads the contents and operates accord-  
ing to the contents.  
[Example of the PT status control area application]  
When data is written to the PT status control area, the NT600S will operate as giv-  
en below.  
NT600S  
PC  
area  
Screen switch setting  
Memory table  
Continuou
buzzer so
Copy setting  
PT status control bits  
Co
Functions of the PT Status Notify Area (NT600S to PC)  
The “PT status notify area” is used to notify the changes of the NT600S status.  
When a change is made in the NT600S status, the change is written to this area in  
the PC. By reading the data from the area, the NT600S status can be checked.  
[Example of the PT status notify area application]  
When a change is made in the NT600S status, such change will be notified to the  
PT status notify area as mentioned below.  
NT600S  
PC  
ea  
12345678  
12345678  
Currently display screen  
Content update memory table  
PT status  
Allocated word (numeral table 13)  
rt  
art + 1  
ꢃꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-6  
2-6  
Communications by RS-232C  
Control of the NT600S by a Host is executed by two kinds of commands supported  
by the RS-232C interface which is built into the NT600S.  
Operation commands  
Operation commands are used to control the display and status of the running  
NT600S as well as to notify information.  
Screen display, data writing, data inquiries, etc.  
Notification of the NT600S operation contents to the Host.  
Terminal commands are used to use the NT600S as a display terminal of the Host.  
Terminal commands  
When the NT600S is used as a display terminal, it can display characters and fig-  
ures in accordance with instructions given by the Host, independently of the  
screens registered to the NT600S.  
These commands are also used if unexpected problems occur.  
ꢃꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-7  
2-7  
Before Operating  
Follow the procedure given below to start the system of the NT600S.  
When using Host Link/NT Link/RS-232C  
Host  
PC  
NT600S  
Support tool  
Check and change  
the PC settings.  
Set the DIP switches.  
(page 26)  
For the host link, refer  
to page 31 and the  
manuals for the host  
link unit and peripheral  
tools.  
Install to the  
operation panel.  
(page 27)  
For the NT link (1:1),  
refer to page 43.  
For the NT link (1:N),  
refer to page 47.  
No special setting re-  
quired for C200H di-  
rect communication  
For RS-232C:  
Connect the power  
supply.  
(page 28)  
Refer to page 63  
Refer to the manuals  
supplied with the Host.  
Check and change the  
connection at the Host.  
Connect to the  
NT600S.  
Connect to the PC.  
(page 31)  
Refer to the manuals  
supplied with the Host.  
(Host link: page 31)  
(NT link (1:1): page 43)  
(NT link (1:N): page 47)  
(C200H direct commu-  
nication: page 56)  
(RS-232C: page 63)  
Check the settings  
and communications.  
Install support tools to  
the computer.  
Create the Host  
program.  
Create the PC  
program.  
Refer to Section 6.  
Refer to the manuals  
Create the screens.  
supplied with the Host.  
Transfer the  
screen data.  
(refer to Section 4 and the  
manuals for the support  
tools)  
(page 79)  
Start operation.  
Note  
Before starting actual operation, check the screen data and the program to be run  
at the Host completely for its operation.  
Reference  
For usable support tools, refer to Appendix H Making the Cable for Connection to  
the Support Tool (page 278)  
ꢄꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1-7  
Refer to the following manuals for the equipment and software.  
Manual Title Manual Number  
V028-E1-  
Equipment or Software  
Support tools  
NT-series Support Tool  
Operation Manual  
PCs  
SYSMAC C20H/C28H/C40H/C60H Operation Manual  
(Programming/RS-232C Interface)  
W176-E1-  
SYSMAC C120/C500 User’s Manual (Programming)  
SYSMAC C200H Operation Manual  
W060-E1-  
W130-E1-  
W236-E1-  
W235-E1-  
W302-E1-  
W303-E1-  
W140-E1-  
W226-E1-  
W228-E1-  
W202-E1-  
SYSMAC C200HS Installation Guide  
SYSMAC C200HS Operation Manual  
SYSMAC C200HX/HG/HE Installation Guide  
SYSMAC C200HX/HG/HE Operation Manual  
SYSMAC C1000H/C2000H Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CQM1 Operation Manual  
SYSMAC CQM1-CPM1 Programming Manual  
SYSMAC CV500/CV1000/CV2000 Operation Manual (Ladder)  
* For a PC of the CVM1 series, refer to the SYSMAC  
CV500/CV1000/CV2000 User’s Manual.  
Peripheral tools  
Host link Unit  
SYSMAC C-series and CVM1 PCs SYSMAC Support Software  
Operation Manual:C-series PCs  
W248-E1-  
W249-E1-  
SYSMAC C-series and CVM1 PCs SYSMAC Support Software  
Operation Manual: CVM1 PCs  
SYSMAC C Series Host Link Unit System Manual  
W143-E1-  
W205-E1-  
SYSMAC CVM1/CV Series Host Link Operation Manual  
ꢄꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢄꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 3  
Hardware Settings and Connections  
This section describes the settings of the NT600S, connections to a PC/Host, and other hardware settings.  
3-1 Description of Parts and Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-1-1 Description of Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-1-2 DIP Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-2 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-2-1 Installation to the Operation Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-2-2 Power Supply Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-2-3 Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-3 Connecting to the Support Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4 Connection to a PC by the Host Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4-1 Compatible PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4-2 Connecting the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-4-3 PC Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5 Connection to a PC by the NT Link (1:1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5-1 Compatible PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5-2 Connecting the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-5-3 PC Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-6 Connection to a PC by the NT Link (1:N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-6-1 Compatible PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-6-2 Connecting the NT600S Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-6-3 PC Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-7 Connecting to the PC with C200H Direct Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-7-1 Compatible PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-7-2 Connection Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-8 Host Connections by RS-232C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-8-1 Host Computer Communication Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
3-8-2 Connector Pin Arrangement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
24  
24  
26  
27  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
31  
32  
34  
43  
43  
44  
45  
47  
47  
47  
55  
56  
56  
59  
63  
63  
63  
ꢄꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-1  
3-1  
Description of Parts and Settings  
Before getting to the operation, confirm the names and functions of parts. Also set  
the DIP switches on the NT600S.  
Caution  
On unpacking the NT600S, check its external appearance and confirm that there  
is no damage. Also confirm that there is no abnormal noise on shaking the unit  
lightly. The product may malfunction if it is damaged.  
3-1-1  
Description of Parts  
Front View  
POWER LED  
Lit when the power is supplied.  
POWER  
RUN  
RUN LED  
Display  
Lit when the unit is in  
RUN mode.  
Flashes orange when the  
battery voltage is low.  
An STN LCD screen with a backlight or an  
EL screen. The whole area of the screen is  
a touch panel which works as an input  
device.  
Battery Normal  
Lit in green  
Not lit  
Battery Abnormal  
RUN mode  
Lit in orange  
Lit in red  
Other modes  
Reference  
The NT600S comes in two body colors.  
NT600S-ST121/ST211-EV : beige  
NT600S-ST121B/ST211B-EV : Black  
ꢄꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-1  
Rear View  
DIP switch (SW2)  
Set various system statuses  
with these switches.  
Lid of CFL case  
Contrast control (ST121 only)  
The backlight unit and battery  
mounting holder are installed  
underneath this lid.  
Use a fine flat-blade screwdriver. Turn  
clockwise to increase the brightness.  
Host interface unit connector  
Connect the cable from the host  
interface unit here.  
24VDC  
+
Reset switch (SW1)  
Grounding terminal  
Initializes the NT600S statuses. Note that for the  
image data memory and the memory switch, the  
status before the initialization is retained.  
Grounding terminal  
for exclusive class 3  
grounding to prevent  
malfunction due to  
noise and electric  
shock.  
Host I/F tool connector  
Connect the cable from a  
PC/Host or support tool here.  
Power input terminals  
Connect the power to the  
NT600S at these terminals.  
Reference  
Contrast control is available only for the following models:  
NT600S-ST121-EV  
NT600S-ST121B-EV  
ꢄꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-1  
3-1-2  
DIP Switch Settings  
Set the NT600S operation status with the DIP switches located in the bottom right  
corner on the rear side of the body.  
Switch #  
SW2-1  
Function  
Screen data forced initialize effective/ineffective  
ON  
The NT600S will start in a special RUN mode in which the  
screen data memory is initialized. When it is started, the  
memory initialization menu will be displayed. For the initialization  
procedure, refer to Section 4-4 Initializing Memory (page 72).  
[OFF]  
The NT600S will start in normal RUN mode.  
SW2-2  
SW2-3  
Screen display language mode  
[ON]  
OFF  
Messages are displayed in English.  
Always set at ON.  
Switching to the System Menu enabled/disabled  
ON  
The System Menu cannot be displayed. If an error occurs during  
a start-up, the System Menu will be automatically displayed.  
However, “RUN Mode” cannot be entered.  
[OFF]  
Not used.  
ON  
The System Menu can be displayed.  
SW2-4  
SW2-7  
[OFF]  
This switch must be set to the OFF position.  
SW2-8  
Low battery voltage detection effective/ineffective  
ON  
Low battery voltage is detected.  
[OFF]  
Low battery voltage is not detected.  
[ ] indicates factory setting.  
Reference  
In addition to the DIP switches, set also the “Comm. Method”, “Host Link  
Speed”, “Automatic Reset”, etc. at the memory switches. For these settings, re-  
fer to Section 4-6 “Setting the Conditions of Communications with the PC/Host  
by Using the Memory Switches” (page 83)  
It may be necessary to change the DIP switch settings after installing the  
NT600S in an operation panel. Bear this in mind when deciding the installation  
position.  
Caution  
If the DIP switch settings have been changed when the NT600S is powered, reset  
the power to the NT600S. The changes with the DIP switches become effective  
only after the power supply is reset.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-2  
3-2  
Installation  
Install the NT600S to the operation panel and connect the power to the NT600S as  
described below.  
Caution  
Select a proper location referring to Appendix D Installation Environment (page  
262).  
Always switch OFF the power before assembling equipment or connecting  
cables. Otherwise you could sustain an electric shock or equipment could be  
damaged.  
3-2-1  
Installation to the Operation Panel  
The NT600S can be flush mounted to an operation panel.  
Use the panel fittings and tools included in the product package and follow the pro-  
cedure below.  
Caution  
During work at the panel, take care to ensure that no metal scraps enter the unit.  
Otherwise, the product may malfunction.  
Note  
The thickness of applicable operation panel is 1.6 mm to 4.8 mm.  
All fittings must be tightened uniformly to a torque of 0.5 to 0.6 N m in order to  
ensure water- and dust- resistance. The panel must not be soiled or warped,  
and must be able to support an installation that will remain secure and strong.  
(1) Open a hole, shown below, in the panel and install the NT600S from the front  
side of the panel.  
180.5+0.5 mm  
0 mm  
263.5 +0.5 mm  
0 mm  
(2) Attach the panel fittings at four positions for the upper/lower sides and at two  
positions for the right and left sides, shown below, on the rear side of the  
NT600S.  
Fit the hook of the fitting in the square hole in the body and tighten the screw  
with a Phillips head screwdriver while lightly pulling the fitting.  
ꢄꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-2  
3-2-2  
Power Supply Connection  
Connect a 24 VDC power supply to the power input terminals.  
2
Note  
Use 2 mm or thicker wires to prevent voltage drop. Twist the wires together for  
wiring.  
Make sure you connect the power supply wires with the correct polarity.  
Do not connect AC power to the DC terminals.  
If the power supply voltage does not conform to the stipulated rating, it could  
destroy the terminal or burn internal circuits.  
If complying with EC directives (low voltage directives), observe the following  
points:  
Use a power supply with reinforced insulation to supply power to the PT.  
If using the EL display type, embed the rear part of the PT in a control panel  
so that, after the product has been made ready for installation, the user  
cannot touch any part of it apart from the part where PT operations are per-  
formed (the front panel).  
24 VDC  
+
Breaker  
24 VDC Power Supply  
Reference  
When using an C200H direct communication the NT600S must be started up be-  
fore the host. For details, refer to “Switching the Power ON/OFF When Using  
C200H Direct” (page 62). When not using C200H direct communication, there are  
no restrictions on the order in which power supplies are switched ON and OFF.  
Noise prevention  
The NT600S has a noise preventive feature against the power supply line noise.  
To further reduce noise, connect a noise filter to the power line. This will drasti-  
cally reduce the ground noise.  
Power supply  
In order to comply with EC directives, use a SELV power supply.  
Applicable power supply specifications are as follows.  
Item  
Value  
Power supply voltage  
24 VDC  
Allowable power supply  
voltage fluctuation range  
20.4 VDC to 26.4 VDC  
(24 VDC --15%, +10%)  
Power supply capacity  
ST121(B)-EV 15W over  
ST211(B)-EV 25W over  
Parts used for connection  
2
Caution  
For the connection to the power supply terminal block, twisted wires of 2 mm or  
greater cross sectional area and M 3.5 size crimp terminals must be used.  
Use crimp terminals to connect the power supply to the power input terminals.  
Recommended crimp terminals for M3.5 are given below.  
Tighten the screws on the terminal block to a torque of 0.8 N·m.  
ꢄꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-2  
Caution  
Fit crimp-style terminals to the power cable. Connecting the wires of the cable to  
the terminal block directly after merely twisting them together could cause fire and  
other hazards.  
Fork type  
Round type  
7 mm or less  
7 mm or less  
[Recommended terminals]  
Maker  
Type  
Type  
Applicable Wire  
(stranded wire)  
(fork type) (round type)  
Japan Solderless Terminal MFG  
Fuji Terminal  
2-YS3A 2-3.5  
2-YAS3.5 V2-S3.5  
2Y-3.5 2-3.5  
2
1.04 to 2.63 mm  
Nichifu Terminal  
3-2-3  
Grounding  
The NT600S has a Grounding terminal  
.
Note  
To prevent malfunctions due to excessive noise, and to prevent electric shock,  
carry out class 3 grounding (grounding resistance of 100 or less) using a spe-  
cial-purpose grounding cable (wire of at least 2 mm ).  
2
Grounding wire length should be less than 20 m.  
Note that if grounding wire is used in common with other equipment, or if it is con-  
nected to a beam of a building, for example, the NT600S might be adversely af-  
fected by this grounding.  
Other  
equipment  
Other  
equipment  
Other  
equipment  
NT600S  
NT600S  
NT600S  
Class 3 grounding  
(grounding resistance  
is 100 or less)  
Grounding for individual equipment:Correct  
Grounding common to several pieces of equipment:Incorrect  
Caution  
Carry out class 3 grounding (grounding wire must be less than 100 ) before con-  
necting the power supply. Otherwise there will be a danger of electric shock.  
ꢄꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-3  
3-3  
Connecting to the Support Tool  
Connect the NT600S to a computer with an RS-232C cable to transfer the screen  
data created by using a support tool to the NT600S.  
In other than C200H direct communications, it is impossible to connect a computer  
and the Host that are used to run the support tool at the same time. Connect a  
computer only for transferring the screen data.  
Communication conditions  
Communication conditions are set when a support tool is started.  
Reference  
It is impossible to connect a computer and a PC/Host at the same time to the  
NT600S. Connect a computer only to transfer the screen data.  
To make a connector cable, refer to Appendix H Making the Cable for Connec-  
tion to the Support Tool (page 278).  
ꢅꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
3-4  
Connection to a PC by the Host Link  
Connect the NT600S to an OMRON PC by the host link method.  
Reference  
To connect the NT600S to a PC by the host link method, the NT600S memory  
switch for “Comm. Method” must be set for the host link. For the “Comm. Method”  
setting, refer to “Selecting the Host Communication Method” (page 85).  
3-4-1  
Compatible PCs  
Some models and series of OMRON PCs have the host link function built in.  
Check the model and series of the PC against the type of host link unit before mak-  
ing the connections.  
The compatible PCs are listed in the table below.  
Units with Built-in Host Link Function  
CPU Units Connectable Using an  
Expansion Communication Board  
PC Series  
Connectable to  
Host Link Unit  
CPU Unit  
C20H/C28H/  
C40H/C60H  
C
H
C120  
C200H  
C500 (F)  
C1000H  
C2000 (H)  
C120-LK201-V1  
C200H-LK201  
C200H  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU32-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HE  
C200HG  
C200HG-CPU33-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C series  
C200HX-CPU34-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C200HX  
C500-LK201-V1  
C500-LK203  
C500  
C1000H  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
CQM1-CPU41-E  
CQM1-CPU42-E  
CQM1-CPU43-E  
CQM1-CPU44-E  
CQM1  
CPM1  
CPM1-10CDR-  
CPM1-20CDR-  
CPM1-30CDR-  
ꢅꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
Units with Built-in Host Link Function  
CPU Units Connectable Using an  
Expansion Communication Board  
PC Series  
Connectable to  
Host Link Unit  
CV500-LK201  
CPU Unit  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CV500  
CV series  
CV500-LK201  
CV500-LK201  
CV1000  
CV2000  
(*)  
CVM1-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU11-EV1  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV1  
CVM1 series  
(*)  
CV500-LK201  
CVM1  
* : Connection is not possible to the CPU units of CVM1/CV series PCs that do not have the suffix “-EV ”.  
In the case of these CPU units, make the connection to NT600S by using a host link unit.  
3-4-2  
Connecting the NT600S  
Refer to the illustrations below to select the appropriate cable for the unit connec-  
tors and connect the NT600S to the PC.  
To make a connector cable, refer to Appendix E Method for Making the Cable for  
Connection to the PC/Host (page 264).  
Caution  
After connecting a communication cable, always secure it with the screws.  
Otherwise the cable may disconnect, causing operation to fail.  
The cable’s tensile load is 30 N. Do not subject it to loads greater than this.  
Otherwise a discontinuity may occur, causing operation to fail.  
Connecting to a PC with a 25-pin Connector  
Use a connector cable with a 25-pin connector on one end and a 9-pin connector  
on the other end (NT600S side) to connect the NT600S to a PC with a 25-pin con-  
nector.  
NT600S  
Host link unit/CPU unit  
SYSMAC C series  
PC, CVM1/CV  
series PC  
9-pin connector  
-pin connector  
RS-232C connector cable  
Use the following recommended cables (OMRON);  
Connector  
Specification  
Applicable  
Host Link Unit  
Type  
Cable Length  
C500-LK203  
XW2Z-200S  
2m  
5m  
C500-LK201-V1  
C120-LK201-V1  
C200H-LK201  
CV500-LK201  
25-pin to 9-pin  
XW2Z-500S  
ꢅꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
Connecting to a PC with a 9-pin Connector  
Use a connector cable with a 9-pin connector on both ends to connect the NT600S  
to a PC with a 9-pin connector.  
Host link unit/CPU unit  
NT600S  
SYSMAC C series  
PC, CVM1/CV  
series PC  
9-pin connector  
Host I/F connector  
9-pin connector  
(RS-232C 9-pin type)  
RS-232C connector cable  
Note  
The connector cable wiring for the C series CPU unit (C  
H) is different from that  
for the other PCs. For details, refer to Appendix E Method for Making the Cable for  
Connection to the PC/Host (page 264).  
Connecting the NT600S to a CVM1/CV Series Host Link Unit  
Two types of connectors are provided to CV500-LK201 host link unit. Both of these  
connector types can connect to the NT600S with an RS-232C connector cable.  
Select the connector cable which matches the connector type.  
To connect to communication port 1  
Communications  
port 1  
This is a 25-pin RS-232C connector. Use a connector cable with a 25-pin con-  
nector on one end and a 9-pin connector on the other end (NT600S side).  
(RS-232C)  
To connect to communication port 2  
Communications  
port 2  
I/O port  
selector  
switch  
This is a 9-pin RS-232C/RS-422A connector. Use a connector cable with a 9-pin  
connector on both ends.  
(RS-232C/  
RS-422A)  
RS-232C  
Set the I/O port selector switch to the RS-232C side (upper side) to use this port.  
RS-422A  
Connecting the NT600S to a C Series CQM1 Unit  
CQM1 can connect to the NT600S by the RS-232C method. Use an RS-232C  
9-pin type connector cable.  
To connect to the RS-232C port  
This is a 9-pin RS-232C connector. Use a connector cable with a 9-pinconnector  
on both ends.  
Connecting to C Series C200HX/HG/HE  
When using C series C200HX/HG/HE models, the NT600S can be connected to  
the standard port of the CPU unit, or to ports A and B of the expansion communica-  
tion board. Procure an RS-232C type connection cable for the connection. For  
details on the specifications, installation method, etc., of the communication board  
used for the connection, refer to the “SYSMAC C200HX/HG/HE Installation  
Guide” (W302-E1- ).  
ꢅꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
Connecting to C Series CPM1  
The CPM1 is connected via an RS-232C adapter (type CPM1-CIF01).  
Procure an RS-232C 9-pin type connection cable for the connection.  
When a connector cable of 5 m or longer is required  
When a connector cable of 5 m or longer is required, please make the cable. How-  
ever, note that the maximum transmission distance is 15 m.  
To make a connector cable, refer to Appendix E Method for Making the Cable for  
Connection to the PC/Host (page 264).  
When Long-Distance Transmission is Required  
When transmission over a distance exceeding the RS-232C specification is re-  
quired, it can be achieved by using an RS-232C/RS-422A converter unit (type NT-  
AL001) to switch to RS-422A communication (RS-485 communication cannot be  
used).  
For details, refer to “Appendix F Connecting to an RS-232C/RS-422A converter  
unit” (page 275 of the appendix).  
3-4-3  
PC Switch Settings  
When the NT600S and PC are connected to each other, set the conditions at the  
PC host link unit or the CPU as given in the table below.  
The following is a general description of switch settings.  
Refer to the manual for respective units for the details of the switch settings.  
Item  
Switch Setting  
I/O port  
RS-232C  
Baud rate  
Set the same baud rate as the NT600S. (*1)  
Transfer code  
Parity  
ASCII 7 data bits, 2 stop bits  
Even  
1-to-1/1-to-N  
Instruction level  
Unit #  
1-to-N (*2)  
Level 1, 2, 3  
00  
Note  
*1. Set the host link baud rate at 9600 bps or 19200 bps with the memory switch  
for “host link baud rate”. For the details, refer to “Selecting the Host Link Com-  
munication Speed” (page 86).  
*2. The 1-to-N setting enables BCC (Block Check Character). The 1-to-N con-  
nection cannot be used to connect the NT600S to a host link unit.  
Reference  
When using CVM1/CV series, always set “CPU execution processing (execution  
control 2)” in the PC system settings to “Simultaneous processing”.  
ꢅꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
Connecting to a Host Link Unit  
Two types of host link units are available: a rack-mounting type and a CPU-  
mounted type. The switch settings differ according to the type of host link unit. Set  
the switches according to the unit type.  
C200H rack-mounting type: C200H-LK201(-V1)  
[Setting the front switches]  
Set each switch with a flat blade screwdriver so that the values or symbols in the  
setting value window agree with the following.  
Unit # (SW1, SW2)  
Set these switches to “0”.  
Instruction level, parity, and transfer code (SW4)  
Set this switch to “2”.  
2
5
Baud rate (SW3)  
Set this switch to “5” to select 9600 bps.  
Set this switch to “6” to select 19200 bps.  
[Setting the rear switches]  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP switch)  
Set #3 to “ON”.  
C
se
sw
Ex
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to “0V” (ON).  
0V
C500/C1000H rack-mounting type: C500-LK201-V1  
[Setting the front switches]  
Host  
Local  
Mode control (key switch)  
Set this to “host link”.  
ꢅꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
[Setting the rear switches]  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to “RS-232C”.  
I/O port  
Unit # (DIP SW1)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-5 to “OFF” (“0”).  
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
Synchronization  
Internal  
External  
Synchronization (selector switch)  
Set this to “Internal”.  
Termination  
resistance  
OFF  
ON  
CTS  
0V  
Baud rate (DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
External  
Set these switches to “1010” to select 9600 bps.  
Set these switches to “0010” to select 19200 bps.  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to “0” (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to “1”.  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to “0V” (ON).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
C500/C1000H rack-mounting type: C500-LK203  
[Setting the rear switches]  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to “RS-232C”.  
5V supply  
ON  
Unit #, parity, and transfer code (DIP SW1-1 to SW1-7)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-7 to “OFF” (“0”).  
OFF  
I/O port  
RS-422A  
RS-232C  
Synchronization  
Internal  
External  
Termination  
resistance  
OFF  
Synchronization (selector switch)  
Set this to “Internal”.  
ON  
CTS  
0V  
Baud rate (DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
External  
Set these switches to “1010” to select 9600 bps.  
Set these switches to “0010” to select 19200 bps.  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to “0” (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to “1”.  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (selector switch)  
Set this always to “0V” (ON).  
ꢅꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
CPU-mounted type: C120-LK201-V1  
[Setting the rear switches]  
Unit #, parity, and transfer code (DIP SW1-1 to SW1-5)  
Set SW1-1 to SW1-5 to “OFF” (“0”).  
* Parity is fixed at Even Parity. Transfer code is fixed  
at ASCII 7 data bits and 2 stop bits.  
Baud rate (DIP SW2-1 to SW2-4)  
Set these switches to “1010” to select 9600 bps.  
Set these switches to “0010” to select 19200 bps.  
1-to-1/1-to-N selection (DIP SW2-6)  
Set SW2-6 to “0” (1-to-N).  
Instruction level (DIP SW2-7, SW2-8)  
Set these switches to “1”.  
(Levels 1, 2, and 3 are enabled.)  
CTS selection (DIP SW3-1 and SW3-2)  
Set SW3-1 to “ON” (1) and SW3-2 to “OFF” (0). (Set  
this always to “0V”.)  
Synchronization (DIP SW3-3 to SW3-6)  
Set SW3-3, SW3-5, and SW3-6 to “ON” (1), and  
SW3-4 to “OFF” (0). (Set these to “Internal”.)  
ꢅꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
CVM1/CV series backplate mounted type: CV500-LK201  
[Setting the front switches]  
Set the operating conditions with the PC System Setting functions when a  
CVM1/CV series host link unit is connected to the NT600S. The PC system set-  
tings can be made directly from the peripheral tool (LSS etc.) or the PC system  
setting information created with a peripheral tool can be transferred to the CPU.  
The following describes the switch settings so as to enable the PC system set-  
tings. For the details of the PC system settings, refer to the “SYSMAC CVM1/CV  
Series Support Software Operation Manual (Details)” (W196-E1- ).  
Unit # (SW3 and SW4)  
Set these switches to “0”.  
Communications  
port 1  
(RS-232C)  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to “RS-232C”.  
Communications  
port 2  
(RS-232C/  
RS-422A)  
CTS selection (DIP SW2 and SW3)  
Set SW2 or SW3 to “ON”. (Set this always to “0V”.)  
To use communication port 1, set SW2. To use commu-  
nication port 2, set SW3.  
I/O port  
selector  
switch  
RS-232C  
RS-422A  
PC system setting (DIP SW1)  
Set SW1 to “OFF”.  
Communication is performed in accordance with the  
values set in the PC CPU special I/O unit system  
settings. The initial values in the system settings  
are as follows:  
Baud rate  
Parity  
: 9600 bps  
: Even  
Xon/Xoff control : Not performed  
Communication mode  
: Full duplex  
Stop bit  
Data length  
: 2 bits  
: 7 bits  
ꢅꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
Connecting to a CPU  
C-series C  
H, CVM1/CV-series (-EV  
)
Reference  
Only CVM1/CV series CPU units designated “-EV1” or higher can be connected.  
Set the operating conditions with the PC System Setting functions when a C  
H, CVM1/CV-series host link unit is connected to the NT600S. The PC sys-  
tem settings can be made directly from the peripheral tool (LSS etc.) or the PC  
system setting information created with a peripheral tool can be transferred to  
the CPU.  
The following describes the switch settings so as to enable the PC system set-  
tings. For the details of the PC system settings, refer to the “SYSMAC C  
H
User’s Manual (Programming)” (W176-E1- ) and the “SYSMAC CVM/CV-Se-  
ries Support Software Operation Manual (Details)” (W196-E1- ).  
(1) C-series C  
H
: C20H/C28H/C40H/C60H  
No switch settings are required when connecting to a C-series C  
H CPU.  
(2) CVM1/CV-series  
: CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU11-EV1  
CVM1-CPU11-EV2  
CVM1-CPU21-EV1  
Only CVM1/CV series CPU units designated “-EV1” or higher can be con-  
nected.  
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series CPU, set the switches as given be-  
low.  
[Setting the front switches]  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to “RS-232C”.  
System setting (DIP SW4)  
To effect the existing DIP switch settings, set SW4 to “ON”.  
To effect the existing PC system settings, set SW4 to “OFF”.  
Note: In the case of CPU units manufactured before June  
I/O port  
selector  
switch  
1995 (lot No. “  
65”), the factory settings of the DIP  
RS-232C  
switches do not agree with the factory settings for the  
PC system settings.  
The factory settings for the DIP switches are:  
2400 bps, 1 stop bit, even parity, 7-bits data length.  
The factory settings for the PC system settings are:  
9600 bps, 2 stop bits, even parity, 7-bits data length.  
For CPU units manufactured from July 1995 (lot No.  
RS-422A  
75”) onward, the factory settings for the DIP  
switches are also 9600 bps and 2 stop bits.  
ꢆꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
[Making the PC system settings]  
The possible settings and existing settings which can be set by the PC system set-  
ting are as given below.  
Item  
Baud rate  
Possible Setting  
2400/4800/9600/19200 bps  
1 or 2 stop bits  
Existing Setting  
9600 bps  
Stop bit  
Parity  
2 stop bits  
Even/odd/non-parity  
ASCII 7 bits  
Even parity  
ASCII 7 bits  
Unit #00  
Data length  
Unit #  
00 to 31  
C-series C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, CPM1, CQM1  
Set the operating conditions to the PC system setting area when a C200HS or  
CQM1 CPU is connected to the NT600S. The PC system setting area (data  
memory) can be directly accessed from the peripheral tool (LSS etc.).  
The following describes the switch settings so as to enable the PC system set-  
tings. For the details of the operation with the PC system setting area, refer to the  
“SYSMAC CQM1 Reference Manual” (W228-E1- ).  
[Switch settings] (C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, CQM1)  
CPU unit DIP switch settings  
RS-232C port communication  
condition settings  
Set DIP switch 5 to OFF (right side)  
to enable the PC system settings.  
[Switch settings] (CPM1)  
CPM1  
CPM1  
-CIF01  
Set the mode setting switch to  
the “HOST” (upper) position.  
[PC system setting area settings]  
Write settings to the PC system setting area (data memory) according to the port  
used to connect to the NT600S.  
Channel #  
DM6645  
Writing Value  
0001  
Settings  
Host link mode and conditions are set.  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 9600 bps  
0303  
DM6646  
DM6648  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 19200 bps  
0304  
0000  
Unit No. 0  
ꢆꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-4  
When using port A of C200HX/HG/HE  
Channel #  
DM6555  
Writing Value  
0001  
Settings  
Host link mode  
Set the conditions with the contents of DM.  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 9600 bps  
0303  
DM6556  
DM6558  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 19200 bps  
0304  
0000  
Unit No. 0  
When using port B of C200HX/HG/HE  
Channel #  
DM6550  
Writing Value  
0001  
Settings  
Host link mode  
Set the conditions with the contents of DM.  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 9600 bps  
0303  
DM6551  
DM6553  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 19200 bps  
0304  
0000  
Unit No. 0  
When using CPM1  
Channel #  
Writing Value  
0001  
Settings  
Host link mode  
DM6650  
Set the conditions with the contents of DM.  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 9600 bps  
0303  
DM6651  
DM6653  
Data length: 7 bits, 2 stop bits, even parity,  
baud rate: 19200 bps  
0304  
0000  
Unit No. 0  
ꢆꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-5  
3-5  
Connection to a PC by the NT Link (1:1)  
Connect the NT600S to an OMRON PC by the NT link method.  
Reference  
To connect the NT600S to a PC by the NT link method, the NT600S memory  
switch for “host communication” must be set for the NT link. For the “host commu-  
nication” setting, refer to “Selecting of the Host Communication Method” (page  
85).  
3-5-1  
Compatible PCs  
With OMRON PCs, the unit that has the built-in NT link function varies depending  
on the models and series. For C200HX/HG/HE, the CPU unit to be connected in  
the NT link by adding a communication board is available.  
Check the model and series of the PC against the type of host link unit before mak-  
ing the connections.  
The compatible PCs are listed in the table below.  
CPU Units Connectable  
PC Series  
CPU Unit  
Using an Expansion  
Communication Board  
Connectable to  
CQM1  
CQM1-CPU41-E  
CQM1-CPU42-E  
CQM1-CPU43-E  
CQM1-CPU44-E  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C200HS  
C200HE  
C200HG  
C200HE-CPU32-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C series  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HG-CPU33-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HX-CPU34-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
C200HX  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CV500  
CV series  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1-CPU01-EV  
CVM1-CPU11-EV  
CVM1-CPU11-EV  
CVM1-CPU21-EV  
CVM1 series  
CVM1  
ꢆꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-5  
3-5-2  
Connecting the NT600S  
Refer to the illustrations below to select the appropriate cable for the unit connec-  
tors and connect the NT600S to the PC.  
A host link connector cable can also be used. To make a connector cable, refer to  
Appendix E Method for Making the Cable for Connection to the PC/Host (page  
264).  
Caution  
After connecting a communication cable, always secure it with the screws.  
Otherwise the cable may disconnect, causing operation to fail.  
The cable’s tensile load is 30 N. Do not subject it to loads greater than this.  
Otherwise a discontinuity may occur, causing operation to fail.  
Note  
Before inserting or removing the connectors, make sure that the NT600S and the  
PC are turned OFF.  
Use a connector cable with a 9-pin connector on both ends to connect the NT600S  
to a PC with a 9-pin connector.  
NT600S  
CPU unit  
SYSMAC C series  
PC, CVM1/CV  
series PC  
9-pin connector  
9-pin connector  
RS-232C connector cable  
The following are the recommended cables (manufactured by OMRON).  
Connector Specification  
9pin 9pin  
If a Cable Longer Than 5 m is Required  
Model  
XW2Z-200T  
XW2Z-500T  
Cable Length  
2 m  
5 m  
If a cable longer than 5 m is required, a connector cable will have to be made. Refer  
to Appendix E Method for Making the Cable for Connection to the PC/Host (page  
264).  
The maximum transmission distance is 15 m.  
When Long-Distance Transmission is Required  
When transmission over a distance exceeding the RS-232C specification is re-  
quired, it can be achieved by using an RS-232C/RS-422A converter unit (type NT-  
AL001) to switch to RS-422A communication (RS-485 communication cannot be  
used).  
For details, refer to “Appendix F Connecting to an RS-232C/RS-422 Converter  
Unit” (page 275 of the appendix).  
ꢆꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-5  
3-5-3  
PC Switch Settings  
When the NT600S and PC are connected to each other, set the conditions at the  
PC CPU so as to enable the NT link communications.  
The following is a general description of switch settings.  
C-series C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, CPM1, CQM1  
Set the operating conditions to the PC system setting area when a C200HS or  
CQM1 CPU is connected to the NT600S. The PC system setting area (data  
memory) can be directly accessed from the peripheral tool (LSS etc.).  
The following describes the switch settings so as to enable the PC system set-  
tings. For the details of the operation with the PC system setting area, refer to the  
“SYSMAC CQM1 Reference Manual” (W228-E1- ).  
[Switch setting] (C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, CQM1)  
CPU unit DIP switch settings  
RS-232C port communication  
condition settings  
Set DIP switch 5 to OFF (right side)  
to enable the PC system settings.  
[PC system setting area settings] (C200HX/HG/HE, CPM1, CQM1)  
Write values to the PC system setting area (data memory) in accordance with the  
CPU unit and port used for connection to the NT600S.  
PC Side  
Channel #  
DM6645  
Writing Value  
Settings  
RS-232 port of  
C200HX/HG/HE,  
CQM1  
Port A of C200HX/  
HG/HE  
DM6555  
4000  
Use NT link (1:1)  
Port B of C200HX/  
HG/HE  
DM6550  
DM6650  
CPM1  
ꢆꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-5  
CVM1/CV-series (-EV  
)
When connecting to a CVM1/CV-series (-EV ) CPU, set the switches as given  
below.  
I/O port  
selector  
switch  
RS-232C  
I/O port selection (selector switch)  
Set this to “RS-232C”.  
RS-422A  
NT link setting (DIP SW3)  
Set SW3 to “ON”.  
Set SW3 to “ON” (right).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
3-6  
Connection to a PC by the NT Link (1:N)  
Connect the NT600S to an OMRON PC by the NT link method.  
To connect the NT600S to a PC by the NT link (1:N) method, the communication  
conditions must be set with the memory switches.  
Setting NT link (1:N)  
(Refer to “Selecting the Host Communication Method” (page 85))  
Setting the unit No. of the connected NT20S  
(Selecting Unit Numbers (page 87))  
3-6-1  
Compatible PCs  
The only OMRON PCs that can be connected in an NT link (1:N) are the C series  
C200HX/HG/HE models. When making a connection, check the series and model  
of the PC to which the connection is being made, and the type of host link unit that  
is installed.  
The following is a list of the PCs that can be connected to the NT600S via a host  
link (1:N).  
CPU Units Connectable  
CPU Unit with Built-in  
PC Series  
Using an Expansion  
Connectable to  
C200HE  
NT Link Function  
Communication Board  
C200HE-CPU32-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HG-CPU33-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HG  
C200HX  
C series  
C200HX-CPU34-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
3-6-2  
Connecting the NT600S Units  
Referring to the illustrations below and using a cable appropriate for the CPU unit’s  
connector, connect the NT600S units and the PC using RS-232C/RS-422A con-  
verter units (type NT-AL001).  
An NT link connection cable can be used as the RS-232C cable. For details on  
making a connection cable, refer to Appendix E “Method for Making the Cable for  
Connection to the Host” (page 264).  
Caution  
After connecting the communication cable, be sure to lock the connectors with  
the screws.  
Otherwise the cable may disconnect, causing operation to fail.  
The cable’s tensile load is 30 N. Do not subject it to loads greater than this.  
Otherwise a discontinuity may occur, causing operation to fail.  
ꢆꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
Connection Diagram  
As shown in the figure below, connect multiple NT600S units to one PC. In an NT  
link (1:N), up to eight NT600S units can be connected to one PC port.  
able length: 500 m  
nnection to an  
S-ST121(B)-EV3, a  
e power supply is  
d.  
R
(m
d
R
+5V (*2)  
(150mA)  
+5V (*2)  
(150mA)  
RS-2
unit,
(Not
made
(Up to eight NT600S units can be connected.)  
[Maximum Number of NT600Ss Connectable to One Port]  
The maximum number of NT600S units that can be connected to the RS-232C  
port (built in the CPU) and the A and B ports in the communication board is indi-  
cated below.  
C200HE  
:Up to 4 NT600S units per port (unit Nos. 0 to 3)  
:Up to 8 NT600S units per port (unit Nos. 0 to 7)  
C200HG, C200HX  
Reference  
When NT600S-ST121(B)-EV3 is connected in the configuration shown in the  
figure above, a separate +5 V (150 mA) power supply is required to drive the  
RS-232C/RS-422 converter units (NT-AL001). When NT600S-ST211(B)-EV3  
is connected, the power to the converter unit can be supplied from the PT itself,  
so no separate power supply is required.  
When connecting the C200HX/HG/HE and an RS-232C/RS-422A converter  
unit, use a converter unit whose lot number is 15Y5 or later. Converter units of  
lot numbers previous to 15Y5 cannot be connected.  
ꢆꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
Converter Unit Connector Specifications  
The terminal block specifications of the RS-232C/RS-422A converter unit are indi-  
cated here. For details on the method for making the connection cable, refer to  
“Making the Cable” (page 272).  
NT-AL001 RS-422A terminal block specifications  
Connected terminal block RS-422A terminal block (M3 screws)  
Electrical characteristics Conform to EIA RS-422A  
Signal direction  
Signal input and output is relative to the NT-AL001.  
Terminal  
Block Pin  
No.  
Signal Direction  
Signal Name  
Abbreviation  
CSA  
Input  
Output  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Request to send (  
Request to send (  
)
)
CSB  
Receive data (  
Receive data (  
)
)
RDA  
RDB  
Send data (  
Send data (  
Signal ground  
)
SDA  
)
SDB  
SG (GND)  
Functional ground  
* The CSA and CSB signals are for special applications.  
Converter Unit Terminal Screws and Crimp Terminals  
The terminal screws are M3 screws. Use M3 size crimp terminals. Tighten the ter-  
minal screws with a torque of 0.5 N·m.  
Note  
During wiring, crimp terminals must be used for connections.  
[Recommended crimp terminals]  
Fork Type  
Round Type  
6.2mm or less  
6.2mm or less  
Maker  
Type  
Recommended Wire Size  
Japan Solderless  
Terminal MFG  
1.25-N3A (Fork)  
Y1.25-3.5L (Fork)  
2
AWG22 to 18 (0.3 to 0.75mm )  
Molex  
ꢆꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
Wiring Method  
For the connections between the PC and NT600S units, wire as shownbelow. The  
wiring method differs depending on the cables used for connection.  
RS-422A connection  
RS
(ma
or d
con
cab
[RS-232C Cable Wiring] (NT600S-ST211(B)-EV  
)
PT, PC  
NT-AL001  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Connector  
cover  
Connector  
cover  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
SG  
2
3
4
5
6
9
2
3
4
5
6
9
SD  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
SG  
: Only connected at PC  
Shielding  
wire  
The pin numbers are the numbers at the NT600S.  
For the pin numbers at the PC, refer to the manual for the PC used.  
ꢇꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
[RS-232C Cable Wiring] (NT600S-ST121(B)-EV  
)
PT, PC  
NT-AL001  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Connector  
cover  
Connector  
cover  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
SG  
2
3
4
5
6
9
2
3
4
5
6
9
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
SG  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
+5V  
(150mA)  
: Only connected at PC  
Shielding  
wire  
The pin numbers are the numbers at the NT600S.  
For the pin numbers at the PC, refer to the manual for the PC used.  
[RS-422A Cable Wiring ( )]  
RS-232C connection at the PC side  
NT-AL001  
NT-AL001  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
1
1
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
3
4
5
6
3
4
5
6
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
Shielding  
wire  
RS-422A connection at the PC side  
PC  
NT-AL001  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Connector  
cover  
Functional  
ground  
1
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
SDA (--)  
3
4
5
6
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
RS-422A  
interface  
SDB (+)  
RDA (--)  
RDB (+)  
Shielding  
wire  
[RS-422A Cable Wiring ( )]  
NT-AL001  
NT-AL001  
Pin No.  
1
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
1
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
3
4
5
6
3
4
5
6
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
Shielding  
wire  
ꢇꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
RS-485 connection  
RS-23
(max.
direct
RS-48
le  
2 m)  
00m  
[RS-232C Cable Wiring]  
Same as for an RS-422A connection. Refer to “RS-422A connection” (page 50).  
[RS-485 Cable Wiring]  
NT-AL001 to NT-AL001  
NT-AL001  
NT-AL001  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Functional  
ground  
Functional  
ground  
1
1
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
3
4
5
6
3
4
5
6
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
Shielding  
wire  
PC to NT-AL001  
PC  
NT-AL001  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Abbrev.  
Connector  
cover  
Connector  
cover  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
1
RS-422A  
interface  
SDA (--)  
SDB (+)  
3
4
SDB  
SDA  
Shielding  
wire  
ꢇꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
NT-AL001 Converter Unit DIP Switch Settings  
The DIP switch settings to be made at an NT-AL001 used in the wiring depend on  
whether it is connected part way along the RS-422A/485 cable or is at the end of  
the RS-422A/485 cable.  
RS-422A connection, RS-232C at the PC side  
(Termination)  
ngth: 500 m  
RS-485 connection, RS-232C at the PC side  
(Termination)  
(Termination)  
gth: 500m  
ꢇꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
RS-422A connection, RS-422A at the PC side  
(Termination)  
(Termination)  
th: 500 m  
RS-485 connection, RS-485 at the PC side  
(Termination)  
(Termination)  
: 500 m  
ꢇꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-6  
3-6-3  
PC Switch Settings  
When the PC and NT600S units have been connected, set the switches at the  
CPU module at the PC side in order to enable communication using the NT link  
method.  
C series, C200HX/HG/HE  
Write the communication conditions directly to the “PC system area” (data  
memory) using a peripheral tool (e.g., SYSMAC support software). For details on  
the operation for setting the “PC system area”, refer to the “SYSMAC C200HX/  
HG/HE Installation Guide” (W302-E1- ).  
[PC system setting area setting]  
With C200HX/HG/HE, the setting area differs according to the standard port of the  
CPU module used for the connection or the port of the expansion communication  
board.  
Port  
Channel #  
DM6645  
Writing Value  
Settings  
C200HX/HG/HE  
RS-232C port  
Use NT link (1:N)  
= highest unit No.  
in the maximum  
number of connect-  
able PTs (1 to 7). (*)  
C200HX/HG/HE  
port A  
DM6555  
DM6550  
5
00  
C200HX/HG/HE  
port B  
(*) When using C200HE, the PT unit No. range is 1 to 3.  
ꢇꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
3-7  
Connecting to the PC with C200H Direct Communication  
This is the procedure for connecting the NT600S to an OMRON PC by using the  
C200H direct communication method.  
3-7-1  
Compatible PCs  
Some models and series of OMRON PCs have the direct communication function  
built in. Check the model and series of the PC to which the connection is to be  
made, and the type of CPU unit installed before making the connections.  
The PCs that can be connected to the NT600S by using C200H direct communica-  
tion are listed below.  
CPU Unit  
C20H/C28H/C40H/C60H  
C200H-CPU01-E  
C200H-CPU03-E  
C200H-CPU11-E  
C200H-CPU21-E  
C200H-CPU23-E  
C200H-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU01-E  
C200HS-CPU03-E  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C200HE-CPU11-E  
C200HE-CPU32-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HG-CPU33-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HX-CPU34-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
Model Name  
H
C
C200H  
C200HS  
C200HE  
C200HG  
C200HX  
Caution  
In a system where the user program operates according to the PC cycle time, the  
system operation may not be constant because of cycle time fluctuations.  
Consider this point when designing the system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
C200H Interface Unit Part Names and Functions  
This section gives the names and functions of the parts of the C200H interface unit  
for your information before you mount the C200H interface unit to the NT600S.  
C200H interface unit: NT-LB122  
Front of C200H interface unit  
Switch cover  
Covers the rotary and DIP switches used to  
set the basic operations of the C200H  
interface unit.  
Host interface connector  
The cable from the PC is connected here.  
Reference  
When the C200H interface unit is mounted or removed from the NT600S, the  
memory switches are initialized.  
Mounting and Setting the C200H Interface Unit  
This section explains how to mount the C200H interface unit on the NT600S, and  
how to set the DIP switches.  
Mounting the Unit to the NT600S  
Mount the C200H interface unit by inserting it fully home so that there is no clear-  
ance between it and the NT600S, then tightening the screws securely.  
If it is difficult to make the connection, shift the position of the unit and try inserting it  
again.  
Note  
Be sure to switch off the power to the NT600S before mounting or removing the  
unit.  
ꢇꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
Removing the unit  
As shown in the figure below, grasp the unit by the cutouts at either side, then pull it  
out while keeping a firm grip.  
C200H Interface Unit Switch Settings  
Set all the DIP switches (SW1, SW2) of the C200H interface unit to “OFF” (re-  
served for system use) and set the unit number to 0 with the rotary switch (SW3).  
It is necessary to set a machine number for NT600S since it operates as a high-  
level function I/O unit of C200H. Make sure that the machine number to be allo-  
cated is unique.  
Switch cover  
SW1  
SW2  
SW3  
The DIP switches are located under the switch cover  
on the front of the interface unit.  
When using C200H/HS, or C200HX/HG/HE, the words corresponding to the  
channel numbers indicated below are occupied for each unit number set. Howev-  
er, since the NT600S uses the allocated bits and words for processing, it does not  
use these words.  
These words are used as internal auxiliary relays.  
Unit No.  
Channel #  
100 to 109  
110 to 119  
120 to 129  
130 to 139  
140 to 149  
150 to 159  
160 to 169  
170 to 179  
180 to 189  
190 to 199  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 (*)  
9 (*)  
(*) Cannot be set with C  
H.  
ꢇꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
Reference  
If unit numbers 8 and 9 are set with a C  
When an NT600S is connected to a C  
H, a “special I/O unit error” occurs.  
H, I/O expansion equipment cannot  
be connected. In other words, it will not be possible to connect other special I/O  
units, and therefore whatever unit numbers are specified there will be no du-  
plication of numbers.  
3-7-2  
Connection Method  
Using the I/O connecting cable, connect the C200H interface unit mounted to the  
NT600S and the PC unit.  
Caution  
Always turn off the power at both the PC and PT before connecting the C200H  
interface cable.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Switch off the power to the NT600S and PC before disconnecting/connecting  
the cable.  
[I/O connecting cable]  
Use one of the following models of I/O connecting cable.  
Model  
C200H-CN311  
Cable length (L)  
30cm  
70cm  
NT20M-CNP711  
C200H-CN711  
NT20M-CNP221  
C200H-CN221  
For connecting C200H/  
HS/HE/HG/HX  
2m  
5m  
NT20M-CNP521  
C200H-CN521  
NT20M-CNP131  
C200H-CN131  
10m  
C20H-CN312  
30cm  
70cm  
NT20M-CNP712  
C20H-CN712  
For connecting C  
H
NT20M-CNP222  
C20H-CN222  
2m  
In the case of NT20M-CNP  
side is a compact one.  
models, the connector at the C200H interface  
Caution  
The combined lengths of each of the I/O connecting cables must not exceed a  
total of 12 m (or 6 m for C H models).  
The cable’s tensile load is 30 N. Do not subject it to loads greater than this.  
Otherwise a discontinuity may occur, causing operation to fail.  
Note  
If the I/O connecting cable is passed through a hole, this hole must have a diam-  
eter of at least 53 mm . If the top cover is removed the cable can be passed  
through a minimum hole size of 33 mm . Replace the cover before mounting  
the unit.  
If a C200H-CN  
or C20H-CN  
is used as the I/O connection cable,  
the connector will project beyond the bottom face of the NT600S.  
ꢇꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
Connection to a C200H/C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE  
Make the connection to the CPU unit or I/O extension unit with an I/O connecting  
cable. The following restrictions apply to this connection:  
Only one CPU unit, and one I/O extension unit, can be connected. Connection to  
two I/O extension units is not possible.  
Connection to remote I/O slave units is not possible.  
The C200H interface unit only has one interface connector. It is not possible to  
connect a C200H interface unit between a CPU unit and an I/O extension unit. It  
must be connected as the final element in the system.  
CPU unit  
I/O connection cable  
(C200H-CN 1)  
I/O extension unit  
Max. 1 unit  
(Rear face of NT600S)  
C200H I/F unit  
I/O extension cable  
(NT20M-CNP  
C200H-CN  
1/  
1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
Connection to a C  
H
Make the connection to the CPU unit with an I/O connecting cable. The following  
restrictions apply to this connection.  
Only one CPU unit can be connected.  
Up to two I/O units can be connected to one CPU unit. However, it is not possible  
to connect an I/O extension unit.  
It is not possible to connect a C  
H I/O unit after a C200H interface unit. The  
C200H interface unit must be the final element in the system.  
CPU unit  
I/O connection cable  
(C20H-CN 2)  
I/O unit  
I/O unit  
I/O connection cable  
(C20H-CN 2)  
Max. 2 units  
(Rear face of NT600S)  
C200H I/F unit  
I/O extension cable  
(C20M-CNP  
C20H-CN  
2/  
2)  
Note  
When making a connection to a C  
H, a noise filter must be installed.  
1. Insert the noise filter in the power supply line of the C  
H.  
2. Make the distance between the noise filter and the C  
H as short as pos-  
sible, and separate it from the power supply line.  
3. Connect the case of the noise filter to the FG face.  
4. For the noise filter, use a ZGB2202-01U made by TDK or equivalent.  
Noise filter  
1
2
4
3
+
--  
+24V  
IN  
OUT  
24V  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-7  
Switching the power ON/OFF when using C200H direct communication  
The C200H interface unit has the function of a C200H I/O extension unit. The pow-  
er should be switched ON/OFF in the way explained below.  
Caution  
Depending on how the power is switched ON/OFF, the entire system may stop.  
Follow the correct procedure when switching the power ON/OFF.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Power ON  
Switch the power ON in the following sequence.  
Switch the NT600S power ON . . . . . . “Connecting to Host” will be displayed on  
the NT600S screen.  
Switch the PC power ON  
. . . . . . After “Connecting to Host” has been dis-  
played on the NT600S screen for approx-  
imately 1 second, normal operation  
starts.  
Reference  
If the power supply to the PC/Host is switched on first, the CPU of the PC/Host is  
subject to a system reset, disabling PC/Host operation. If the power to the  
NT600S is then switched ON, “Connecting to Host” will be displayed on the  
NT600S screen for approximately one second and then normal operation will  
commence.  
If the I/O connecting cable is disconnected during system operation, an I/O bus  
error will occur at the PC/Host side and operation will stop. If this happens, con-  
nect the I/O connecting cable and clear the error.  
Power OFF  
Switch the power OFF in the following way.  
Switch the PLC and NT600S . . . . . . The next time the power is switched ON,  
power supplies OFF simulta-  
neously  
the NT600S will display the screen that  
was being displayed when it was  
switched OFF.  
Reference  
If the power supply to the NT600S is switched OFF first, the CPU of the PC/Host  
is subject to a system reset, disabling PC operation.  
The system must be stopped before replacing a defective NT600S or C200H  
interface unit. If only the power to the NT600S is switched OFF, the system will  
stop suddenly, causing accidents or damage to machinery.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-8  
3-8  
Host Connections by RS-232C  
Connect NT600S with an RS-232C Interface Unit installed to the host computer  
with an RS-232C cable.  
RS-232C connection allows a single NT600S to be connected to the host.  
A computer or other control device with a built-in RS-232C interface is a suitable  
host for connection to the NT600S.  
Reference  
To connect the NT600S to a Host by the RS-232C method, the NT600S memory  
switch for “Comm. Method” must be set to “RS-232C” and the communication set-  
tings must be set for RS-232C communications. For the “Comm. Method” setting,  
refer to “Selecting the Host Communication Method” (page 85), and for the  
memory switch setting for RS-232C communication, refer to “Setting the  
RS-232C Communication Conditions” (page 89).  
3-8-1  
Host Computer Communication Settings  
Set the host communication conditions according to the following table.  
Item  
Baud rate  
Setting  
Set to the same baud rate as the NT600S: 2400, 4800, 9600,  
19200  
Data bits  
Stop bits  
Parity  
7 bits/8 bits  
1 bit/2 bits  
Even, Odd, None  
Flow control  
RS/CS control  
XON/XOFF control  
None  
Reference  
Set the same communication conditions at the NT600S and Host.  
Refer to the appropriate instruction manuals for the method of setting the Host  
communication conditions.  
You are recommended to set the maximum baud rate supported by both the  
NT600S and Host.  
3-8-2  
Connector Pin Arrangement  
The RS-232C connection between the NT600S and Host is described below.  
RS-232C Interface Unit  
The connector and cable specifications are described below.  
Electrical characteristics: Conforms to EIA RS-232C specifications.  
Signal direction: Signal input and output are relative to the host computer.  
6
1
9
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2-8  
Connec-  
tor pin #  
Signal name  
Frame ground  
Abbrevi-  
ation  
Signal direction  
Input Output  
--- ---  
1
2
3
4
5
6
FG  
SD (TXD) ---  
Send data  
Yes  
---  
Receive data  
Request to send  
Clear to send  
RD (RXD) Yes  
RS (RTS) ---  
CS (CTS) Yes  
Yes  
---  
+5V 150mA Max. (ST211(B)-EV  
100mA Max. (ST121(B)-EV  
)
)
+5 V  
---  
Yes  
9
Signal ground  
SG (GND) ---  
---  
Note  
1. FG is not connected internally in the NT600S.  
2. Unlisted pins are not used.  
For cable parts and the wiring method, refer to APPENDIX E Method for Making  
the Cable for Connection to the PC/Host (page 264).  
Connecting to the Host Computer  
Use a cable that is compatible with the RS-232C connector of the host to connect  
the NT600S and the host.  
In the example shown here, the cable connects the 9-pin connector of the NT600S  
and 25-pin connector of the host. If the host has a 9-pin RS-232C connector, use  
an RS-232C cable with 9-pin connectors at both ends.  
NT600S  
9-pin  
connector  
25-pin  
connector  
RS-232C cable  
Caution  
Turn off the NT600S power supply when connecting or disconnecting connec-  
tors.  
After connecting a communication cable, always secure it with the screws.  
Check that the current capacity of the equipment to be supplied is within 150 mA  
before using the +5V output of pin No.6. Otherwise, the product may malfunc-  
tion.  
The current capacity of +5 V output of NT600S is:  
+5 V  
+5 V  
5%, 150 mA max. with ST211(B)-EV , and  
5%, 100 mA max. with ST121(B)-EV  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 4  
System Menu Operation  
This section describes the operation of the System Menu focusing on the procedure to start up the NT600S.  
Functions which will be convenient to use the NT600S and those which are useful for the system maintenance are  
also explained here.  
4-1 Operation Flow by the System Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-2 Starting the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-2-1 Changing the System Settings etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-3 Operation Modes and the System Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-3-1 System Menu and the Operation Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-3-2 Menu Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-3-3 Operations with the System Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-4 Initializing Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-4-1 Initialization of the Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-4-2 Initialization by Using the DIP Switch (Forced Initialization) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-5 Registering the Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
66  
67  
67  
68  
68  
69  
70  
72  
72  
74  
79  
4-6 Setting the Conditions of Communications with the PC/Host by Using the Memory Switches  
83  
4-6-1 Selecting the Host Communication Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-6-2 Baud Rate Selection (Host Link Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-6-3 Setting Unit Numbers (NT Link 1:N Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-6-4 Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-6-5 Selecting the Automatic Reset Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-7 Starting the Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-8 Various System Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-8-1 Setting the Key Press Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-8-2 Using the Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-8-3 Backlight OFF / EL Screen OFF Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-8-4 Resume Function (Featured with Battery Unit Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
4-8-5 Setting the Support Tool Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  
85  
86  
87  
89  
90  
92  
93  
93  
94  
96  
98  
99  
4-9 System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
4-9-1 I/O Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
4-9-2 Checking the NT600S DIP Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
4-9-3 Checking the PT Setting Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
4-9-4 Display History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-1  
4-1  
Operation Flow by the System Menu  
Follow the procedure below when using the NT600S for the first time or when  
changing the system.  
Create the Screen Data  
Create the screen data to be displayed on the NT600S by using a  
support tool.  
For the screen data creation, refer to the “NT-series Support Tool  
Operation Manual” (V028-E1- ).  
Although the screen data can be created with the previously avail-  
able support tool, there are several restrictions if such a tool is used.  
For details, refer to Appendix G Function Restrictions Depending  
on the Support Tool (page 277).  
Start Up the NT600S (Display the System Menu.) (page 67)  
Turn ON the power to the NT600S.  
When no screen data has been registered, the “SYSTEM MENU”  
will be displayed. If the NT600S enters the RUN mode, press ap-  
propriate touch switches to display the System Menu.  
Initialize Memory (page 72)  
Select a System Menu and initialize the NT600S unit memory.  
Transfer the Screen Data (page 79)  
Connect a support tool to the NT600S and transfer the screen data  
from the support tool to the NT600S.  
For the connection of a support tool, refer to Section 2-3Connecting  
to the Support Tool. (page 30)  
Memory Switch Setting (page 83)  
Select the System Menu and set the conditions for communications  
with the PC/Host using the memory switch.  
Start the Operation (page 92)  
Connect to the PC/Host and start the operation.  
System Maintenance (page 101)  
If an error has occurred during operation, check the I/Os, settings,  
etc. referring to this guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-2  
4-2  
Starting the NT600S  
When the NT600S is started, it will enter the RUN mode if system settings and  
screen data registration have been completed. If no screen data has been regis-  
tered or the screen data are destroyed, the System Menu will be displayed.  
Before turning ON the power, check the following DIP switch settings on the  
NT600S.  
SW2-3 “Switch to the System Menu enabled/disabled” is set to OFF (enabled).  
SW2-1 “Screen data forced initialize Yes/No” is set to No (ineffective).  
For the DIP switch settings of the unit, refer to the “DIP switch settings” (page 26).  
4-2-1  
Changing the System Settings etc.  
Follow the procedure below to change the system settings or screen data con-  
tents.  
Procedure 1. Turn ON the power to the NT600S.  
The NT600S will enter the RUN mode and the start-up screen will be dis-  
played. The start-up screen varies according to registered screen data.  
2. Press appropriate touch switches to display the System Menu, and change  
system settings. For the method for calling the System Menu, refer to the “Op-  
erations with the System Menu” (page 70).  
Note  
If the NT600S has failed to start up normally; an error message is displayed or no  
screen is displayed, memory needs to be initialized.  
For the memory initializing procedure, refer to Section 3-4 Initializing memory  
(page 72).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-3  
4-3  
Operation Modes and the System Menu  
The NT600S operates in either “RUN”, “Transmit”, or “Maintenance” mode. The  
operation modes can be switched by using the System Menu.  
4-3-1  
System Menu and the Operation Modes  
Select an operation mode by pressing the corresponding touch switch in the Sys-  
tem Menu. The operation modes with respect to the System Menu are related to  
each other as shown below.  
For the operations with the System Menu, refer to the “Operations with the System  
Menu” (page 70).  
RUN mode  
The NT600S runs in this  
state. Controls from the  
PC/Host are enabled  
and various indications  
and I/O operations are  
made.  
To change system  
settings or screen  
data contents  
Transmit Mode  
Screen data and other  
data are transmitted  
between the NT600S  
and a support tool.  
When system settings  
and screen data  
registration have been  
completed  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Power ON  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
The NT600S  
maintenance operations  
such as memory initialize  
and setting check are  
executed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-3  
4-3-2  
Menu Tree  
The System Menu allows to effect various NT600S functions by using the touch  
switches. The NT600S’s functions with respect to the System Menu are related as  
shown below.  
For the operations with the System Menu, refer to the “Operations with the System  
Menu” (page 70).  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance mode  
MAINTENANCE MENU  
Quit  
I/O CHECK MENU  
Communication I/F  
CHECK MENU  
PT Setting Status (page 108)  
I/O Check (page 101)  
Quit  
LED (page 101)  
Quit  
Memory Init. (page 72)  
Buzzer (page 102)  
Touch Switch (page 102)  
LCD/EL Display (page 104)  
Backlight (page 104)  
Tool Transmit  
(page 106)  
Memory Switches  
(page 83)  
RS-232C Transmit  
(page 106)  
Display History  
(page 110)  
Communication I/F  
(page 105)  
DIP-Switch (page 107)  
MEMORY INITIALIZATION  
MENU  
RS-232C  
setting  
MEMORY SWITCH MENU 2  
Quit  
Screen Data Memory (page 72)  
Memory Tables (page 75)  
Display History (page 77)  
Memory Switches (page 78)  
Data Bit Length (page 89)  
Stop Bit Length (page 89)  
Parity Bit (page 89)  
Flow Control (page 89)  
RS-232C Speed(page 89)  
Support Tool Mode(page 99)  
MEMORY SWITCH MENU 1  
Key Press Sound (page 93)  
Buzzer Sound (page 94)  
NT link  
setting  
MEMORY SWITCH MENU 2  
Backlight OFF/  
EL Screen OFF (page 96)  
Automatic Reset (page 90)  
Comm. Method (page 85)  
Host Link Speed (page 86)  
Automatic Reset (page 90)  
Resume Function (page 98)  
PT Unit No. (1:N setting) (page 87)  
Host link  
setting  
Automatic Reset (page 90)  
Host Link Baud Rate (page 86)  
MEMORY SWITCH MENU 2  
DISPLAY HISTORY MENU  
Quit  
Time Order (page 112)  
Frequent Order (page 112)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-3  
4-3-3  
Operations with the System Menu  
The following gives the procedure to call the System Menu, select the menu items,  
and other operations with the System Menu.  
Reference  
Make sure that DIP SW2-3 “Switch to the System Menu enabled/disabled” is set  
to OFF (enabled). If the setting is ON (disabled), the System Menu will not be dis-  
played by following the procedure given below.  
Displaying the System Menu Press appropriate touch switches to display the System Menu as mentioned be-  
low. The “RUN” LED goes off when the System Menu is displayed.  
The NT600S display screen has four touch switches to display the System Menu  
in the four corners (about 14 mm x 11 mm size). Press any two of these switches at  
the same time to call the System Menu screen.  
RUN mode  
POWER  
[SYSTEM MENU]  
RUN  
Quit  
Press any two of  
these four corners  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance mode  
at the same time.  
Note that the touch switches used to call the System Menu are not displayed on  
the screen. If a touch switch displayed in a corner is pressed first, the touch switch  
will function and the System Menu will not be displayed. To successfully call the  
System Menu, first press a corner where no touch key is displayed, and then,  
press any other corner regardless of the presence of a touch key.  
Reference  
If a screen has the touch switches registered at all of the four corners, it is impos-  
sible to call the System Menu from the screen.  
In this case, switch to a screen that does not have touch switches at its four cor-  
ners.  
A “system key” function can be assigned to a touch switch. Pressing the touch  
switch so assigned on the screen can easily display the System Menu. For the  
relationship between the system key and the touch switch, refer to the “System  
key functions” (page 142).  
ꢈꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-3  
Selecting the Menu Items  
Press (touch) a menu item on the screen to select the item.  
Menu items allow to make the ON/OFF selection or to call subsequent menu or  
screen.  
Example :  
To call the “Maintenance Mode Menu” by pressing the “Maintenance Mode” on the  
System Menu screen:  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
System Menu Items  
The System Menu items and the functions are as given below.  
Menu Item  
Function  
Quit  
The System Menu screen is cleared and the NT600S will return  
to the RUN mode.  
Transmit Mode  
The Transmit Mode screen will be displayed to allow the trans-  
mission of the screen data between the NT600S and the support  
tool. For the transmission of the screen data, refer to Section 3-5  
Registering the Screen Data (page 79).  
Maintenance Mode The Maintenance Mode menu will be displayed to allow the  
maintenance of the NT600S system.  
Switching from the System Menu to the RUN mode  
The NT600S will exit the System Menu and switch to the RUN mode in the cases  
mentioned below.  
Selecting “Quit” in the System Menu.  
The screen (touch switches) is not pressed for over 10 seconds.  
ꢈꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
4-4  
Initializing Memory  
If the NT600S is used for the first time or if the screen data is ruined and the  
NT600S cannot be normally started, the memory needs to be initialized.  
The memory initialization is required in the cases mentioned below.  
When the NT600S is used for the first time or when an error message indicating  
that the screen data is ruined etc. when the NT600S is started.  
Use the “Maintenance Mode” -- Init. Memory” in the System Menu.  
When the NT600S has made a buzzer sound and the screen has disappeared  
during the start-up or operation.  
Use the NT600S DIP SW2-1 “Screen data forced initialize effective/ineffec-  
tive”.  
Reference  
When an error has occurred, the error messages such as “Screen data corrupted”  
will be displayed. For the error messages displayed on the screen, refer to Section  
7-2 “Responding to Displayed Error Messages” (page 242).  
The following memory data can be initialized.  
Image data memory  
Memory tables  
Display history  
Memory switch  
The image data memory can be initialized regardless of the setting for the resume  
function (page 98).  
Reference  
After initializing one type of data, if it is necessary to initialize another type, dis-  
play the System Menu again and follow the initialization operation from the be-  
ginning.  
If the image data memory is initialized, all the screen data stored in the NT600S  
is cleared. Therefore, before initializing the image data memory, make sure that  
the created screen data has been saved in a floppy disk.  
4-4-1  
Initialization of the Screen Data  
The screen data can be initialized by either of the following two methods.  
Initialization by using the System Menu  
Initialization by using the DIP switch  
ꢈꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
Initialization by using the System Menu  
Initialize the image data memory by following the procedure given below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Init.”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Screen Data Memory”.  
[ MEMORY INITIALIZATION MENU ]  
Quit  
Screen Data Memory  
Memory Tables  
Display History  
Memory Switches  
Select “Confirm”.  
Initialize the Screen Data Memory?  
Confirm  
Cancel  
The screen data memory is initialized. During the initialization, the “Initializing ...”  
message will be displayed.  
ꢈꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
Reference  
If “No” is selected, the memory initialization will be canceled and the NT600S re-  
turns to the “Memory initialization”.  
Upon completion of image data  
[ MEMORY INITIALIZATION MENU ]  
memory initialization, the  
NT600S returns to the “Memory  
Initialization Menu”.  
Quit  
Screen Data Memory  
Memory Tables  
Display History  
Memory Switches  
After initialization of the screen data memory, the system enters the operation  
mode. At this point, nothing is displayed on the screen of the NT600S.  
When the screen data memory initialization has been completed, transfer the  
screen data from the support tool.  
If the screen data cannot be initialized for any reason, the message “An Error Oc-  
cur Initializing Memory” is displayed.  
4-4-2  
Initialization by Using the DIP Switch (Forced Initialization)  
Note  
Be sure to turn the power OFF before setting the NT600S DIP switch.  
Set the DIP switch as follows to initialize the screen data memory.  
Operation 1.  
Set DIP SW2-1 on the NT600S to ON and turn the power ON.  
Select “Confirm”. The screen  
Initialize the Screen Data Memory?  
data memory is initialized. Dur-  
ing the initialization, the “Initial-  
izing ...” message will be dis-  
played.  
Confirm  
Cancel  
The screen data memory was  
initialized.  
Turn off the DIP-Switch 2-1  
and push the reset switch,  
then NT600S starts up normally.  
2.  
3.  
Turn the NT600S power to OFF.  
Set NT600S DIP SW2-1 to OFF and turn the power ON.  
ꢈꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
Reference  
Selecting “No” will cancel the memory initialization. To change the system set-  
tings or to register the screen data, set DIP SW2-1 to OFF and start the  
NT600S, and then, call the System Menu screen.  
The NT600S DIP SW2-1 is used to set “Screen data forced initialize effective/in-  
effective”. Setting this to ON selects “effective”, and OFF “ineffective”.  
Initialization of the Memory Tables  
It is possible to initialize the numeral memory tables and character-string memory  
tables in the NT600S. When these tables are initialized, the values are returned to  
those set by the support tool.  
If a memory table is initialized in the Maintenance Mode, it is initialized regardless  
of the setting for the resume function (resume function: page 98)  
If “Effective” is set for the “Resume Function” memory switch, the initial values set  
with the support tool will not be reflected inthe present values of the memory tables  
unless the memory tables are initialized.  
Reference  
If “Ineffective” is set for the “Resume Function” memory switch, the memory  
tables can be initialized just by switching the NT600S power off andback onagain,  
or by resetting it, (page 98)  
Using the System Menu, initialize the memory tables by following the procedure  
given below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Init.”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Memory Tables”.  
[ MEMORY INITIALIZATION MENU ]  
Quit  
Screen Data Memory  
Memory Tables  
Display History  
Memory Switches  
ꢈꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
Select “Confirm”.  
The memory table is initialized.  
Initialize the Memory Tables?  
Confirm  
Cancel  
Reference  
If “Cancel” is selected instead of “Confirm”, the NT600S returns to the “Memory  
Initialization Menu” without initializing the memory.  
If a memory table is initialized in the Maintenance Mode, it is initialized regard-  
less of the setting for the resume function (resume function: page 98).  
Initialization of the Display History Data Memory  
Thedisplayhistory(page110)is storedintheorder ofoccurrence(timeorder) orthe  
order of frequency (frequent order). Since no more display history data can be  
stored if the memory becomes full, the memory has to be initialized at regular inter-  
vals.  
Reference  
The display history data memory can be initialized by a command given from the  
Host.  
Using the System Menu, initialize the display history data memory by following the  
procedure given below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Init.”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
Select “Display History”.  
[ MEMORY INITIALIZATION MENU ]  
Quit  
Screen Data Memory  
Memory Tables  
Display History  
Memory Switches  
Select “Confirm”.  
Initialize the Display History?  
Confirm  
Cancel  
The display history data memory is initialized.  
Reference  
If “Cancel” is selected instead of “Confirm”, the NT600S returns to the “Memory  
Initialization Menu” without initializing the memory.  
Initialization of the Memory Switch  
It is possible to initialize the settings of the NT600S memory switch to the settings  
made before shipping.  
Key Press Sound : ON  
Buzzer Sound  
Screen Saver  
Comm. Method  
: ON  
: 10 min  
: Host Link  
Host Link Speed : 9600 bps  
Automatic Reset : OFF  
Resume Function : OFF  
Data bit length  
Stop bit length  
Parity bits  
: 8 bits  
: 1 bit  
: None  
: None  
: 2400 bps  
: NT600S  
: 0  
Flow control  
Baud Rate  
Tool Mode  
Unit No.  
ꢈꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-4  
Using the System Menu, initialize the memory switch by following the procedure  
given below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Init.”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MEMORY INITIALIZATION MENU ]  
Quit  
Screen Data Memory  
Memory Tables  
Display History  
Memory Switches  
Select “Confirm”.  
Initialize the Memory Switches?  
Confirm  
Cancel  
The memory switch settings are initialized to the settings made before shipping.  
While the memory switch is being initialized, “Initializing ...” is displayed.  
Reference  
If “Cancel” is selected instead of “Confirm”, the NT600S returns to the “Memory  
Initialization Menu” without initializing the memory.  
ꢈꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-5  
4-5  
Registering the Screen Data  
The screen data is created by using the support tool and registered to the NT600S  
screen data memory. This section describes the procedure to register the screen  
data to the NT600S. For the screen data creation and the support tool operation,  
refer to the NT-series Support Tool Operation Manual (V028-E1- ).  
Reference  
The screen data transmission speed can be increased by setting “Hispeed” for  
“Communication Mode” on the Tool Settings screen of the support tool.  
Transmission -- Transmission in File Units  
The NT600S uses several screens which are switched on its display. The screen  
data of one NT600S unit corresponds to the files created by using the support tool.  
Select a file which contains the screen data to be transmitted when selecting the  
screen data to be transmitted to the NT600S so that the required screen data can  
be transmitted to the NT600S.  
Screen data file  
NT600S  
Screen 1  
Screen 2  
:
Screen 1  
Screen 2  
:
All screen data are  
transmitted by one operation.  
Screen N  
Screen N  
Memory table  
Mark data  
Memory table  
Mark data  
System memory  
Direct connection information  
System memory  
Direct connection information  
Reference  
If an error message and the System Menu are displayed immediately after the  
NT600S has been started, the screen data memory needs to be initialized.  
Before transferring the screen data to the NT600S, initialize the image data  
memory.  
ꢈꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-5  
Transmission in Screen Units  
The NT600S allows the transmission of data for individual screens. The screen  
number of the screen to be transmitted can be specified with the support tool to  
transmit this screen only to the NT600S (it is also possible to transmit multiple  
screens in a batch).  
If, when executing screen data transmission in screen units, there are also  
changes to data other than screen data, for example memory table or direct ac-  
cess data, transmit this changed data to the NT600S also.  
NT600S  
Support tool  
Screen 2  
Screen 1  
Screen 2  
Only the required  
data is transmitted.  
Screen N  
Memory table  
(Direct information)  
Ca
When screen data transmission is in screen units, if data other than screen data  
changes -- for example memory table or direct access data -- transmit this new  
data also.  
Reference  
When screen data is transmitted to the NT600S, it does not overwrite existing  
screen data; it is written to a free area of the memory. Consequently, if data is  
transmitted frequently in screen units, the free area of the memory will not be suffi-  
cient and transfer will become impossible. If this happens, transmit the data in file  
units to bring the memory of the NT600s back to order.  
Transmitting the Screen Data from the Support Tool  
To transmit the screen data from the support tool to the NT600S, connect the  
NT600S to the computer on which the support tool is being used, and follow the  
procedure below.  
Reference  
The NT600S (Host link/NT link/RS-232C method) uses one connector for the con-  
nection to both a PC/Host and a computer. If it has been connected to a PC/Host,  
disconnect the PC and connect the support tool (computer) to the NT600S, and  
then, transmit the screen data.  
Operation 1. Connect the NT600S to the computer on which the support tool is being used,  
and turn ON the NT600S.  
2. Turn ON the computer and start up the support tool.  
3. Set the [Support Tool Mode] memory switch setting to match the support tool  
being used.  
ꢉꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-5  
Reference  
By setting the Support Tool Mode to “NT600M”, the NT600S is made compatible  
with the existing NTM support tool. For details on setting the Support Tool Mode,  
refer to page 99.  
4.  
Enter the “Transmit Mode” by operating the menu of the NT600S as men-  
tioned below.  
Select “Transmit Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
[ TRANSMIT MODE ]  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode: NT600S  
5.  
6.  
Select a screen data to be transmitted to the NT600S in the File Selection  
screen of the support tool, and press the Send key.  
The NT600S will display the following screen when the screen data is being  
transmitted.  
[ TRANSMIT MODE ]  
Tool PT  
Screen Data  
0KB  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode: NT600S  
ꢉꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-5  
7.  
When the screen data transmission is completed, the support tool will display  
the following screen.  
-- -- -- -- -- Help Message -- -- -- -- --  
Data successfuly transmitted  
(Hit any key to continue)  
8.  
9.  
Press any key on the support tool to return to the File Selection screen.  
Pressing the “EXIT” touch switch in the Transmit Mode screen of the NT600S  
will exit the Transmit Mode and enter the System Menu.  
Reference  
Press the “EXIT” touch switch on the NT600S when the screen data transmission  
is completed. Unless this touch switch is pressed, the screen data will not be cor-  
rectly registered. If the “EXIT” touch switch is pressed during transmission, the  
screen data will not be correctly registered.  
If screen data cannot be transmitted from the support tool properly, check whether  
communication between the NT600S and support tool (personal computer) is nor-  
mal.  
To check communication with the support tool, use the “Tool Transmit” function in  
the maintenance mode of the NT600S. See “Checking the Communications with  
the Support Tool/Host” (page 105).  
Precautions to be Observed During the Screen Data Transmission  
When any of the following or a system error occurs during the screen data trans-  
mission, the transmitted screen data will not be registered correctly to the  
NT600S. If an error message is displayed in the System Menu and the Transmit  
Mode cannot be selected, the screen data memory needs to be initialized.  
The power to the NT600S is interrupted or the NT600S is reset.  
The power to the computer on which the support tool is running is interrupted or  
the computer is reset.  
The cable connecting the NT600S to the computer on which the support tool is  
running is disconnected or has a broken wire.  
The Cancel touch switch on the NT600S screen is pressed to end the transmis-  
sion during screen data transfer.  
The ESC key on the support tool is pressed to end the transmission.  
When the power to the NT600S is turned ON or reset, the screen data is checked.  
However, if any of the above occurs during the screen data transmission, the  
screen may disappear and other unexpected problems may occur.  
In the case of such problems, set DIP SW2-1 to ON to initialize the memory.  
For the memory initialization by using the DIP switch, refer to the “Initialization by  
using the DIP switch” (page 74).  
ꢉꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
4-6  
Setting the Conditions of Communications with the PC/  
Host by Using the Memory Switches  
The communications between the NT600S and a PC/Host are called the host  
communications.  
The NT600S can be connected to a PC/Host by the host link, NT link (1:1, 1:N),  
C200H direct, or RS-232C. The link can be selected by setting the memory switch.  
Also, the host link baud rate, automatic reset function, RS-232C communication  
conditions, etc. are set with the memory switches.  
This section describes the communications condition settings by using the  
memory switches.  
Memory Switches  
The NT600S has the memory areas used to store the PC/Host connection meth-  
od, communications conditions, system settings, etc. which can be used as the  
switches and called the “memory switches”. Since the memory switches use the  
flash memory, the stored data can be held even when the power supply is turned  
OFF.  
If for any reason the set memory switch data is destroyed, a message will be dis-  
played on switching to the run mode. If this happens, press the [Write] touch  
switch to initialize the memory switches.  
Setting Functions and the Memory Switch Menu  
The memory switches can be set easily by using the memory switch menu in the  
System Menu.  
The functions that can be selected (memory switch menu) differ according to the  
communication method selected, as shown on the next page. For details on each  
function, refer to the next section onward and to 3-8 Various System Settings”  
(page 93).  
[MEMORY SWITCH MENU 1 (When LCD display screen is used.)]  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
None  
ON  
NEXT  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Selecting the Host Communication Method (page 85)  
3-8 Various System Settings (page 93)  
3-8 Various System Settings (page 94)  
3-8 Various System Settings (page 96)  
3-8 Various System Settings (page 98)  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
Support Tool Mode 3-8 Various System Settings (page 99)  
ꢉꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
[MEMORY SWITCH MENU 2]  
Host Link method  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
Host Link Speed  
ON  
19200bps  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
NT Link method (1:1)  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
ON  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
NT Link method (1:N)  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
PT UNIT No.  
ON  
7
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
C200H direct method  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
Automatic Reset ON  
EXIT  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
ꢉꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
RS-232C method  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
Data Bit Length  
Stop Bit Length  
Parity Bit  
ON  
7bits  
2bits  
Odd  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Flow Control  
RS-232C Speed  
XON/XOFF  
19200bps  
Automatic Reset  
Host Link Speed  
PT UNIT No.  
Selecting the Automatic Reset Function (page 90)  
Selecting the Host Link Communication Speed (page 86)  
Setting the PT UNIT No. (page 87)  
Data Bit Length  
Stop Bit Length  
Parity Bit  
Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions (page 89)  
Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions (page 89)  
Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions (page 89)  
Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions (page 89)  
Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions (page 89)  
Flow Control  
RS-232C Speed  
4-6-1  
Selecting the Host Communication Method  
The NT600S can be connected to a PC/Host by the host link, NT link (1:1, 1:N),  
C200H direct, or RS-232C. Either link can be selected by setting the “Comm.  
Method” memory switch. The factory setting has been made to the “Host link”.  
Select the host communication method by the menu operation from the System  
Menu as mentioned below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
ꢉꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
Each time the “Comm. Method”  
touch switch is pressed, the set-  
ting option changes to the next  
item in the sequence “Host  
Link”, “NT Link”, “NT Link 1:N”,  
“RS-232C”.  
When a C200H interface unit is  
connected, the setting is fixed  
as “C200H”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without set-  
ting, press [EXIT].  
4-6-2  
Baud Rate Selection (Host Link Only)  
When using the host link, the baud rate for the communication method must be  
set. “9600 bps” or “19200 bps” can be selected.  
The factory setting has been made at 9600 bps.  
Select the baud rate of the communication with the PC by the menu operation from  
the System Menu shown below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
Select “NEXT PAGE”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
If the communication method is  
not displayed as host link, press  
“Comm. Method” to select “Host  
Link”.  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
Each time the “Host Link Speed”  
touch switch is pressed, the set-  
ting option “9600 bps” alternates  
with “19200 bps”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
Host Link Speed  
ON  
19200bps  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without set-  
ting, press [EXIT].  
4-6-3  
Setting Unit Numbers (NT Link 1:N Only)  
When using NT600S with the NT link (1:N) communication method, set unit num-  
bers.  
When using NT link (1:N), unit numbers are used to identify each of the multiple  
PTs connected to a single PC port. Set a different unit number for each of the PTs  
connected to the port.  
The unit numbers that can be set differ in accordance with the type of host PC as  
follows.  
C200HE  
C200HG, C200HX  
:Unit Nos. 0 to 3  
:Unit Nos. 0 to 7  
Set the unit numbers by following the menu operation from the System Menu de-  
scribed below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
ꢉꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Press the “NEXT PAGE”.  
If “NT link 1:N” is not displayed  
as the communication method,  
press “Comm. Method” to dis-  
play it.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
Repeatedly pressing the “UNIT  
No.” touch switch cycles  
through the numbers that can be  
set.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
UNIT No.  
ON  
7
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT]. The run mode will be established.  
ꢉꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
4-6-4  
Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions  
When connecting the NT600S to the host by the RS-232C method, set the follow-  
ing communication conditions.  
Item  
Setting  
Factory-Setting  
2400bps  
2400/4800/9600/19200bps  
(to be set to the same value as set for the Host)  
RS-232C Speed  
Data bit length  
Stop bit length  
Parity bit  
7 bits/8 bits  
1 bit/2 bits  
8 bits  
1 bit  
Even/odd/none  
None  
RS/CS control  
XON/XOFF control  
None  
Flow control  
None  
Select the required menu option from the System Menu by following the procedure  
given below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Press “NEXT PAGE”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
If the RS-232C has been se-  
lected, the host link speed set-  
ting does not make any effect.  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
RS-232C  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
ꢉꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
The setting changes when each  
of the touch switches is pressed  
are indicated below.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
Data Bit Length  
Stop Bit Length  
Parity Bit  
ON  
7bits  
2bits  
Odd  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Flow Control  
RS-232C Speed  
XON/XOFF  
19200bps  
“Automatic Reset”  
“Data Bit Length”  
“Stop Bit Length”  
“Parity Bit”  
Alternates between “OFF” and “ON”  
Alternates between “8 bits” and “7 bits”  
Alternates between “2 bits” and “1 bit”  
Changes among “None”, “Even” and “Odd”  
“Flow Control”  
Changes among “None”, “RS/CS”  
and “XON/XOFF”  
“RS-232C Speed”  
Changes among “2400 bps”, “4800 bps”,  
“9600 bps” and “19200 bps”  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without set-  
ting, press [EXIT].  
4-6-5  
Selecting the Automatic Reset Function  
The “Automatic Reset” memory switch in MEMORY SWITCH MENU 2 selects  
whether or not operation is automatically restarted after the occurrence of a com-  
munication error.  
The factory setting for the automatic reset function is “OFF”.  
Select whether the automatic reset function is off or on by operation from the Sys-  
tem Menu as described below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
ꢊꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-6  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “NEXT PAGE”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
Each time the “Automatic Re-  
set” touch switch is pressed, the  
setting option changes from  
“ON” to “OFF” or from “OFF” to  
“ON”.  
The menu display differs ac-  
cording to the communication  
method (see page 83).  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (2/2) ]  
EXIT  
Automatic Reset  
Host Link Speed  
ON  
19200bps  
PREV.  
PAGE  
SAVE  
EXIT  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT].  
“OFF”: If a communication error has occurred, corresponding error message is  
displayed and the operation stops.  
“ON”: If a communication error has occurred, corresponding error message will  
not be displayed and the operation will be automatically reset.  
ꢊꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-7  
4-7  
Starting the Operation  
After completing the screen data transmission, connect the NT600S to the PC/  
Host and start the operation.  
Caution  
Carefully check the operation of all screen data and host programs before using  
them. If incorrect, the system may operate unpredictably.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Switching to the RUN mode Press the Quit touch switch in the System Menu. The start-up screen in the RUN  
mode will be displayed.  
Note  
If the NT600S has failed to start correctly; e.g., the start-up screen is not dis-  
played, an error message is displayed, or the screen is not displayed at all, refer to  
Section 7-2 “Responding to Displayed Error Messages” (page 242) and take ap-  
propriate action.  
Reference  
In the case of direct connection, the screen designated as “Screen Switch Setting”  
of the area by the PT status control at the start up is displayed as the start-up  
screen.  
In the case of RS-232C, the start-up screen is designated when the screen data is  
created by using the support tool. If the start-up screen has not been designated,  
the screen with screen number 1 will be displayed. If no screen data has been  
registered at screen number 1, the “Specified Screen Cannot Be Saved.” error  
message will be displayed. For the screen number setting, refer to Section 5-3  
Screen Display (page 124).  
Confirming the Communications between the NT600S and the PC/Host  
If RS-232C communication is used, confirm that communications are normally  
executed between the NT600S and the PC/Host using the RS-232C communica-  
tion check function in the maintenance mode. Refer to “Checking the Commu-  
nications with the Support Tool/Host” (page 105).  
If the direct access is used, execute the PC/Host program and confirm that the  
following operations are normally performed.  
Confirm that the NT600S screens switch according to the PC/Host program  
execution.  
If the screens do not switch correctly, check the connection between the  
NT600S and the PC/Host and also check the settings.  
Refer to Section 2 Hardware Settings and Connections.  
Confirm that the information selected by the NT600S touch switches has been  
set in the PC/Host by displaying the contents of the words and bits using a pe-  
ripheral tool (LSS etc.) or at the Host. If the information sent from the NT600S  
has not been correctly received by the PC, check the screen data settings (spe-  
cifically the switch settings).  
For the details of the screen data creation, refer to the NT-series Support Tool  
Operation Manual (V028-E1-01).  
ꢊꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
4-8  
Various System Settings  
The NT600S can set a variety of functions to the memory switches which are con-  
venient during the operation. This section describes the memory switch settings  
related to the operation environment.  
4-8-1  
Setting the Key Press Sound  
Whether or not the key press sound is given when the NT600S touch switch is  
pressed can be set with the memory switch.  
The factory setting has been set to give the key press sound when the touch key is  
pressed.  
Set the key press sound by the menu operation from the System Menu as men-  
tioned below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Each time the “Key Press  
Sound” touch switch is pressed,  
the setting option “ON” alter-  
nates with “OFF”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
ꢊꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT].  
ON: The key press sound will be given for 0.2 second when a touch switch is  
pressed.  
OFF: The key press sound will not be given when a touch key is pressed.  
4-8-2  
Using the Buzzer  
The NT600S can set a buzzer to indicate the occurrence of an emergency or an  
NT600S error.  
Setting the Buzzer  
Except when the buzzer has been set so as not to sound at all, the buzzer will  
sound when an error occurs. The buzzer can be made to sound in other cases by  
using the two following methods.  
Sounding under control of the host (when using RS-232C communication)  
It is possible to control the NT600S from the host to sound the buzzer during  
operation.  
See “7-2 Commands Sent by the Host” (page 207).  
Set buzzer sounding as a screen data attribute with the support tool  
When creating the screen data by using the support tool, set buzzer sounding as  
a screen attribute so that the buzzer will sound. When a screen for which this  
attribute has been set is displayed, the NT600S buzzer sounds.  
If the control by the host and the display of the screen in which the buzzer attribute  
has been set are executed simultaneously, the priority is given to the control by the  
host. Refer to the NT-series Support Tool Operation Manual (V028-E1- ).  
To Stop the Buzzer Sound  
The buzzer sound can be stopped by the following operation.  
Control by the Host  
Switch the screen to a screen which does not have a buzzer attribute.  
Press the touch switch to which the buzzer stop attribute has been set.  
Reference  
If a buzzer stop attribute has been set to a touch switch created on the screen in  
which the buzzer attribute has been set, such touch switch can be used to stop the  
buzzer sound. For details on setting buzzer stop attributes to touch switches, refer  
to “Allocating of system key functions” (page 142).  
ꢊꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
Types of the Buzzer Sounds  
The following buzzer sounds can be set.  
Continuous sound: The buzzer continues to sound.  
Intermittent sound: The buzzer sounds intermittently at constant intervals.  
Reference  
If both the continuous buzzer and the intermittent buzzer are instructed by the  
Host, the continuous buzzer will sound.  
Setting the Buzzer  
Use the memory switches to set whether or not the buzzer sounds when the buzz-  
er sound has been instructed by the Host or with a screen attribute or when an  
error has occurred.  
The factory setting has been made at “ON” so that the buzzer will sound when a  
command is received from the Host or when a screen attribute setting error has  
occurred.  
Set the buzzer sound by the menu operation from the System Menu as mentioned  
below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Repeatedly pressing the “Buzz-  
er Sound” touch switch cycles  
through the setting options  
“ON”, “ERR ON”, and “OFF”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
ꢊꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT].  
When “OFF” is set, the buzzer does not sound during operation.  
ON: The buzzer will sound when a command from the Host is given, the screen  
attribute has been set, or an error has occurred.  
When “ERR ON” has been set, the buzzer will sound only when an error has  
occurred.  
Reference  
The buzzer will sound when “Buzzer check” is selected in the Maintenance Mode  
regardless of the buzzer setting.  
4-8-3  
Backlight OFF / EL Screen OFF Function  
The NT600S has a function that turns off the backlight of the LCD panel or turns off  
the EL screen if no operation is performed for a certain period of time in order to  
maximize the service life of the backlight and prevent the formation of an afterim-  
age on the EL screen.  
An afterimage may occur if the same screen contents are kept displayed for a long  
period. What is meant by “afterimage” is that previously displayed screen con-  
tents are not cleared and are left on the screen.  
Turning ON the Backlight / Redisplaying the Turned OFF Screen  
When a touch switch on the NT600S is pressed, or when a screen is switched or  
redisplayed by the host after the backlight or EL screen has been switched OFF by  
the backlight OFF or EL screen OFF function, the backlight will turn on or the EL  
screen will be redisplayed. Changes of numerals or characters displayed on the  
screen will not cause the backlight to turn back on or the EL screen to be redis-  
played.  
Setting the backlight OFF / EL screen OFF Function  
Use the memory switches to set whether or not the backlight OFF function and EL  
screen OFF function are used, and the length of time that the backlight or the EL  
screen is turned off.  
The factory setting specifies that the backlight or EL screen will turn off if no opera-  
tion is performed for 10 minutes.  
Set the backlight OFF function or EL screen OFF function by operation from the  
System Menu as described below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Each time the “Putting-Out  
Time” touch switch is pressed,  
the setting option will switch  
among “10 min”, “1 hour”, and  
“None”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT].  
When “None” is set, the backlight OFF/EL screen OFF function is not effective  
and the same screen will therefore remain displayed indefinitely even if no op-  
eration is performed.  
When “10 min” is set, the backlight or the EL screen will be turned off when no  
operation has been performed for 10 minutes.  
When “1 hour” is set, the backlight or the EL screen will be turned off when no  
operation has been performed for 1 hour.  
Caution  
Do not press touch switches carelessly while the backlight is off or while nothing is  
displayed on the screen.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Only press touch switches after confirming system safety.  
Note  
Continuous display of the same pattern for an extended time (as a guide, about 1  
hour) will lead to the formation of an afterimage.  
In order to prevent this, either periodically switch screens or use the EL screen  
OFF function.  
ꢊꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
4-8-4  
Resume Function (Featured with Battery Unit Only)  
The resume function is used to maintain the data contents of numeral/character-  
string memory tables when the power is switched off or the reset switch is pressed.  
If the resume function is set “ON”, the memory table is not initialized even whenthe  
power is switched off, the reset switch is pressed, or the mode is changed from the  
system menu to the transmit mode.  
It is possible to redisplay the screen contents displayed before switching off the  
power when restarting the operation next using the values stored to the memory  
table before the switching off of the power.  
The memory table is always initialized disregarding of the ON or OFF setting of the  
resume function if the memory table is initialized using the “Memory Init.” of the  
MAINTENANCE MENU. For the procedure for initializing the memory table, refer  
to Initialization of the Memory Tables (page 75).  
Reference  
The resume function can be used only when an optional battery unit is installed.  
However, if the battery voltage is low, the contents of the memory table cannot be  
retained even when the resume function is set “ON”.  
Whether or not the resume function is used is set by the Memory Switch.  
The factory setting for the resume function is “OFF”.  
Select the setting for the resume function by the menu operation from the System  
Menu shown below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
ꢊꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
Each time the “Resume Func-  
tion” touch switch is pressed,  
the setting option changes from  
“ON” to “OFF” or “OFF” to “ON”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT].  
When “OFF” is set, the resume function is ineffective, and the memory tables are  
initialized when the NT600S is switched ON or reset, and on switching to the run  
mode. When new memory table data (initial settings) is transmitted from the  
support tool, the contents of the memory tables are also updated.  
When “ON” is set, the resume function is effective, and even when the NT600S  
is switched ON or reset, or switched to the run mode, the memory tables retain  
their existing data.  
When NT600S operation starts, the contents of the memory tables are also writ-  
ten to the allocated words at the host. In addition, when new memory table data  
(initial settings) is written from the support tool, the initial settings are updated,  
but the memory tables themselves retain their original contents. To initialize with  
new initial settings, carry out memory table initialization (page 75).  
4-8-5  
Setting the Support Tool Mode  
By setting the “Support Tool Mode” to “NT600M”, the NT600S can be used in the  
same way as the existing NT600M model, and is made compatible with the  
NT20M/NT2000M/NT600M support tool (Ver.4).  
However, the following restrictions apply when the “NT600M” setting option is se-  
lected.  
Version 5 of the direct connection function cannot be used.  
The “PT type” setting must be set to “NT600M”.  
High-speed transmissions with respect to the support tool are not possible.  
Transmissions consisting of direct information only are not possible.  
When screen data transmission is in screen units, simultaneous transmission of  
multiple screens is not possible. An attempt to transmit multiple screens may  
destroy the screen data.  
When screen data transmission is in screen units, transmission with verification  
set is not possible.  
Before transmitting data in file units, the screen data memory must be initialized.  
It is not possible to create screen data for RS-232C communication.  
ꢊꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-8  
Starting from the system menu, make the following menu selections to set the  
Support Tool Mode.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “Memory Switches”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Each time the “Support Tool  
Mode” touch switch is pressed,  
the setting option changes from  
“NT600S” to “NT600M” or from  
“NT600M” to “NT600S”.  
[ MEMORY SWITCH MENU (1/2) ]  
EXIT  
Comm. Method  
Key Press Sound  
Buzzer Sound  
Host Link  
OFF  
OFF  
NEXT  
PAGE  
Putting-Out Time  
Resume Function  
None  
ON  
SAVE  
EXIT  
Support Tool Mode NT600S  
To set and quit the menu, press the [SAVE EXIT] touch switch. To quit without  
setting, press [EXIT].  
When “NT600M” is set, the NT600M compatible mode is established and the  
NT600S can be used as if it were an NT600M.  
When “NT600S” is set, the NT600S can be used as an NT600S.  
ꢃꢋꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
4-9  
System Maintenance  
The NT600S has the self maintenance functions such as I/O check and setting  
status check.  
4-9-1  
I/O Check  
The I/O operations for the following items of the NT600S are checked by the I/O  
check function.  
LED  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD/EL  
Backlight  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Checking the LED  
Check the LED by using the menu operation from the System Menu as mentioned  
below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O Check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “LED”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
ꢃꢋꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
The “RUN” LED on the front face of the NT600S will flash. The “POWER” LED  
remains lit.  
To quit the LED check, press the “EXIT” touch switch. The I/O Check Menu will  
be redisplayed.  
Checking the Buzzer  
Check the NT600S buzzer by using the menu operation from the System Menu as  
mentioned below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O Check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Buzzer”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
If the buzzer function is normal, the continuous buzzer sound will be made.  
To stop the buzzer, press “EXIT” in the buzzer check screen.  
Reference  
Though memory switch setting for the buzzer has been made for OFF, the buzzer  
will sound when the buzzer check is executed.  
Checking the Touch Switches  
Execute a touch switch check by the menu operation from the System Menu as  
mentioned below.  
ꢃꢋꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O Check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Touch Switch”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
A panel of 8-row x 16-column touch switches, each switch sized 39 dots x 49dots  
cm, will be displayed.  
“EXIT” switch to exit the  
touch switch check menu.  
The touch switch is normal if it is  
highlighted while it is pressed.  
Press a touch switch on the screen. If the touch switch is highlighted while it is  
pressed, the touch switch is normally functioning.  
When the check is finished, press the “EXIT” touch switch. The I/O check menu  
will be redisplayed.  
Reference  
If memory switch setting for the key press sound has been made for ON, the key  
press sound will be made when a touch switch is pressed. The number of pressed  
touch switch will not be notified to the PC/Host.  
ꢃꢋꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Checking the LCD/EL display  
Check the NT600S LCD/EL display by using the menu operation from the System  
Menu as mentioned below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O Check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “LCD” or “EL”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
The LCD/EL displays dots (segments of the screen) line by line beginning with  
the top left corner. When all dots are normally displayed, the I/O Check Menu will  
be redisplayed.  
To cancel the LCD/EL indication check, press any touch switch (anywhere) on  
the screen. The I/O Check Menu will be redisplayed.  
Checking the Backlight (NT600S-ST121 Only)  
Check the Backlight by using the menu operation from the System Menu as men-  
tioned below.  
ꢃꢋꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O Check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Back light”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
IBuzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
When the backlight is operating correctly, it should flash.  
To end the check function, press the [EXIT] touch switch. The NT600S returns to  
the “I/O Check Menu”.  
The EL type does not feature the backlight check function.  
Checking the Communications with the Support Tool/Host  
Execute a NT600S-to-support tool/Host communication check by the menu op-  
eration from the System Menu as mentioned below.  
This check can be executed only for RS-232C communications.  
In direct connection other than the C200H communications, the same connector is  
used for the connection of a support tool and the Host. To execute communication  
check with the support tool, if the Host is connected to the NT600S, first discon-  
nect the cable that connects the Host and connect the support tool to the same  
connector. Execute the check after that.  
ꢃꢋꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O Check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select “Communication I/F”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
Select “Tool Transmit” or  
“RS-232C Transmit”.  
[ COMMUNICATION I/F CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Tool Transmit  
RS-232C Transmit  
(Select “Tool Transmit”)  
ꢃꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
[ TOOL TRANSMIT CHECK ]  
EXIT  
The data received from the connected support tool/Host are displayed in hexa-  
decimal numbers.  
When the check is finished, press the “EXIT” touch switch. Communication I/F  
check menu will be redisplayed.  
Note  
The NT600S uses one connector for connection to both the Support tool and the  
PC/Host. If it is connected to other equipment, remove the connecting cable from  
the connector and connect the cable to the connector for the Support tool/Host.  
Then perform a communication check.  
4-9-2  
Checking the NT600S DIP Switch Settings  
Display the NT600S DIP switch settings by using the menu operation from the  
System Menu as mentioned below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “I/O check”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
ꢃꢋꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Select “DIP-Switch”.  
[ I/O CHECK MENU ]  
Quit  
Backlight  
LED  
Communication I/F  
DIP-Switch  
Buzzer  
Touch Switch  
LCD Display  
The NT600S DIP switch sta-  
tuses are displayed.  
[ DIP-SWITCH STATUS ]  
1.Forced Memory Init.  
2.Language  
OFF  
English  
Enable  
3.Mode Change  
4.Reserved  
5.Reserved  
6.Reserved  
7.Reserved  
8.Battery Low Check  
OFF  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
ON  
EXIT  
OFF  
To exit the DIP switch settings display, press the “EXIT” touch switch.  
Note  
If the DIP switch settings have been changed when the NT600S is powered, reset  
the power to the NT600S. The changes with the DIP switches become effective  
only after the power supply is reset.  
4-9-3  
Checking the PT Setting Status  
Checking the PT setting Status  
Display the NT600S settings by using the menu operation from the System Menu  
as mentioned below.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
ꢃꢋꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Select “PT Setting Status”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
<Host link>  
<NT link (1:1)>  
[ PT SETTING STATUS ]  
[ PT SETTING STATUS ]  
Communication Method Host Link  
Communication Method NT Link  
PT Control Area  
PT Notification Area  
Automatic Reset  
Resume Function  
Host Link Speed  
EXIT  
DM 0010  
DM 0020  
OFF  
OFF  
19200bps  
PT Control Area  
PT Notification Area  
Automatic Reset  
Resume Function  
DM 0010  
DM 0020  
OFF  
OFF  
EXIT  
<NT link (1:N)>  
[ PT SETTING STATUS ]  
Communication Method NT Link (1:N)  
PT Control Area  
PT Notification Area  
Automatic Reset  
Resume Function  
PT UNIT No.  
DM 0010  
DM 0020  
OFF  
OFF  
7
EXIT  
*
If no unit is set at the PC, “0” will be displayed.  
<C200H direct communication>  
<RS-232C>  
[ PT SETTING STATUS ]  
Communication Method  
Automatic Reset  
[ PT SETTING STATUS ]  
Communication Method C200H  
RS-232C  
ON  
Resume Function  
ON  
PT Control Area  
PT Notification Area  
Automatic Reset  
Resume Function  
UNIT No.  
DM 0010  
DM 0020  
OFF  
OFF  
9
Data Bit Length  
Stop Bit Length  
Parity Bit  
Flow Control  
RS-232C Speed  
7 bits  
1 bit  
Even  
XON/XOFF  
2400bps  
EXIT  
EXIT  
*
If no unit is set at the PC, “0” will be displayed.  
The current NT600S setting status will be displayed.  
Pressing the [EXIT] touch switch will exit the “PT Setting Status 1” display and  
cause the NT600S to return to the “Maintenance Menu”.  
ꢃꢋꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
4-9-4  
Display History  
The display history function records the number of times that screens for which a  
display history attribute has been set by the support tool are displayed, and dis-  
plays the accumulated occurrence data either in order of occurrence or order of  
frequency format.  
Recording the Display History  
The display history is recorded using the procedure given below.  
Operation 1. Setting the screen attribute  
When creating a screen using the support tool, set the display history record-  
ing attribute for the screen if its display history should be recorded. When set-  
ting the attribute, register a message no longer than 24 characters expressing  
the contents of the screen.  
A display history is recorded only for screens for which the display history re-  
cording attribute is set.  
2. Initializing the display history data memory  
Before starting to record the display history, initialize (clear) the display history  
data memory either by sending the display history data memory initialization  
command from the Host (page 76) or by selecting the “Screen Data Memory”  
initialization menu in the Maintenance Mode (page 72).  
If the memory becomes full of history data, the history data for new occur-  
rences cannot be recorded.  
3. Executing the display history recording  
If a screen for which the display history recording attribute has been set is dis-  
played during operation, the display history data is recorded in the NT600S.  
In the display history, the following data relating to the displayed screen is stored  
in the memory.  
- Screen number  
- Message expressing the contents of the screen  
Each time a screen number for which the display history recording attribute has  
been set is specified by the PC/Host, the data indicated above is recorded in the  
corresponding data area.  
The data recording capacity is 1023 screens if the display history is recorded in the  
order of occurrence and 255 times per screen if it is recorded in the order of fre-  
quency. Note that only the screen number and the message are recorded.  
Reference  
The recorded data is retained even when the power is turned off since it is backed  
up by battery. However, if no battery is installed, the recorded data is lost when the  
power is turned off.  
ꢃꢃꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Reading the Recorded Display History  
Before starting to record the display history, initialize (clear) the display history  
data memory, either by sending the display history data memory initialization com-  
mand from the Host (page 76) or selecting “Screen Data Memory” initialization  
menu in the Maintenance Mode (page 72).  
If the memory becomes full of history data, the history data for new occurrences  
cannot be recorded.  
Display the recorded display history using the following menu operation starting  
from the System Menu.  
Select “Maintenance Mode”.  
[ SYSTEM MENU ]  
Quit  
Transmit Mode  
Maintenance Mode  
Select “History Display”.  
[ MAINTENANCE MENU ]  
Quit  
Display History  
PT Setting Status  
I/O Check  
Memory Init.  
Memory Switches  
Select either “Time Order” or  
“Frequent Order”.  
[ DISPLAY HISTORY MENU ]  
Quit  
Time Order  
Frequent Order  
ꢃꢃꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3-9  
Display in time order  
The recorded display history is displayed in the order the screens were dis-  
played.  
No. Freq.  
Message  
No. Freq.  
Message  
24  
24  
4
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
Workpiece misalignment A.2  
Workpiece misalignment A.2  
Valve abnormality  
26  
25  
35  
26  
35  
26  
26  
35  
35  
4
Workpiece misalignment B.1  
Workpiece misalignment A.3  
Frequent stop  
Workpiece misalignment B.1  
Frequent stop  
Workpiece misalignment B.1  
Workpiece misalignment B.1  
Compressor pressure upper limit  
Compressor pressure upper limit  
Valve abnormality  
Workpiece misalignment A.1  
Workpiece misalignment A.3  
Frequent stop  
23  
25  
35  
EXIT PREV. NEXT  
Page. 1/1  
Screen number  
- Up to 40 items of recorded data are displayed in one screen.  
- If the recorded data cannot be displayed in one screen, it is possible to scroll  
the screen by pressing the [NEXT] or [PREV.] touch switch.  
Reference  
If there is no display history recorded, the following message is displayed.  
“Display History not Found”  
- Pressing the [EXIT] touch switch causes the NT600S to return to the “Display  
History Menu”.  
- If the display history is displayed in time order (order of occurrence), the dis-  
play frequency data is not displayed.  
Display in frequent order  
No. Freq.  
Message  
No. Freq.  
Message  
26  
35  
4
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
4)  
3)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
2)  
1)  
Workpiece misalignment B.1  
Frequent stop  
Valve abnormality  
35  
24  
25  
23  
Compressor pressure upper limit  
Workpiece misalignment A.2  
Workpiece misalignment A.3  
Workpiece misalignment A.1  
EXIT PREV. NEXT  
Frequency data  
Page. 1/1  
Screen number  
- If the same message appears more than once, the message is displayed in  
ascending order of the screen numbers.  
- Up to 40 items of recorded data are displayed on one screen.  
- If the recorded data cannot be displayed on one screen, scroll the screen by  
pressing the [NEXT] or [PREV.] touch switch.  
Reference  
If there is no display history recorded, the following message is displayed.  
“Display History not Found”  
- Pressing the [EXIT] touch switch will cause the NT600S to return to the “Dis-  
play History Menu”.  
ꢃꢃꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 5  
NT600S Functions  
This section describes the functions of the NT600S.  
5-1 Creating and Transmitting Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
5-1-1 Setting the Support Tool for Use with the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
5-1-2 Creating Screen Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
5-2 Outline of Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
5-2-1 NT600S Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
5-2-2 Characters and Figures Which can be Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120  
5-2-3 Communication with the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122  
5-3 Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
5-3-1 Classification of Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
5-3-2 Screen Attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
5-4 Memory Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128  
5-4-1 Character-String Memory Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128  
5-4-2 Numeral Memory Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129  
5-5 Bar Graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
5-5-1 Bar Graph Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
5-6 Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
5-6-1 Lamp Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
5-7 Touch Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138  
5-7-1 Functions of Touch Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139  
5-7-2 Standalone Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
5-7-3 System Key Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
5-8 Numeral Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
5-8-1 Function of Numeral Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
5-8-2 Types of Numeral Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144  
5-8-3 Creating Numeric Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
5-8-4 Using Numeric Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148  
5-8-5 Using Thumb Wheel Keys (Only When Direct Connection Ver.5 is Specified) . . 150  
ꢃꢃꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-1  
5-1  
Creating and Transmitting Screen Data  
This section describes briefly the support tool settings required for creating screen  
data and the screen data creation procedure.  
Reference  
For the details of the support tool and screen data creation, refer to the “NT-series  
Support Tool Operation Manual” (V028-E1-01).  
5-1-1  
Setting the Support Tool for Use with the NT600S  
To create the screen data for the NT600S, make settings with the support tool for  
use with the NT600S.  
Select “Tool Settings”.  
ꢃꢃꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-1  
Note  
To create the NT600S screen data, make settings in the “Tool Settings” screen as  
follows.  
PT Type  
:NT600S  
:128 KB  
Memory Size  
Direct Access  
:When using Host link/NT link/C200H direct communication:  
Ver.4 or Ver.5.  
When using RS-232C: “None”  
Direct Macn Type:OMRON  
5-1-2  
Creating Screen Data  
Screen Data Creation Method The screen data is created by using the support tool. The support tool registers the  
screen data used with one NT600S to one file.  
Screen data can be created by one of the following three methods:  
creating a new file;  
editing an existing file;  
reading and editing selected screens from an existing file.  
Screen Data Creation Procedure  
The following gives the basic screen data creation procedure. Required settings  
and reference pages are given for each step of the procedure.  
Select “Tool Settings” in the Main Menu to display the “Tool Settings” screen.  
Settings of PT type, memory size, direct connection are made in this screen.  
Refer to “Setting the support tool for use with the NT600S” on the previous  
page.  
ꢃꢃꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-1  
Select “Edit Screen”.  
Select a file used for storing the screen data for the NT600S in the “File List”  
screen.  
To create a new file, select “New File”.  
To edit an existing file, select a file to edit.  
Select “New File” and press [Enter]. Enter filename on completion of creation.  
Select “Screen Creation”.  
Select a screen number to edit in the selected file in the “Screen List” screen.  
To read the screen data from other file, press the [F5] (Read) function key.  
When using host link/NT link/C200H direct communication, set the direct connec-  
tion information before selecting the screen number.  
While in the “Screen List” screen, press the [F10] (Next page) key, and then,  
the [F4] (Direct) key to display the “Direct Connection Data Setting” window in  
which the head words in the PC used to allocate the following areas.  
ꢃꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-1  
PT status control area: Section 5-4 NT600S Status Control (page 192)  
PT status notify area: Section 5-5 Notification of the Operating Status to the PC  
(page 197)  
Numeral memory table: 5-2 Memory Tables and Bar Graph (page 164)  
character-string memory table: 5-2 Memory Tables and Bar Graph (page 164)  
Select a screen number and  
press [Enter].  
Create screen data in the Edit screen of the support tool. Data of one screen can  
be created by registering (laying out) the following display elements and attributes  
on the screen.  
Numeral display:  
Set numbers in the numeral memory table. ..... “Numeral Memory Table” (page 129)  
Character-string display:  
Set numbers in the character-string memory table. ...... “Character-String  
Memory Table” (page 128)  
Lamp:  
Host link/NT link/C200H direct ..... Specify allocated bits.  
RS-232C ............... Specify lamp address. ..... Section 4-6 Lamps (page 135)  
Touch switch:  
Host link/NT link/C200H direct  
....................... Specify allocated bits for control and notification.  
RS-232C ........ Specify touch switch number. ....... Section 4-7 Touch Switches  
(page 138)  
Bar graph:  
Set numbers in the numeral memory table. ..... Section 4-5 Bar Graphs (page 131)  
Numeral setting:  
Set numbers in the numeral memory table. ...... Section 4-8 Numeral Setting  
(page 143)  
Character input: Input fixed character-strings.  
ꢃꢃꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-1  
[Exiting the Edit screen]  
Return to the “Screen List”.  
[To the File Selection]  
Enter filename to newly created screen data.  
Return to the “File List”.  
Pressing the [F8] (Start-up screen) key allows setting of the screen number to be  
displayed when the NT600S is booted. (Only effective when using RS-232C)  
Transmitting Screen Data to the NT600S  
Transmit the screen data created by using the support tool to the NT600S screen  
data memory.  
Connect the NT600S to the support tool and set the NT600S to Transmit Mode.  
Then, press the [F6] (Transmit) key in the “File List” screen to transmit the created  
screen data to the NT600S.  
ꢃꢃꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-2  
It is also possible to transmit the data in screen units by pressing [F10] (Next), then  
[F6] (Transmit) on the “Screen List” screen. However, the memory table data and  
direct information are not transferred when this function is used. Use the transmis-  
sion screen to change and add this information and transmit it with the other in-  
formation.  
For the connection procedure to the support tool, refer to Section 2-3 Connecting  
to the Support Tool (page 30). For the transmission of the screen data, refer to  
Section 3-5 Registering the Screen Data (page 79).  
Caution  
When transferring the data in units of screens, if there are changes in memory  
table and/or direct connection, transfer such data along with the screen data.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
5-2  
Outline of Functions  
5-2-1  
NT600S Screen  
This section gives the outline of the screen which is the basis of all NT600S func-  
tions.  
For specific operation procedure using Host/NT link or C200H direct such as  
screen switching, refer to Section 4-3 Screen Display” (page 124).  
For actual operations such as displaying the specified screen using RS-232C, re-  
fer to Section 6-2 Commands Sent by the Host (page 207).  
Composition of the Screen The NT600S screen is composed of horizontal 640 dots x vertical 400 dots. Each  
dot is set by the combination of the X (horizontal) and Y (vertical) coordinates. The  
origin of coordinates (0, 0) is set at the top left corner of the screen.  
0 X coordinate (horizontal)  
639  
0
Y coordinate  
(vertical)  
Coordinates  
(x, y)  
639, 399  
399  
Screen Management  
The screens displayed on the NT600S are managed by the screen numbers.  
Screen numbers are set when the screen data are created by using the support  
tool. Up to 1000 screens can be set by allocating arbitrarily selected numbers 1 to  
1000.  
The display screens can be switched or the start-up screen can beset by designat-  
ing the screen number from the PC/Host.  
Special Screen Number  
Screen number “0” is reserved for the system as the no-display screen. Select this  
to display nothing on the NT600S screen  
ꢃꢃꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-2  
5-2-2  
Characters and Figures Which can be Displayed  
The NT600S screen can display characters, figures, and other various elements.  
This section describes the types and attributes of the characters and figures which  
can be displayed and do not need to be changed at all.  
For the settings, display, and use of the characters, numeric values, and graphs  
which change according to the system operation status and other conditions, refer  
to Section 4-4 Memory Table (page 128) and Section 5-2 Memory Tables and Bar  
Graph (page 164).  
The power of expression of the screen can be increased by giving various attrib-  
utes such as the enlarged or reverse display to the characters and figures.  
The character and figure attributes can be set in the edit screen when creating the  
screen data by using the support tool.  
When displaying the characters using a command from a Host, character attrib-  
utes are displayed in accordance with the enlarged size, which is obtained by  
executing the command, and the display attribute.  
Types and Attributes of Characters and Figures  
The following types of characters can be input by using the support tool and be  
displayed during operation.  
Dots  
Character  
Maximum Number of  
Characters Displayed in One  
Screen (without overwriting)  
(vertical x  
Character Set  
Type  
horizontal)  
Half height  
8 x 8  
Alphanumerics and  
symbols  
80 characters x 50 lines  
(4000 characters)  
character  
Normal  
8 x 16  
Alphanumerics and  
symbols  
80 characters x 25 lines  
(2000 characters)  
characters  
Create by using the  
support tool  
Marks  
16 x 16  
When displaying characters by sending a command from a Host, only half size  
characters and normal size characters can be displayed.  
Marks  
A mark is a graphic pattern created by combining 16 x 16 dots by using the sup-  
port tool. Marks can be handled the same as the wide size characters. Up to 64  
patterns can be defined within the total screen area using 2-byte codes (FF20 to  
FF5F).  
ꢃꢄꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-2  
Enlarged display of the characters and marks  
The characters and marks can be enlarged to the following scales.  
Double Double  
x1 scale  
width  
scale  
height x4 scale x9 scale x16 scale  
scale  
x64 scale  
Reference  
Smoothing  
The characters and marks enlarged to the x4 scale or larger are displayed with  
the outline automatically smoothed. This function is called “smoothing”.  
Note that smoothing processing is not performed if characters are displayed at  
x4 or a larger scale by giving an enlarging scale specifying command from a  
Host.  
Reverse and flashing display  
Reverse display:  
Flashing display:  
The display brightness of the character and the  
background is reversed comparing with the  
normal display.  
Characters are displayed as they flash. The  
normal display alternates with no-display.  
Reverse and flashing display: The reverse display alternates with the normal  
display.  
Types and Attributes of the Figures  
The following types of figure can be input either by using the support tool or by  
giving a command from the Host, and be displayed during operation. Continuous  
straight lines including up to 256 vertexes can be drawn (up to 255 straight lines  
can be connected).  
Continuous straight lines  
Circle  
ꢃꢄꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-2  
5-2-3  
Communication with the Host  
Communication with Host Link, NT Link, and C200H Direct Communication  
Using the direct communication function, bits and words can be allocated without  
restriction to the PC memory area, and data can then be directly written to and  
read from these bits and words. This makes the following possible:  
Control and notification of display elements  
Control and notification of NT600S statuses  
Screen switching  
Ascertainment of the screen number of the displayed screen  
Memory table operations  
For details on the actual operations involved, refer to Section 5 “Using Host Link/  
NT Link/C200H Direct”.  
Communication Using RS-232C  
In RS-232C communication, by sending and receiving commands via anRS-232C  
interface, the following functions of the NT600S can be utilized from various types  
of host.  
Control and notifications of display elements  
Control and notification of NT600S statuses  
Memory table operations  
Display/deletion of characters and graphics  
For details on the actual operations involved, refer to Section 6 “Using the  
RS-232C Interface Unit”.  
Controllable NT600S Functions  
The following statuses of the NT600S can be controlled.  
Screen display  
Continuous and intermittent buzzers  
:Sounds and stops the buzzer  
:Displays and clears screens  
Backlight mode  
:Switches on the backlight on/causes the  
backlight to flash  
For details on the actual procedures used for these types of control, refer to Sec-  
tion 5-4 “NT600S Status Control” (page 192), and also “Screen Display Control”  
(page 214) and “Buzzer Control” (page 214).  
ꢃꢄꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-2  
Ascertainable NT600S Statuses  
The following NT600S statuses can be ascertained.  
PT operating status  
Screen number  
:Whether the NT600S is operating or stopped  
:Screen number of the currently displayed screen  
Numeral setting input  
:Whether a numerical value has been input by  
numeral setting  
For details on the actual method for detecting these operating statuses, refer to  
Section 5-5 “Notification of the Operating Status to the PC (Determining the  
NT600S Operating Status)” (page 197), and also “Screen Number Response”  
(page 217) and “Notifying Input to the Numeral Memory Table” (page 217).  
Caution  
In order to ensure system safety, be sure to periodically read the PT operating  
status bit at the host during operation to confirm that the PT is always operating  
correctly.  
ꢃꢄꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-3  
5-3  
Screen Display  
This section describes the screen information required for the operation with the  
NT600S.  
5-3-1  
Classification of Screens  
The NT600S is provided with the following types of screens which are classified by  
the display method.  
Normal screen  
Overlapping screen  
Continuous screen  
The screen type is set with each screen in the “Screen Selection” screen of the  
support tool. Select a screen type according to the purpose, and create characters  
and figures on the screen. The details of each screen type are given below.  
Normal Screen  
A normal screen is the basic screen of the NT600S. It is not necessary to select a  
screen type (overlapping or consecutive) when to create the screen data on a nor-  
mal screen.  
When a normal screen is selected, existing screens will be erased and a normal  
screen will be displayed.  
Overlapping Screen  
Several normal screens can be overlapped and displayed as one screen. A group  
of overlapped screens is called an “overlapping screen”.  
Several normal screens are displayed in the order of screen numbers which have  
been designated to each screen and form an overlapping screen. Up to eight  
screens can be overlapped to form one overlapping screen. The base screen used  
for making an overlapping screen is called a “parent screen”, and a bunch of  
screens which are laid over the parent screen are called “child screens”.  
All display elements can be used on a parent screen.  
Reference  
The screen attributes such as a buzzer attribute set in the parent screen become  
effective in an overlapping screen.  
[Example overlapping screen]  
Screen #10  
This is an  
(1)  
Screen #8  
Screen #7  
This is an  
overlapping  
screen.  
(2)  
(3)  
overlapping  
Screen #25  
screen.  
Parent screen: #8  
Child screens: #10, #7, and #25  
When screen #8 is designated, screen #8 becomes the parent screen and the  
child screens #10, #7, and #25 are displayed over the parent screenin that order.  
ꢃꢄꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-3  
Reference  
Only one numeral setting screen which allows numeric values to be set on the  
NT600S screen can be registered as a child screen. For the numeral setting,  
refer to Section 4-8 Numeral Setting (page 143).  
Make sure that the touch switches and numbers set in the normal screens do  
not overlap in an overlapping screen. If the set positions of the touch switches  
and/or numbers in the normal screens overlap with each other, such settings  
may sometimes not be effective as intended. Use the support tool and make  
sure that the set positions do not overlap with each other.  
Continuous Screens  
A group of normal screens which are related in series and canbe switched consec-  
utively is called the “continuous screens”. Up to eight screens can be registered to  
one screen as a group of continuous screens.  
The base screen used for registering the continuous screens is called a “parent  
screen”, and the registered continuous screens are called “child screens”.  
The current screen number and the total number of continuous screens can be  
displayed in the top right corner of the screen. This is called the “page number dis-  
play”.  
Reference  
Reference  
The page number is set when creating the screen data by using the support tool.  
Refer to the “NT-series Support Tool Operation Manual” (V028-E1- ).  
All display elements except “numeral setting” can be used in the continuous  
screens.  
The screen attributes set in the parent screen become effective in the continuous  
screens.  
[Example continuous screens]  
1/3  
Screen #20  
Continuous  
screen (1)  
[] touch switch  
[] touch switch  
2/3  
Screen #15  
[] touch switch  
Screen #5  
Continuous  
screen (2)  
[] touch switch  
3/3  
Continuous  
screen (3)  
Parent screen: #10  
Child screens: #20, #15, and #5  
When screen #10 (continuous screen) is designated, screen #20 whichis page1  
of the continuous screens will be displayed. Screen #15 or #5 can be displayed  
by using the touch switches. Since screen #10 has been set for the continuous  
screens, that screen cannot be displayed as an individual screen.  
ꢃꢄꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-3  
Switching the Continuous Screens by Using the Touch Switches  
Continuous screens can be switched by using the [ ] and [ ] touch switches which  
have the system key functions.  
When creating the screen, create touch switches [ ] and [ ] to which the system  
key functions are allocated. (Refer to “System key functions” (page 142).)  
1/3  
Production Status  
Line A: Normal  
Line B: Normal  
5-3-2  
Screen Attributes  
Each screen can be set with a specific function by designating a screen attribute,  
so that the specific function can be executed by displaying the screen. For exam-  
ple, by displaying a screen to which a “buzzer attribute” has been set, the buzzer of  
the NT600S starts sounding.  
Reference  
Use the support tool to set the screen attributes.  
The following several attributes can be set with one screen.  
Buzzer Attribute  
This attribute will become effective to sound the buzzer in the NT600S when the  
screen to which this attribute has been set is displayed. The buzzer sound can be  
set as follows:  
No:  
Buzzer does not sound when the screen is displayed.  
Buzzer sounds continuously.  
Continuous sound:  
Intermittent sound:  
Buzzer sounds intermittently at constant intervals.  
Reference  
The buzzer sound is set with the NT600S memory switch. The buzzer can also be  
set by using the PC/Host. Refer to “Using the buzzer” (page 94) for the buzzer  
setting using the memory switch.  
To stop the buzzer by using the screen operation, create a [buzzer stop] system  
key as a touch switch.  
Numeral Setting Attribute  
Select whether the numeric keys are automatically displayed or the numeric keys  
are created at arbitrary positions on the numeral setting screen. The following two  
numeral setting attributes are used.  
System: The numeric keys registered to the system are automatically dis-  
played.  
User:  
The numeric keys can be created at any arbitrary positions.  
ꢃꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-3  
Reference  
The screen attributes are set for each screen by using the “screen selection”  
screen of the support tool.  
The support tool displays “alarm”, “backlight color”, etc. which are not used with  
the NT600S.  
If the numeral setting attribute on the NT600S has been set for “system”, the  
touch switches [ENT], [], and [] which are allocated to the system besides the  
numeric keys need to be created. (System key functions (page 142))  
Bit input attributes (RS-232C communication only)  
Select whether the touch switch number or bit information is notified to the host  
when a touch switch is pressed. There are two types of bit input attribute in the  
screen attributes, as indicated below.  
Off  
:Bit control when a touch switch is pressed is invalid.  
The status of the touch switch is notified using its number.  
Touch SW :Bit control when a touch is pressed is valid.  
The status of the touch switch is notified using bit information.  
Backlight attributes (NT600S-ST121 only)  
Select whether the backlight is lit or flashes when the screen is displayed. There  
are two types of backlight attribute in the screen attributes, as indicated below:  
Lit  
:Backlight is lit when the screen is displayed.  
Flashing :Backlight flashes when the screen is displayed.  
This attribute is invalid with the EL display type NT600S-ST211.  
ꢃꢄꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-4  
5-4  
Memory Tables  
The NT600S has the “character-string memory table” for the character data and  
the “numeral memory table” for numeric data which can be written and updated by  
the PC/Host.  
Reference  
The contents of the memory tables can be set by using the support tool when dis-  
playing the memory tables on the screen or by editing the table.  
5-4-1  
Character-String Memory Table  
The character-string memory table is an NT600S internal memory used to store  
the character data. Up to 256 character-string memory tables can be used, and up  
to 20 full size characters (40 bytes) can be stored in one memory table. The char-  
acter-string memory tables at up to 50 positions can be registered in one screen.  
Displaying a Character-string  
The character-string memory tables are registered with table numbers 0 to 255.  
When creating the screen data by using the support tool, set the position on the  
screen to display a character-string and also set a character-string number to be  
displayed.  
When the NT600S is operated, the screen displays the contents of the character-  
string memory table.  
In the direct connection of Ver. 5, it is possible to display the character-string by  
designating the number of the character-string memory table using the numeric  
memory table instead of directly changing the contents of the character-string  
memory table. (indirect designation)  
For the procedure for changing the character-string in the table, refer to “Changing  
Displayed Numerals or Character Strings (Changing the Contents of Allocated  
Words)” (page 170, 172) or “Write Character-string Memory Table” (page 208).  
If the RS-232C communication is used, it is possible to display the character-string  
by the Host instruction disregarding of the screen presently displayed (terminal  
function). Refer to “Specify Displayed Characters” (page 225).  
Characters and Figures Which can be Displayed  
The power of expression of the screen can be increased by giving various attrib-  
utes such as the enlarged or reverse display to the characters of the character-  
string memory table.  
The character attributes can be set in the edit screen when creating the screen  
data by using the support tool.  
The following types of characters can be displayed on the NT600S:  
Dots  
(vertical x  
horizontal)  
Maximum Number of  
Characters Displayed in One  
Screen (without overwriting)  
Character  
Type  
Character Set  
Half height  
character  
Alphanumerics and  
symbols  
80 characters x 50 lines  
(4000 characters)  
8 x 8  
8 x 16  
16 x 16  
Normal  
characters  
Alphanumerics and  
symbols  
80 characters x 25 lines  
(2000 characters)  
Create by using the  
support tool  
Marks  
ꢃꢄꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-4  
Enlarged display of the characters and marks  
The characters and marks can be enlarged to the following scales.  
Double width scale, Double height scale, x4 scale, x9 scale, x16 scale, x64 scale  
Smoothing  
The characters and marks enlarged to the x4 scale or larger are displayed with  
the outline automatically smoothed. This function is called “smoothing”.  
Reverse and flashing display  
Reverse display:  
Flashing display:  
The display brightness of the character and the  
background is reversed comparing with the  
normal display.  
Characters are displayed as they flash. The  
normal display alternates with no-display.  
Reverse and flashing display: The reverse display alternates with the normal  
display.  
5-4-2  
Numeral Memory Table  
The numeral memory table is an NT600S internal memory used to store the nu-  
meral data. Up to 512 numeral memory tables can be used, and up to eight digits  
(four bytes) of numeral data (including signs) can be stored in one numeral  
memory table. The numeral memory tables at up to 50 positions can be registered  
in one screen.  
Displaying a Numeral  
The numeral memory tables are registered with table numbers 0 to 511.  
When creating the screen data by using the support tool, set the position on the  
screen to display a numeral and also set a numeral number to be displayed.  
When the NT600S is operated, the screen displays the contents of the numeral  
memory table.  
Also, by relating the numeral memory tables with the bar graphs, the bar graphs  
corresponding to the data of the numeral memory tables can be displayed.  
ꢃꢄꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-4  
Numerals Which can be Displayed  
The power of expression of the screen can be increased by giving various attrib-  
utes such as the enlarged or reverse display to the numerals of the numeral  
memory table.  
Reference  
The numeral attributes can be set in the edit screen when creating the screen data  
by using the support tool.  
The following types of numerals can be displayed on the NT600S:  
Digits of the whole numbers: 1 to 8 digits  
Digits of the decimal fraction: 0 to 7 digits  
Character sizes:  
Enlarged display:  
Half, normal  
Double width, double height, x4, x9, x16, x64  
The characters enlarged to the x4 scale or larg-  
er are displayed with the outline automatically  
smoothed. This function is called “smoothing”.  
Sign display setting  
Decimal/hexadecimal display setting  
Zero suppress setting  
Reference  
Zero suppress setting  
The numeral data are displayed in designated display areas as right-aligned. If the  
number of digits of a numeral data is smaller than that of the display area, number  
“0”s will be displayed at the vacant digits. These “0”s will not be displayed if the  
zero suppress setting is made for “Yes”.  
ꢃꢅꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-5  
5-5  
Bar Graphs  
The contents of the numeral memory tables of the NT600S can be displayed as  
bar graphs as well as numeral data.  
Setting for bar graphs is made when creating the screen data using the support  
tool.  
The following describes the kinds of bar graphs that can be displayed.  
The display data of bar graph can be changed by changing the contents of the nu-  
meral memory table.  
For the procedure for changing the data of the bar graph presently displayed, refer  
to “Upgrading Bar Graphs (Changing the Contents of Allocated Words)” (page  
179) or “Write Numeral Memory Table” (page 209).  
5-5-1  
Bar Graph Functions  
The bar graph function displays a value in a bar graph form as a percentage to the  
specified value according to the contents of a numeral memory table. Up to 50 bar  
graphs can be registered in one screen.  
Reference table  
The numeral memory table used as the reference for the bar graph display can  
be set.  
Reference  
The support tool has the “direct” and “indirect” options for the reference method of  
the numeral memory table. However, the NT600S recognizes the “direct” method  
only.  
The bar graph display cannot use hexadecimal numbers. If hexadecimal numbers  
are set in the reference numeral table, the bar graph cannot be displayed. Use  
caution not to write hexadecimal numbers except the minus sign “F” to the refer-  
ence numeral table.  
Bar Graph Attributes  
Reference  
The following attributes can be set with the NT600S for the bar graph display:  
Use the support tool to make settings for the bar graph display when creating the  
screen data.  
Position and size  
The display position and size (length) of a bar graph can be set.  
The width of the bar graph can be set in the range of 2 to 255 dots.  
ꢃꢅꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-5  
Orientation and incremental direction  
The orientation and incremental direction of the bar graph can be selected from  
those mentioned below.  
(up): The bar graph increments upward in the vertical orientation.  
(down):The bar graph increments downward in the vertical orientation.  
(left): The bar graph increments to the left in the horizontal orientation.  
(right):The bar graph increments to the right in the horizontal orientation.  
Direction: ↑  
Direction: →  
Graph frame  
Select whether or not the graph frame (boundary line of a graph display area)  
which indicates the effective display range is displayed.  
This frame is not displayed if  
“Graph frame: No” has been set.  
Setting the 100 % value and % display  
Set a value which corresponds to 100 % for the “100 % value”. The available  
value range is “0 to 99999999” (max. eight digits). For the “% display”, whether  
or not the proportion (percentage) of the reference numeral memory table value  
to the “100 % value” is displayed in a numeral can be selected. The display value  
is calculated as follows:  
“% display” value = Numeral memory table value  
“100 % value” x 100  
For the font and attributes used for the numeral display, refer to “Numerals which  
can be displayed” (page 130).  
Sign display and display method  
Select whether or not the bar graph which indicates a value below 0 % is dis-  
played.  
ꢃꢅꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-5  
[To display a value below 0 %: Sign display “Yes”]  
The bar graph is displayed in the range of --100 % to 100 %. The middle of the bar  
graph indicates 0 %.  
% display  
--60 %  
--100 %  
0 %  
100 %  
[Not to display a value below 0 %: Sign display “No”]  
The bar graph is displayed in the range of 0 % to 100 %. The end of the bar graph  
indicates 0 %. Values below 0 % are indicated as 0 %.  
% display  
60 %  
0 %  
100 %  
Differences in the bar graph display method according to the % values  
The bar graph display method varies according to the % value range.  
(1) When the % value is in the minus range  
The display varies as follows according to the sign display setting:  
Sign display “No”: Displayed as 0 %.  
Sign display “Yes”: Displayed in the minus range.  
ꢃꢅꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-5  
(2) When the absolute value of the % value is in the range of 100 % to 999 %  
The % value is displayed as it is.  
Sign display “No”: The display will be as mentioned below according to  
the graph frame setting.  
When the frame is displayed:  
% display  
999 %  
Graph width: 8 dots  
0 %  
100 %  
When the frame is not displayed:  
% display  
999 %  
1-dot-wide space  
Graph width: 8 dots  
0 %  
100 %  
Sign display “Yes”: A value below --100 % will be displayed in the minus  
direction as shown above.  
(3) When the absolute value of the % value is above 1000 %  
The bar graph will be displayed the same as (2) above.  
The % value is displayed as follows according to the sign display setting:  
Sign display “No”:  
Sign display “Yes”:  
%
%
ꢃꢅꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-6  
5-6  
Lamps  
The NT600S has the “lamp” function used to simply display the PC bit status.  
Set the lamp function when creating the screen data using the support tool.  
The following describes the kinds of lamps that can be displayed.  
The status of the lamps (lit (flashing) or unlit) can be changed by the Host instruc-  
tions.  
5-6-1  
Lamp Functions  
The lamps are the graphic areas whose method of display can be changed by us-  
ing the PC/Host. Available display methods are “lit”, “unlit”, and “flash“. Up to 255  
lamps can be registered in one screen.  
The display status (lit, unlit, and flash) which are registered when creating the  
screen data can be switched according to the ON/OFF of the PC bit status.  
PC  
Host  
Unlit  
Lit  
Lamp Attributes  
The following attributes can be set with the lamp. Use the support tool to set the  
lamp attributes.  
Shape  
Select from the square and circle shapes. The display size can be freely se-  
lected.  
Square  
Circle  
Frame  
Select whether or not the boundary line (frame) of the lamp display area is dis-  
played. If the frame is not set, only the guide display message for the lamp is  
displayed when the lamp is not lit (or flashing). If the guide display message is  
not set, nothing is displayed.  
Lit and flashing  
Select whether the lamp is lit (reverse display) or flashing (reverse flashing)  
when the lamp is turned ON by the PC/Host.  
ꢃꢅꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-6  
Guide display message  
Lamps can be displayed with the guide display messages.  
The guide display message attributes are the same as that for the “character  
display”. Refer to “Characters and Figures which can be Displayed” (page  
128).  
Frame and lit/flashing  
The display method of “lit/flashing” varies according to the frame setting.  
Frame is set:  
Only the area in the frame will be lit/flashing.  
The area including the frame will be lit/flashing.  
Frame is not set:  
[Frame is set]  
[Frame is not set]  
Unlit  
Unlit  
Lit  
Lit  
Flash  
Flash  
Area inside the frame  
flashes.  
Area including the frame  
flashes.  
Controlling lamps in a batch  
Multiple lamps can be lit or flashed in a batch by registering multiple lamp alloca-  
tions to the same screen.  
[Example of batch lighting]  
Set the same bit number or lamp number for lamps L1 to L5.  
L1  
L2  
L3  
L1  
L2  
L4  
L5  
L3  
L4  
L5  
ꢃꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-6  
When a lamp is overlapped with a memory table display  
The guide display message for a lamp is a fixed character-string. If you want to  
change the lamp guide display in accordance with some condition, overlap the dis-  
play area of a numeral memory table or character-string memory table with the  
lamp. However, note that -- as shown below -- different results will be achieved  
depending on the timing of the lighting of the lamp and the updating of the memory  
table. Bear this in mind when creating the control program.  
Example 1 :Lamp lit after the memory table is updated  
Lamp OFF  
Lamp OFF  
Lamp ON  
PT  
OMRON  
PT  
Memory table  
updated  
Lamp turned  
ON  
Lamp  
Character-string memory  
table display area  
The characters are  
displayed white on black.  
Example 2 :Memory table updated while lamp is lit  
Lamp OFF  
Lamp ON  
Lamp ON  
OMRON  
OMRON  
PT  
Lamp turned  
ON  
Memory table  
updated  
Lamp  
Character-string memory  
table display area  
The characters are  
displayed white on black.  
The memory table display  
area of the lit lamp is  
overwritten.  
ꢃꢅꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-7  
5-7  
Touch Switches  
The NT600S has a function whereby input operations can be performed by using  
touch panels displayed on the screen. NT600S screens can be switched, or bit  
information sent to the PC, by pressing (lightly touching) the “touch switches” in a  
panel.  
The touch switches can also be made to light up (or flash) and go off like lamps.  
Touch switches are set when creating the screen data with the support tool.  
This section describes the touch switches that can be displayed, and explains the  
screen switching function and the system key function.  
For details on how the status of the currently displayed touch switch is notified to  
the Host, refer to “Lit (Flashing) and Unlit Touch Switch Statuses (Changing the  
Status of Allocated Bits)” on page 185, “Lamp and Touch Switch Display (Bit Spec-  
ification)” on page 211, and “Lamp and Touch Switch display (Number Specifica-  
tion)” on page 212.  
For details on how the statuses of touch switches are ascertained by the Host, re-  
fer to “Notifying the Host that a Switch has been Pressed (Determining Touch  
Switch Status)” on page 185, and “Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Enqui-  
ry” on page 212.  
Caution  
Do not use input functions such as PT touch switches for applications where  
danger to human life or serious damage is possible, or for emergency switch  
applications.  
Press touch switches with a force of no greater than 20 N.  
Applying higher force may cause glass to break, cause injuries, and prevent op-  
eration.  
Do not press touch switches carelessly while the backlight is off or while nothing  
is displayed on the screen.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Only press touch switches after confirming system safety.  
If touch switches are pressed in rapid succession, their inputs may not be suc-  
cessfully received.  
Correct use  
Confirm that the input of a touch switch has been successfully received before  
moving on to the next operation.  
ꢃꢅꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-7  
Reference  
Caution on pressing touch switches at 3 points  
When multiple touch switches are created at the relative positions indicated in  
the example below, malfunctions may occur due to the characteristics of this  
switch configuration.  
Be careful about the positioning when setting touch switches.  
Example 1 :When switches are created at positions A and B and at the points  
where the vertical and horizontal lines extending from these two points inter-  
sect, i.e. points C and D:  
A
When switches A, B, and C are switched  
on at the same time, switch D is also  
assumed to have been switched on due to  
the configuration of the touch switches.  
C
B
When switches A, B, and D are switched  
on at the same time, switch C is also  
assumed to have been switched on due to  
the configuration of the touch switches.  
D
Smallest touch switch frame  
5-7-1  
Functions of Touch Switches  
Touch switches are created using rectangular elements measuring 39 dots hori-  
zontally by 49 dots vertically. A touch switch can comprise more than one touch  
switch element. Up to 128 touch switches (16 horizontally x 8 vertically) can be  
registered on one screen.  
39 dots  
49 dots  
STOP  
A touch switch can comprise more  
than one touch switch element.  
PC  
Host  
When the touch switch is  
pressed, bit information  
is sent to the PC.  
(NT link/Host link/  
C200H direct)  
When the touch switch is pressed,  
the touch switch number or bit  
information is sent to the Host.  
(RS-232C)  
ꢃꢅꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-7  
Functions of touch switches  
Touch switches can have the following functions:  
- PC notification function  
Direct connection (page 181)  
RS-232C communication (page 205)  
- Screen switch (standalone) function (page 141)  
- System key function (page 142)  
- Numeral setting function (page 146)  
Direct connection (page 189)  
RS-232C communication (page 205)  
The following attributes can be set for touch switches.  
Display frame  
Touch Switch Attributes  
The area that will respond as a touch switch is displayed in the form of a frame,  
as shown in the table below. One of three types of frame - standard, 3-D, and  
none - can be selected.  
Type of Display  
Switch OFF  
Switch ON  
Frame  
Standard  
3-D  
None  
If “none” is selected, only the touch switch’s guidedisplay message (or nothing, if  
there is none) are displayed until a “light” or “flash” designation is sent from the  
PC/Host or the touch switch is pressed.  
Inverse display on input  
It is possible to set a touch switch so that its display will be inverted when it is  
pressed.  
Lighting and flashing  
When using host link/NT link/C200H direct communication, it is possible to spec-  
ify whether a touch switch will be lit continuously or flash when the bit allocated to  
it is turned ON by an instruction from the PC.  
When using RS-232C, it is possible to specify whether a touch switch will be lit  
continuously or flash in response to an instruction from the Host.  
Presence/absence of a guide display  
A guide display message can be displayed at a touch switch location.  
ꢃꢆꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-7  
5-7-2  
Standalone Function  
The NT600S has a function that allows screens to be switched by pressing touch  
switches on its screen, rather than by designation from the PC. This function is  
called the “standalone function”.  
The screen number of the screen that will be displayed when a touch switch is  
pressed is set for that touch switch when the screen data is created using the sup-  
port tool.  
If the touch switch is pressed during operation, the screen whose number was  
designated will be displayed. Simultaneously, the PC will be notified of the screen  
number of the screen selected for display.  
Touch switch  
pressed once  
To next screen  
Screen #5  
“Screen #5” set for touch switch #1  
Reference  
To set a screen number for a touch switch, use “Touch SW”, “Bit specification”  
and “Screen switch” of the support tool.  
Only one screen number can be set for one touch switch within one screen (or  
within one overlapping screen).  
ꢃꢆꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-7  
5-7-3  
System Key Functions  
The NT600S allows the allocation of “system key” functions to touch switches. The  
system key functions can then be used during operation by pressing the touch  
switches to which they have been allocated.  
For example, if, when a screen for which buzzer sounding has been set is dis-  
played, a “ ” touch switch is also displayed, the buzzer can be stopped by press-  
ing this touch switch.  
Reference  
To set a system key function for a touch switch, use “TouchSW”, “Bit specification”  
and “Numeric key” of the support tool.  
Allocation of System Key Functions  
The system key functions are allocated to touch switch numbers 227 to 230 and  
255, as shown below. When a touch switch with one of these numbers is displayed  
on the screen, it has the same function as the corresponding system key.  
System Key  
System menu display  
[]  
Key Symbol Touch Switch No.  
MENU  
227  
228  
[]  
229  
230  
255  
[Buzzer stop]  
[ENT]  
Reference  
When a touch switch to which a system key function has been allocated is  
pressed, the touch switch bit information is not notified to the PC.  
The  
,
, and  
keys are not displayed among the system numeric keys. Ac-  
cordingly, when using the system numeric keys, create the [ENT], [], and []  
keys. Alternatively, create user numeric keys.  
ꢃꢆꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
5-8  
Numeral Setting  
The NT600S has a “numeral setting” function to enable numerical values to be in-  
put from the screen. This function inputs numerical values to numeral memory  
tables in response to touch switch operations, displays these numerical values on  
the screen, and sends them to the host.  
This section outlines the numeral setting function and the method for creating the  
ten keys required to set numerical values on the screen, and explains how to use  
ten keys during operation.  
Numeral setting screens cannot be registered as child screens of continuous  
screens, In the case of overlapping screens, only one of the screens can be set as  
a numeral setting screen.  
Caution  
In order to input numerical values using touch switches, apart from the display  
area for the numeral setting, the numeric keys must also be created. For details on  
how to create numeric keys, see “Creating Numeric Keys” (page 146).  
Ensure the safety of the system before changing the monitor data.  
5-8-1  
Function of Numeral Keys  
Basic Procedure  
The procedure for numeral setting is as follows.  
(1) Input the numerical value using touch switches (numeric keys).  
(2) The input numerical value is displayed in the numeral setting area on the  
screen.  
(3) Confirm the input numerical value (by pressing the [ENT] key); it will bewritten  
to the numeral memory table, and simultaneously notified to the PC/Host.  
Numerical values are displayed in  
the numeral se
NT600S  
PC  
Host  
1 2 3 4  
1 2 3 4  
alue  
simultaneously notified to the PC/Host.  
Input the numerical values using the  
numeric keys on the screen.  
If there is more than one numeral setting area, the one in which the numerical val-  
ue is to be input can be selected by using a touch switch (numeric key).  
Restrictions on Numerical Value Input and Attribute Setting  
Numerical values of up to 8 digits (7 if there is a minus sign) can be input in either  
decimal or hexadecimal format.  
Decimal input  
When the display attribute is set for decimal display, values are input in the deci-  
mal format.  
- Numerical value range  
The range for numerical values that can be input differs according to whether  
or not there is a sign display.  
ꢃꢆꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
When there is no sign display :0 to 99999999 (8 digits)  
When there is a sign display :--9999999 to +9999999  
(7 digits for negative numbers, 8 digits for positive numbers)  
If a sign is displayed when using the thumbwheel type of numeral setting, the maxi-  
mum number of digits for both positive and negative numbers is 7.  
- Decimal point  
A maximum of 7 digits can be input after the decimal point (or 6 for negative  
numbers).  
Hexadecimal input  
When the display attribute is set for hexadecimal display, values are input in the  
hexadecimal format.  
- Numerical value range  
Numerical values can be input in the range 0 to FFFFFFFF (8 digits).  
Attributes that can be set  
The attributes of the numerical values displayed in the input field are the same as  
for numeral displays. See “Numerals Which can be Displayed” (page 130).  
Upper/Lower Limit Check (Ver.5 Direct Connection Only)  
When Ver.5 direct connection is used, upper and lower limits can be set for input  
numerical values to prevent erroneous values that are outside the valid range be-  
ing stored in the numeral memory table or notified to the PC.  
The upper/lower limit check is executed when the input numerical value has been  
confirmed: if the value is outside the valid range, the screen returns to its status  
before input.  
To use the numerical value input function safely, always use the upper/lower limit  
check function. Since this function is not featured with Ver.4 and previous ver-  
sions of the direct connection function, a similar check should be implemented by  
using the user application software.  
Correct use  
5-8-2  
Types of Numeral Setting  
There are two types of numeral setting: the numeric key type, and the thumbwheel  
type.  
The basic function of these two types is the same, but the screen displays and in-  
put methods are different.  
A maximum of 50 input fields, including both numeric key and thumbwheel types,  
can be registered on one screen.  
The thumbwheel type of numeral setting can only be used when using Ver.5 direct  
connection with an NT600S-ST121/ST211-EV  
.
ꢃꢆꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
Numeric Key Type  
When a numerical value is input using touch switches to which numeric key func-  
tions have been allocated, the input numerical value is displayed on the screen.  
On pressing the return key after completing input, the input numerical value is writ-  
ten to the numeral memory table and notified to the host.  
If there is more than one numeral setting input field, the field in which the input is to  
be made can also be selected with the numeric keys.  
In order to perform numeric key input, it is necessary not only to create a numeral  
setting input field on the screen, but also to create the numeric keys to be used for  
input (see page 146).  
Displayed in the numeral  
setting input
NT600S  
1 2 3 4  
Host  
1 2 3 4  
tten to the  
otified to the PC.  
Input the numerical value using the  
numeric keys on the screen.  
Thumbwheel Type (Ver.5 Direct Connection Only)  
When using an NT600S-ST121/ST211-EV with Ver.5 direct connection, numeri-  
cal values are input directly at the numeral setting input field using touch switches  
that increment or decrement each of the digits in the display when pressed. Each  
time the displayed numerical value is changed, the new displayed value is written  
to the numeral memory table and simultaneously notified to the host.  
This means that, when using the Thumbwheel type of numeral setting, all that is  
required to input numerical values is to create the numeral setting input field on the  
screen.  
Pressing the [--] key  
decrements
NT600S  
1 2 3 4  
Host  
1 2 3 4  
y  
table and simultaneously notified to the hos.  
Pressing the [+] key  
increments the digit by one.  
ꢃꢆꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
5-8-3  
Creating Numeric Keys  
In order to input numerical values using the numeral setting function, apart from  
the display area for the numeral setting, the numeric keys must also be created.  
Setting Screen Attributes  
The type of numeric keys can be selected using the numeral setting attributes of  
the screen attributes. There are two numeral setting attributes: “system” and  
“user”.  
Screen when “system” is specified  
When a numeral setting area is created, numeric keys are automatically dis-  
played. The display position and arrangement of the numeric keys are fixed. On  
this screen, only the types of numeric key shown in the figure below (system  
keys) are used.  
Tank A Tank B Tank C  
1
7
2
8
3
9
4
0
5
6
CLR  
When using the NT600S with the numeral setting attribute set to “system”, apart  
from the numeric keys provided by the system, the touch switches allocated to  
system keys (  
,
,
) also have to be created (system key function). To en-  
able input of hexadecimal values, it is also necessary to create numeric keys A  
through F.  
With the NT600S, if the numeral setting attribute is set to “system”, apart from  
the numeric keys prepared by the system, the touch switches allocated to sys-  
tem keys (  
,
,
) have to be created. (“System key functions”, page 142)  
When the numeral setting attribute is “user”  
The type, position, etc., of numeric keys can be set as required. The numeric  
keys that can be created are shown below.  
Tank A Tank B Tank C  
ꢃꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
Numeric Key Allocations  
The following special touch switch numbers (numeric key numbers) are allocated  
to the numeric keys.  
Touch  
Switch  
Number  
Touch  
Switch  
Number  
Touch  
Switch  
Number  
Numeric  
Key  
Numeric  
Key  
Numeric  
Key  
Menu  
display  
227 (*)  
237  
6
247  
CLR  
228  
229  
230  
231  
232  
233  
234  
235  
236  
238  
239  
240  
241  
242  
243  
244  
245  
246  
7
8
248  
249  
250  
251  
252  
253  
254  
255  
.
9
HOME  
0
1
2
3
4
5
A
B
C
D
E
F
(*) Numeric key number 227 (formerly “buzzer stop” + [] + []) is the system  
menu display key.  
To create a touch switch for a user-defined numeric key, select “Numeric key” from  
the “Touch SW - Bit setting” menu of the support tool, then designate a touch  
switch number at “Numeric key #”.  
Reference  
When a touch switch allocated as a numeric key is pressed, the touch switch sta-  
tus is not notified to the PC. Consequently, touch switches 227 to 255 cannot be  
used as ordinary touch switches.  
Continuous screens and overlapping screens  
Numeral setting screens cannot be registered as child screens of continuous  
screens. If a numeral setting screen is displayed part way through a continuous  
screen, the system keys created as touch switches - [] and [] - function as  
keys for numeral setting, making it impossible to switch screens.  
In the case of overlapping screens, only one of the screens can be set as a nu-  
meral setting screen.  
ꢃꢆꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
5-8-4  
Using Numeric Keys  
To input numerical data at a numeral setting area during operation, first select the  
numeral setting at which the data is to be input, and then input the numerical value  
by pressing the numeric keys (touch switches).  
Selecting the Numeral Setting Area for Data Input  
Select the numeral setting area into which the numerical value is to be input by  
using either the numeric keys or the system keys.  
Selection with the numeric keys  
Use the [HOME],  
,
,
and keys. By using these keys, the cursor can be  
shifted between numeral setting areas in the way shown in the figure below.  
6563  
4568  
5107  
3200  
0000  
4624  
HOME  
Pressing the [HOME] key will shift the cursor to the area whose top left corner  
has the smallest XY coordinate sum (the top left numeral setting input field in the  
example above).  
Selection with the system keys  
When the  
and  
system keys on the touch panel are pressed, the cursor  
moves between the numeral setting areas by following the order in which they  
were created using the support tool.  
For example, if three numeral setting areas have been created, the cursor can  
be moved between them following the order of creation as follows.  
key:1st area 2nd area 3rd area 1st area  
key:1st area 3rd area 2nd area 1st area  
If the “numeral setting” screen attribute is set to “system”, the order of cursor  
motion when the and system keys are used can be changed. For details,  
refer to the NT series support tool operation manual (V028-E1- ).  
ꢃꢆꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
Inputting Numerical Values Input numerical values using the following numeric keys (touch switches): numer-  
als (0 to 9), decimal point (.), sign (+,--), clear (CLR), and return (  
).  
Inputting the integer and decimal fraction parts  
When inputting a numeric value including a decimal point, input the integer and  
decimal fraction separately. First input the integer, then press the decimal  
point key (.) and input the decimal fraction.  
If the integer or decimal fraction exceed their respective allowable numbers of  
display digits, they are shifted to the left.  
Note that the system keys do not have a decimal point (.) key. Accordingly, it is  
necessary to make a decimal point key in addition to the system keys to input  
numeric values including a decimal point.  
Changing the sign  
When there is a sign display, pressing the sign ( ) key changes minus to plus or  
plus to minus.  
Confirming input numerical values  
Always press the return key as the final step when inputting a numerical value.  
When the return key is pressed, the displayed numerical value is written to the  
numeral memory table and at the same time notified to the host.  
Initial operation of input keys  
The return key (  
), sign key ( ), decimal point key (.), operate as follows on  
initial use (first use after displaying the screen or first use after key input).  
- Return key (  
The display is cleared to zero (assuming decimal input width sign display).  
- Sign key (  
)
)
The display is cleared to zero (assuming decimal input with sign display).  
- Decimal point key (.)  
The display is cleared to zero, after which input starts from the decimal fraction  
digits (assuming decimal input with sign display).  
- Alphabet (A to F) key  
The display is cleared to zero (assuming decimal input).  
ꢃꢆꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
Upper/lower limit check (only when using direct connection)  
By setting a maximum value and minimum value for input numerical values, the  
storage of erroneous values outside the applicable range in numeral memory  
tables and their notification to the PC/Host can be prevented.  
The upper/lower limit check is executed when an input numerical value is con-  
firmed.  
5-8-5  
Using Thumb Wheel Keys  
(Only When Direct Connection Ver.5 is Specified)  
Using thumb wheel switches, numerical values can be input during operation by  
pressing the incrementing/decrementing (+/--) keys.  
Numerical value input  
Input numerical values by using the incrementing/decrementing (+/--) keys pro-  
vided for each digit.  
Numerical value specification  
When an incrementing/decrementing (+, --) key is touched, the numeral at the  
corresponding digit is incremented or decremented by one. Whenever a plus or  
minus key is touched, the changed value is notified to the host. There is no need  
to press the return key as is the case when using the numeric key type of numer-  
al setting.  
Thumb wheel numeral setting  
Numeral  
memory table  
1
2
3
4
1 2 3 4  
Press  
PC  
2
2
3
4
2 2 3 4  
Host  
Numerical value  
incremented by one  
Reference  
Numerical values cannot be set in thumb wheel type numeral setting fields by us-  
ing numeric keys.  
Changing the sign  
In settings with a sign display, touching the incrementing/decrementing (+, --)  
keys at the digit where the sign is displayed will change plus to minus and minus  
to plus.  
ꢃꢇꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4-8  
Upper/lower limit check  
An upper/lower limit check is executed when the incrementing/decrementing (+,  
--) keys are pressed. If the input numerical value is outside the valid range, the  
data in the numeral memory table before the key was pressed is redisplayed and  
notified to the host.  
However, with thumbwheel type numeral setting, if the situation is such that with  
an upper limit of 1n..n, and a lower limit of 0m..m (where n and m are the values  
of each digit), n..n < m..m, it is not possible to carry digits upward or downward.  
Example:  
When the upper limit value is 1200 and the lower limit value is 201, if the initial  
value has three digits the value can be changed within the range 201 to 999, and  
if the initial value has four digits it can only be changed within the range 1000 to  
1200.  
This is because if an attempt is made to change the leftmost digit from 0 to 1, or  
from 1 to 0, an upper/lower limit value check is always performed.  
In order to avoid this, either set the values so that n..n m..m, or create another  
touch switch and write values to the host when digits are carried up or down.  
Restrictions and Additional Settings for Thumb Wheel Type Numeral Settings  
There are the following restrictions and additional items to set when creating  
thumb wheel type numeral settings.  
Number of input digits for positive values when there is a sign display  
When a sign display is set for a thumb wheel type numeral setting, a maximum of  
7 digits can be input for positive values.  
Display size  
The only size that can be specified is “medium” (two touch switch areas com-  
bined to make each digit).  
Note that since the touch switch mesh overlaps with the numeral display, touch-  
ing the numeral display will cause the numerical value to be updated.  
Shape (end plates)  
Set which of the two shapes shown below will be used. One has “end plates” at  
right and left sides and the other does not.  
<With>  
<Without>  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
Restrictions on display attributes  
The following restrictions apply to display attributes.  
Character type  
Character enlargement  
Zero suppress  
: Wide size only (16  
: Standard only  
: No zero suppression only  
16 dots)  
See “Numerals Which can be Displayed” (page 130).  
ꢃꢇꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢃꢇꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 6  
Using Host Link/NT Link/C200H Direct  
This section describes how the NT600S can be used when using the Host link/NT link/C200H direct.  
6-1 Outline of Host Link / NT Link / C200H Direct Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
6-1-1 Equipment and Settings Used in This Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
6-1-2 Allocatable Bits and Words . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
6-1-3 NT600S Status Control and Notification to PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155  
6-1-4 Switching the Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160  
6-1-5 Notifying the Display Screen to the PC  
(To Display the Number of Currently Displayed Screen) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
6-2 Memory Tables and Bar Graph . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164  
6-2-1 Allocation Words and Display of the Memory Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167  
6-2-2 Changing Displayed Numerals or Character Strings  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Words ..... Direct Specification) . . . . . . . . . 170  
6-2-3 Changing Displayed Numerals or Character-Strings  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Words ..... Indirect Specification) . . . . . . . . 172  
6-2-4 Copying the Memory Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
6-2-5 Upgrading Bar Graphs  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Words) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179  
6-3 Lamps, Touch Switches, and Numeral Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
6-3-1 Allocation Bits and Display of Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
6-3-2 Turning ON (lit) and OFF (unlit) the Lamps  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Bits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181  
6-3-3 Allocated Bits, and Display, of Touch Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
6-3-4 Lit (Flashing) and Unlit Touch Switch Statuses  
(Changing the Status of Allocated Bits) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
6-3-5 Notifying the PC that a Switch has been Pressed  
(Determining Touch Switch Status) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
6-3-6 Notification of Numbers to the PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
6-4 NT600S Status Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
6-4-1 Controllable NT600S Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192  
6-4-2 How to Control NT600S Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195  
6-5 Notification of the Operating Status to the PC  
(Determining the NT600S Operating Status) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
6-5-1 Ascertainable NT600S Statuses (Notified Operating Statuses) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
6-5-2 Reading the NT600S Operating Statuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198  
ꢃꢇꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
6-1  
Outline of Host Link / NT Link / C200H Direct Operation  
This section describes the basics for operating the NT600S through communica-  
tions with the PC using the Host link/NT link/C200H direct.  
6-1-1  
Equipment and Settings Used in This Chapter  
The following equipment and settings are used in the examples in this Chapter:  
[Equipment] PT  
PC  
: NT600S-ST121-EV3  
: CQM1  
Support tool  
: NT-series Support Tool Ver. 2.  
[Support tool settings]  
NT Model  
: NT600S  
Memory capacity : 128 KB  
Direct Access : Ver.5  
Direct Macn Type: OMRON  
6-1-2  
Allocatable Bits and Words  
The following bits and words are allocated to the PC and used for the NT600S op-  
eration. The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix  
L PC Memory Map (page 291).  
The allocations must be made without exceeding respective area range.  
[OMRON PCs]  
C Series PCs  
CVM1/CV Series PCs  
Allocated Word  
Character  
Allocated Word  
Symbol  
Allocated  
Bit  
Allocated  
Bit  
Area Name  
Area Name  
Character  
String  
Numeral  
Numeral  
String  
DM  
CH  
Data Memory  
Data Memory  
Internal/Special  
Relay  
Internal/Special  
Relay  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Timer  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: 1 word only  
: NG  
Reference  
One allocation word of the memory table can use continuous areas of up to 2  
words in the case of numeral memory table or 20 words in the case of character-  
string memory table.  
Reference  
When allocating a memory table to words, the allocation must not exceed the  
word area.  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CV series PCs are allocated to thesystem,  
they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use. However, reading  
from them is possible.  
ꢃꢇꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
6-1-3  
NT600S Status Control and Notification to PC  
This section describes the fundamentals of the display elements, NT600S status  
control, and notification which are the basics of the NT600S functions.  
For the detail method of use of the PT status control area and the PT status notify  
area, refer to Sections 5-4 NT600S Status Control (page 192) and 5-5 Notification  
of the Operating Status to the PC (page 197).  
Controlling the Display Elements by Using Allocated Bits and Words  
The NT600S will operate as follows in the display element control operation.  
[NT600S operation]  
(1) The NT600S checks the allocation bits and words of the display elements and  
makes an inquiry to the PC.  
(2) The PC answers the NT600S about the bit and word data.  
(3) The NT600S changes the display status according to the bits and words ob-  
tained from the PC.  
[NT600S operation example]  
NT600S  
PC  
Lamp 0 Bit 010012  
Bit 010012?  
TIM003?  
(“a”, “b”)  
(“c”, “d”)  
(“e”, “f”)  
DM0100 to DM0102?  
Character-string memory table2  
Numeral memory table0  
First word  
: DM0100 First word  
: TIM003  
Number of saved words : 3  
Number of saved words : 1  
ꢃꢇꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
Controlling the NT600S Status by Using Allocated Bits and Words ..... PT Status Control Area (PC to PT)  
The PT status control area (PC to PT) is provided to control the NT600S status  
from the PC. When data is written to this area in the PC, the NT600S will read the  
data and operates according to the data. The PT status control area is configured  
as four consecutive words as shown below.  
Word 15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 Bit  
Screen switch  
setting  
Copy memory  
Screen # (4-digit BCD)  
Copy source memory table # (3-digit BCD)  
n
0
n+1  
table setting  
Copy destination memory table # (3-digit BCD)  
Copy type  
n+2  
n+3  
PT status control bit  
PT status control  
0
0
Reference  
The first word (word n) of the PT status control area must be set with the support  
tool.  
Screen switch settings (refer to page 160)  
Specify the screen # to switch the screen displayed on the NT600S.  
Copy memory table settings (refer to page 175)  
Specify the memory table # to copy the contents of a memory table internally in  
the NT600S.  
Set the copy type to match the type of memory table to be copied:  
0: Character-string memory table  
1: Numeral table  
PT status control bits (refer to page 192)  
Turn this bit ON and OFF to control the buzzer and backlight of the NT600S.  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
0
8
Bit  
n+3 CH  
0
0
Item Controlled  
1 (ON)  
ON  
0 (OFF)  
OFF  
Screen display  
(Note 1)  
Processing priority  
registration  
ON  
OFF  
(Note 2)  
Continuous buzzer  
Intermittent buzzer  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
Backlight mode  
(Note 3)  
ON  
Flash  
Note 1: When “ON” is set for screen display, the  
backlight/EL display is on; when “OFF”  
is set for screen display, the backlight is  
off.  
Note 2: Priority registration is only valid when  
NT link (1:N) is set.  
Note 3: Cannot be used with NT600S-ST211.  
ꢃꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
The PT status control area (PC to PT) can be allocated to the following PC  
areas.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CV series PCs are allocated to the system,  
they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
Caution  
Set so that there is no overlap between the PT status control area and PT status  
notify area. Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Reference  
When NT link (1:N) is set, the PT status control area must be set for each con-  
nected PT.  
Notifying the Display Elements by Using Allocated Bits and Words  
The NT600S will operate as follows in the display element notification operation.  
[NT600S operation]  
The NT600S will write any changes in the contents of the numeral or character-  
string memory table being displayed or pressing of a touch switch to the bits and  
words area in the PC.  
[NT600S operation example]  
NT600S  
PC  
Touch switch #12  
Bit009012  
Bit 009012:ON  
DM0110:0432  
Num
Numeral memory table0  
Number of saved words : 1  
0
4
3
2
Copy  
First word  
: DM0110  
ꢃꢇꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
Notifying the NT600S Status by Using Allocated Bits and Words ..... PT Status Notify Area (PT to PC)  
The PT status notify area (PT to PC) is provided to notify the NT600S status  
changes to the PC. When any NT600S status has changed, suchchange is written  
to this area in the PC, and the PC will read the data from this area to check the  
NT600S status.  
The PT status notify area is configured as three consecutive words as shown be-  
low.  
Word 15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 Bit  
Screen being displayed  
Screen # (4-digit BCD)  
Numeral memory table # (3-digit BCD)  
m
Content upgrade  
memory table  
0
m+1  
m+2  
PT status  
PT status  
0
0
Reference  
The first word (word m) of the PT status notify area must be set with the support  
tool.  
Currently displayed screen (refer to page 162)  
The screen number displayed on the NT600S is written to this word.  
Simultaneously, the PT status screen switch strobe flag is set to ON (1). After  
this is notified to the PC, this flag reverts to OFF (0). Checking the status of this  
flag will provide a simple method of checking if the NT600S display has  
switched.  
Content upgrade memory table (refer to page 189)  
The number of the numeral table is written to the word when the numeral  
memory table contents change due to the touch switch operation on the  
NT600S.  
Reference  
The contents of the word to which the numeral table has been allocated also  
change.  
ꢃꢇꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
As the number of the numeral table is written, the PT status numeral setting  
strobe flag is simultaneously set ON (1). After this is notified to the PC, this flag  
reverts to OFF (0). Checking the status of this flag will provide a simple method  
of checking if a number has been input from the NT600S.  
Note that this function is not available with the character-string memory table.  
PT status (refer to page 197)  
The NT600S operation status and other information are written with the ON or  
OFF of the bits as shown below.  
PT status notify bits  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
0
8
0
Bit  
Word m+2  
0
0
PT operation status (1 (ON): RUN / 0 (OFF): STOP)  
Battery (1 (ON): LOW / 0 (OFF): NORMAL)  
Screen switching strobe  
Numeral setting strobe flag  
The PT status control area (PC to PT) can be allocated to the following PC areas.  
Symbol C Series PCs Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
DM Data Memory  
Data Memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Reference  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
Caution  
Set so that there is no overlap between the PT status control area and PT status  
notify area. Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Reference  
When NT link (1:N) is set, the PT status notify area must be set for each con-  
nected PT.  
ꢃꢇꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
6-1-4  
Switching the Screen Display  
The following describes the procedure used to switch the NT600S screen display  
by controlling from the PC.  
Reference  
The display screen can be switched also by pressing a touch switch during the  
operation after registering a screen number to the touch switch. For this function,  
refer to the “Standalone Function” (page 141).  
To switch the NT600S screen display by controlling from the PC, write a screen  
number at the “screen switch setting” in the PT status control area.  
NT600S  
PC  
PT status control area  
Screen switch setting  
Screen number  
Copy memory  
table setting  
Designated screen  
PT status control setting  
[Screen switch setting in the PT status control area]  
PT status notify bits  
15 14 13 12 11 10 9  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 Bit  
Screen number (4-digit BCD)  
Screen switch setting  
Word n  
Screen number: 0000 (screen clear, no-display)  
0001 to 01000  
Reference  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the PT status control area (PC to PT) to the PC  
memory.  
2. Create a PC program to write the number of the displayed screen to the  
“screen switch setting word” in the PT status control area.  
Reference  
Use a 4-digit BCD (binary-coded decimal) value to set a screen number.  
If a screen has been switched by operating the PT status control area (PC to PT),  
the contents of the “currently displayed screen word” in the PT status notify area  
(PT to PC) also change.  
Screen switching timing  
The NT600S screen switches when the contents of the “screen switch setting”  
have changed. To re-specify the number of the currently specified screen, first  
write the value 0000 to clear the screen before writing the appropriate screen  
number.  
ꢃ ꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
Use of the screen switching strobe  
Create a program to read the number of the currently displayed screen and to  
write the number to the “screen switch setting word” at the leading edge of the  
“screen switching strobe” of the PT status notify area. This program enables  
screen switching by using the touch switches on the NT600S and eliminates re-  
peated setting of the same screen number. If the screen switching is not  
executed on the NT600S, the screen switching strobe does not need to be  
checked.  
Reference  
Reference  
For the screen switching strobe, refer to the “notifying the displayed screen to the  
PC” mentioned below.  
Continuous screens and overlapping screens  
Continuous or overlapping screens can be displayed by designating the parent  
screen. If a child screen is designated, only the child screen is displayed.  
For the continuous and overlapping screens, refer to the “Classification of  
screens” (page 124).  
Example of Display Screen Switching  
This example operates the PC switch (bit) to switch the NT600S display screen.  
Support tool settings  
Make the following settings with the support tool:  
PT status control area:  
PT status notify area:  
Word 0100  
Word 0110  
Screen number to be created: Screen #2 and #3  
PC ladder program  
Create a PC ladder program as follows:  
00002  
(1)  
@MOV(21)  
Screen number  
#0002  
100  
Screen switch setting word  
00003  
11212  
(2)  
@MOV(21)  
#0003  
Screen number  
Screen switch setting word  
100  
(3)  
@MOV(21)  
110  
Screen number  
Screen switch setting word  
100  
Screen switch strobe flag  
Program operation  
(1) Screen #2 is displayed on the NT600S when bit 00002 turns ON.  
(2) Screen #3 is displayed on the NT600S when bit 00003 turns ON.  
(3) When the screen switch strobe flag turns ON, the number of the currently dis-  
played screen is read and written to the currently displayed screen word in the  
PT status notify area. In this case, the NT600S will not write the same screen  
twice.  
ꢃ ꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
6-1-5  
Notifying the Display Screen to the PC  
(To Display the Number of Currently Displayed Screen)  
The following describes the processing to display the number of currently dis-  
played screen of the NT600S.  
This processing reads the data from the PC status notify area.  
To indicate that the screen has switched, use the screen switch strobe flag.  
To display the number of the currently displayed screen, use the currently dis-  
played screen word.  
When the screen has switched, the NT600S notifies the following to PT status  
notify area (PT to PC) allocated to the PC.  
Screen switch notification:  
New screen number:  
Screen switch strobe flag of the PT status word  
Currently displayed screen word  
By reading the currently displayed screen word when the screen switch strobe flag  
has turned ON, the number of the currently displayed screen on the NT600S is  
displayed.  
NT600S  
PC  
PT status notify area  
Currently displayed screen  
Content upgrade memory table  
PT status  
Screen number  
Currently  
displayed  
screen  
Screen switch  
strobe flag  
[Currently displayed screen] and [PT status] words in the PT status notify  
area  
1514131211 10 9  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 Bit  
Word  
m
Screen number (4-digit BCD)*  
* Screen number: 0001 to 1000  
Screen switch setting  
PT status  
0
0
PT status  
m+2  
m+2  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
-- -- --  
9
0
8
0
Bit  
0
0
Screen switch strobe  
Use a 4-digit BCD (binary-coded decimal) value to set a screen number.  
The screen switch strobe bit reverts to OFF (0) after this is notified to the PC.  
Reference  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CV series PCs are allocated to thesystem,  
they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
ꢃ ꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-1  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the PT status notify area (PT to PC) to the PC  
memory.  
2. Create a PC program to read the “currently displayed screen word” in the in the  
PT status notify area when the “screen switch strobe flag” in the PT status  
notify area has turned ON.  
Reference  
The contents of the “currently displayed screen word” are updated also by  
switching the screen by pressing a touch switch on the NT600S.  
For this function (standalone function or screen switch function), refer to the  
“Standalone Function” (page 141).  
Continuous screens and overlapping screens  
When a continuous or overlapping screen is displayed, the number of the parent  
screen is written to the “currently displayed screen word”.  
For the continuous and overlapping screens, refer to the “Classification of  
screens” (page 124).  
Example of Reading the Number of Currently Display Screen  
This example gives a PC program that reads the screen number each time the  
screen is switched. In this example, the number of the previous screen is also  
stored.  
Support tool settings  
Make the following settings with the support tool:  
PT status notify area: Word 0110  
PC ladder program  
11212  
(1)  
@MOV(21)  
DM0100  
Word for storing the number of the  
previous screen  
DM0101  
(2)  
Screen switch  
strobe flag  
@MOV(21)  
110  
Word for notifying the number of the  
currently displayed screen  
DM0100  
Word for storing a new screen number  
Program operation  
(1) When the NT600S screen display switches and the screen switch strobe flag  
(bit 11212) turns ON, the contents of DM0100 are transferred to DM0101. The  
number of the previously displayed screen is stored in word 0101.  
(2) The new screen number notified by the NT600S is read and transferred to  
DM0100. The number of the currently displayed screen is stored in DM0100.  
ꢃ ꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
6-2  
Memory Tables and Bar Graph  
This section describes allocation of the memory table to PC words, and changes to  
the contents of words necessary to display characters, numerals, and graphs by  
communicating with the PC using the Host link/NT link.  
Reference  
For the functions relating to memory tables and bar graphs, refer to 4-4 Memory  
Tables (page 128) and 4-5 Bar Graphs (page 131), respectively.  
Writing Words to the Character-String Memory Table  
Since the character-string memory tables can be allocated to the words in the PC,  
the PC can write data to the character-string memory tables or the initial values  
can be set when creating the screen data.  
Display area where the character-string  
NT600S  
PC  
memory table No. 2 is allocated  
Tntte se hthre displayed.  
Can be updated by the PC.  
During the operation, the display contents are automatically updated so that the  
contents of the character-string memory table being displayed are the same as  
that of the PC word.  
Displaying and Referencing Character String Memory Table Contents  
Since the character-string memory tables can be allocated to the words in the PC,  
the PC can write data to the character-string memory tables or the initial values  
can be set when creating the screen data.  
Automatic updating is performed to ensure that the currently displayed NT600S  
character string memory table contents and PC word contents always match each  
other.  
There are two methods for referencing character string memory tables used for  
character string display, as follows:  
- Direct specification  
- Indirect specification (with Ver.5 direct connection only)  
ꢃ ꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Direct specification  
Direct specification is a method of specification in which the contents of dis-  
played memory tables are directly correlated with the contents of the allocated  
words.  
NT600S  
PC  
Allocated channel  
(character string memory table 51)  
Direct  
specification  
Character string  
memory table 51  
Indirect specification (with Ver.5 direct connection only)  
In indirect specification, even if the displayed data is a character string, the dis-  
play is correlated with a numeral memory table. The contents (numerical value)  
of this numeral memory table are regarded as a character string memory table  
number and the contents of the table with this number are displayed.  
Up to 50 numeral displays and 50 character string displays can be specified on  
one screen by using indirect specification.  
NT600S  
PC  
Allocated word (numeral memory table 20)  
Indirect  
Numeral  
specification  
memory table 20  
Allocated word (character string table 51)  
Character  
string memory table 51  
This specification method is a little complex, but it allows the display to be changed  
more easily according to the circumstances. In the example above, if 1 were add-  
ed to the contents of memory table 20 to give 52, the contents of memory table 52  
would be displayed instead.  
The memory tables used for display can also be allocated to areas in the PC, so  
that the display can also be changed in response to changes in the data to be dis-  
played (i.e., the contents of character string memory table 51 in the example  
above).  
However, in comparison with direct specification, indirect specification requires  
more time for processing.  
Setting the Words of the Character-String Memory Table  
When creating the screen data by using the support tool, make the following set-  
tings for each numbered character-string:  
Initialization setting  
Set whether or not the PC words are initialized with the character-string memory  
table initial value registered to the screen data memory when the main power  
supply is turned ON or reset.  
ꢃ ꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Number of registration words  
Set the number of words within 20 words required for registering the character-  
string data. One word can store two half-size characters or one full-size charac-  
ter.  
Setting the words for the character-string memory tables  
The character-string memory tables can be allocated to the following PC words.  
Set the word type and the first word.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Note  
1. Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to  
the system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
2. If the “number of registration words x 2” (“word setting window”) set with the  
support tool is larger than the “number of character digits” (“character-string  
display setting” window), the character-string may be broken halfway.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
Writing Numerals to the Numeral Memory Table  
Since numeral memory tables can be allocated to PC words, data can be written  
from the PC to a numeral memory table, and initial values can be set whencreating  
screen data.  
The numeral display area where the  
numeral memory table No. 2 is allocated  
NT600S  
PC  
Numeral memory table  
splayed.  
Can be updated by the PC.  
numeral memory table No. 4 is allocated  
During the operation, the display contents are automatically updated so that the  
contents of the numeral memory table being displayed are the same as that of the  
PC word.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Setting the Words of the Numeral Memory Table  
When creating the screen data by using the support tool, make the following set-  
tings for each numbered numeral:  
Initialization setting  
Set whether or not the PC words are initialized with the numeral memory table  
initial value registered to the screen data memory when the main power supply is  
turned ON or reset.  
Number of registration words  
Set the number of words within 2 words required for registering the numeral  
data. One word can store up to 4 digits. Two words can store up to 8 digits.  
Setting the words for the numeral memory tables  
The numeral memory tables can be allocated to the following PC words. Set the  
word type and the first word.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data Memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data Memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: 1 word only  
: NG  
Note  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
6-2-1  
Allocation Words and Display of the Memory Tables  
The character-string memory table and numeral memory tables can be allocated  
to the following PC words.  
Set the word type and the first word. The number of words required for allocating a  
memory table and the areas to which a memory table can be allocated vary be-  
tween the character-string memory table and the numeral memory table.  
Number of words required for the allocation  
The number of words used for allocating one memory table is as mentioned be-  
low.  
Numeral memory table:  
1 word (max. 4 digits) or 2 words (max. 8 digits)  
Character-string memory table: 1 to 20 words (2 to 40 normal-size characters)  
ꢃ ꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Available allocation words  
The memory tables can be allocated to the following PC areas:  
C Series PCs  
Allocation  
CVM1/CV Series PCs  
Allocation  
Symbol  
Area Name  
Area Name  
Numeral Character  
Numeral Character  
DM  
CH  
Data Memory  
Data Memory  
Internal/Special  
Relay  
Internal/Special  
Relay  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Timer  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: 1 word only  
: NG  
Note  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
Contents of the numeral memory tables  
Numerals are stored in the allocated words as shown below.  
[Stored as a single word]  
15  
to 12 11  
Digit 4  
to  
8
7
to  
4
3
to  
0
0
0
Bit  
Bit  
Bit  
Digit 3  
Digit 2  
Digit 1  
Example: 1234  
15 to 12 11  
to  
2
8
7
to  
3
4
3
to  
4
1
[Stored as a double words]  
Word  
15 to 12 11 to  
8
7
7
to  
4
4
3
to  
Start  
Digit 4  
Digit 8  
Digit 3  
Digit 2  
Digit 6  
Digit 1  
Digit 5  
Start+ 1  
Digit 7  
Example: 12345678  
Word  
15 to 12 11 to  
8
to  
7
3
to  
8
0
Bit  
Start  
5
1
6
2
Start+ 1  
3
4
ꢃ ꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Displaying the numeral memory table  
Numerals can be displayed in three different ways according to the contents of  
the numeral memory table, as mentioned below.  
The most significant digit (digit 4 of a single word or digit 8 of a double word) is  
processed in different ways.  
Hexadecimal display:  
All digits are handled as stored in the allocated  
words.  
Decimal display without signs: If the most significant digit is “F”, it is handled  
as “0”, and the most significant digit other than  
“F” and other digits are handled as stored in the  
allocated words.  
Decimal display with signs:  
If the most significant digit is “F”, it is handled  
as “--” (minus sign), and the most significant  
digit other than “F” and other digits are handled  
as stored in the allocated words.  
[Numeral memory table display examples]  
When the data are numeral data (0 to 9)  
Decimal without sign 123456  
Start  
3
F
4
0
5
1
6
2
Decimal with sign  
Hexadecimal  
--123456  
Start + 1  
F0123456  
When the data contain characters (A to F)  
Decimal without sign 123B56  
Start  
3
F
B
0
5
1
6
2
Decimal with sign  
Hexadecimal  
--123B56  
Start + 1  
F0123B56  
If the hexadecimal data (A to F) are stored when the decimal display has been set,  
the alphabets are displayed.  
Reference  
If the number of display digits has been set to be smaller than the maximum  
number of digits of the registration words (4 digits for 1 word; 8 digits for 2  
words), the contents of the allocated words are not displayed and “ ” symbols  
will be displayed at all digits.  
If the most significant digit is “F” when “decimal with signs” has been set, the  
numeral is handled as a negative number. The maximum number of digits of the  
negative number becomes smaller than that of the positive number by 1 digit.  
The actual display will vary according to the “zero suppress” setting and decimal  
fraction setting as well as the contents mentioned above. Refer to the “NT-se-  
ries Support Tool Operation Manual” (V028-E1-01).  
ꢃ ꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Contents of the character-string memory table  
A character-string is stored in the allocated words beginning with the first word in  
half-size or normal-size characters.  
Two half-size characters or two normal-size character is stored in one word. One  
memory table can store up to 16 words (32 characters).  
Start  
Start + 1  
Start + 19  
Code 1  
Code 2 Code 3  
Code 4  
Code39 Code40  
[Character-string memory table display example]  
To display the characters in order, allocate the characters as follows.  
4
1
4
2
“A” = 41H, “B= 42H Start  
“C” = 43H, “D”= 44H Start + 1  
“E” = 45H, “F” = 46H Start + 2  
“G” = 47H, “H”= 48H Start + 3  
4
4
3
5
4
4
4
6
“ABCDEFGH”  
4
7
4
8
Character allocation bestriding two words.  
Provided the order is correct, it is possible to assign two digits each of a four-digit  
character code to successive words.  
[Example of character code bestriding words]  
4
1
4
2
“A” = 41H, “B= 42H Start  
“C” = 43H Start + 1  
4
9
3
F
E
E
B
B
“ABC  
D”  
” = EB9FH  
” = EBA0H  
Start + 2  
Start + 3  
A
0
4
4
“D” = 44H  
Reference  
Characters with 8-bit codes (00 to 1FH) are displayed on the screen as a one-byte  
space (20H). 00H is converted to 20H.  
6-2-2  
Changing Displayed Numerals or Character Strings  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Words....Direct Specification)  
The following describes the procedure to change displayed numerals or character  
-strings by changing the contents of the allocated words.  
Reference  
Numerals and character-strings can be changed also by making a copy of the  
memory tables. Refer to “Copying the memory table” explained later.  
To change the numerals or character-strings displayed on the NT600S, make  
changes with the numeral or character-string memory table. To make changes  
with the numeral or character-string memory table of the NT600S, change the con-  
tents of words by the PC.  
NT600S  
PC  
Allocated word  
(numeral table)  
Numeral memory  
table 1  
Start  
Start+1  
ng memory table)  
Start  
Start+1  
Start+2  
Character-string  
memory table 4  
ꢃꢈꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Reference  
When it is necessary to display changing data such as monitored data of words in  
the PC, use the numeral and character-string memory tables. This must be used  
to change the display contents (contents of memory table and words).  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the numeral and character-string memory  
tables to the PC memory.  
2. Register the memory tables for the numerals and character-strings to be dis-  
played when creating the screen data by using the support tool.  
To display a character-string, use “character display” and specify the charac-  
ter-string memory table by using the support tool.  
To display numerals, use “numeral display” and specify the numeral memory  
table by using the support tool.  
3. Create a PC program to write the contents of numerals and character-strings  
to be displayed on the NT600S to the PC words.  
Important points when writing a character-string  
If the character font for character-strings displayed on the NT600S screen is set  
as half height and a normal character-string is written after displaying a 2-byte  
code (mark), part of the mark will remain displayed, as shown below.  
ꢀ ꢁ ꢂ ꢃ ꢄ ꢅ ꢆ ꢇ  
In this case, first write a 2-byte code (FF20 to FF5F) for which nothing is regis-  
tered, then write a normal-size character-string.  
Application Example of the Numeral Memory Tables Allocated to the PC Words  
This example gives the procedure to directly display the contents of the words allo-  
cated as the numeral memory tables in the PC memory. The NT600S screen dis-  
play will change as the contents of the PC word change.  
Support tool settings  
Allocate the memory as shown below by using the support tool.  
Numeral memory table entry #1: DM0000 (allocated words: 2 words)  
Numeral memory table entry #2: DM0002 (allocated words: 1 word)  
Screen numbers to be created: #1 and #2  
Numeral memory  
table entry #1  
Line 1  
(8-digit input)  
Qty.  
15289  
23  
units  
units  
Defects  
Numeral memory  
table entry #2  
(4-digit input)  
ꢃꢈꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
PC ladder program  
Create a PC ladder program as follows:  
25502  
1 second clock  
DIFU(13)  
00100  
00100  
(1)  
INC(38)  
DM0000  
Word for least significant 4 digits of #1  
25506 (=)  
(2)  
INC(38)  
DM0001  
Word for most significant 4 digits of #1  
00001  
(3)  
@INC(38)  
DM0002  
Word for #2  
Program operation  
(1) The contents of word DM0000 are incremented by 1 each second. The value  
displayed on the NT600S in numeral table entry #1 increases by 1 each se-  
cond.  
(2) When the counter in (1) above causes an increase in the most significant dig-  
its, the contents of word DM0001 are incremented by 1 each second. The val-  
ue displayed on the NT600S in numeral memory table entry #1 most signifi-  
cant digits increases by 1.  
(3) When bit 00001 turns ON, the contents of DM0002 are incremented by 1. The  
value displayed on the NT600S in numeral memory table entry #2 increases  
by 1.  
6-2-3  
Changing Displayed Numerals or Character-Strings (Changing the  
Contents of Allocated Words ..... Indirect Specification)  
When displaying numerals or character-strings, it is possible to change them indi-  
rectly by specifying a numeral memory table. The contents of the specified numer-  
al memory table (39 in the following example case) is regarded as the memory  
table number used for display.  
Either of the following two methods can be used to change the contents of the dis-  
play.  
(1) Changing the memory table number to be displayed  
(To change the contents of numeral memory table 41, in the following exam-  
ple case)  
(2) Changing the contents of the memory table used for display  
(To change the contents of character-string memory table 39, in the following  
example case)  
ꢃꢈꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
In this section, the procedure for changing the display contents by using method  
(1) is explained.  
Method (2) involves changing the contents of the allocated table. For details, refer  
to the sections on memory table copy (page 175) and changing displayed numer-  
als or character-strings (direct specification) (page 170).  
NT600S  
PC  
Indirect numeral table 41  
Allocated word (numeral table 41)  
0039  
0
0
3
9
0039  
AaBb  
Character-string memory table 39  
AaBb  
Character-string memory table 40  
Moji  
Reference  
This method is convenient when switching the display at the same location, for  
example when monitoring a series of words, or when using unique codes to speci-  
fy individual character strings, etc.  
Procedure 1. Set the PC area for allocation of the numeral memory table to be referenced in  
indirect specification using the support tool.  
2. When using the support tool to create screen data, register on the screen the  
numeral memory table referenced in indirect specification. Specify the “indi-  
rect” option for the reference method.  
In the case of a character string, use the “character display” function of the  
support tool to specify the numeral memory table.  
In the case of a numerical value, use the “numeral display” function of the sup-  
port tool to specify the numeral memory table.  
3. Use the “table edit” function of the support tool to write the actually displayed  
data to the memory table for display. If displaying a numerical value, use a nu-  
meral memory table and if displaying a character string use a character string  
memory table.  
4. Create a PC program to change the contents of the word allocated to the nu-  
meral memory table referenced in the indirect specification.  
Notes on writing memory table numbers  
When writing the number of the memory table for display to the numeral memory  
table referenced in indirect specification, always specify it in BCD. Also, be sure  
to specify a number within the range of memory table numbers that actually exist  
(Numeral memory table : 0 to 511, Character string memory table : 0 to 255).  
If the contents of the numeral memory table for indirect specification are speci-  
fied in hexadecimal format, or the number specified is outside the valid range for  
memory table numbers, the display is not updated.  
Notes on writing character strings  
The points to note when displaying character strings are the same as those de-  
scribed for direct specification. See “Important points when writing a character  
string” (page 171).  
ꢃꢈꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Example of Changing a Character-String in Indirect Specification  
An example in which the character-strings being displayed are changed by adding  
the contents of the word allocated to the numeral memory table which is used in  
indirect specification is given below.  
Setting by the support tool  
Perform the following setting with the support tool.  
Numeral memory table number 51: DM0000 (registration word: 1 word)  
Contents to be registered  
for the screen:  
Numeral memory table number used for  
indirect specification ..... 51  
Initial value of numeral memory table  
number 51 ..... 100  
Line 1  
NT600S  
Display of character-string (specification of numeral memory  
table number 51 in indirect specification)  
Character-string memory table settings  
Number of  
#
Contents  
Character Digits  
100  
101  
102  
103  
NT20S  
NT600S  
NT610G  
NT610C  
6 digits  
6 digits  
6 digits  
6 digits  
(no word allocation)  
PC program  
Create the following PC ladder program.  
Make sure that the contents of the numeral table used for indirect specification  
will not be outside the range of table numbers used for display.  
00100  
(1)  
@INC(38)  
Numeral memory table number used for  
indirect specification  
DM0000  
00101  
(2)  
@DEC(39)  
Numeral memory table number used for  
indirect specification  
DM0000  
ꢃꢈꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Program operation  
When the program is executed by displaying the screen on the PT, the following  
operation is performed.  
(1) Each time contact 00100 comes ON, the display on the NT600S changes to  
the next item in the following sequence.  
NT20S NT600S NT610G NT610C  
(2) Each time contact 00101 comes ON, the display on the PT changes to the  
next item in the following sequence.  
NT610C  
NT610G  
NT600S  
NT20S  
6-2-4  
Copying the Memory Table  
The following describes the procedure to change displayed numerals or character  
-strings by copying the contents of the memory table.  
Reference  
Numerals and character-strings can be changed also by changing the contents of  
the allocated words. Refer to “Changing displayed numerals or character -strings”  
explained before.  
To change the numerals or character-strings displayed on the NT600S, copy the  
data between the numeral or character-string memory tables by using the “copy  
memory table setting” of the PT status control area.  
NT600S  
PC  
PT status control area  
Memory table  
copy source  
Screen switch setting  
Copy source number  
A
Copy memory  
table setting  
A
Copy destination number  
Copy destination  
(for display)  
A
PT status control setting  
Write a memory table number etc. to the copy memory table setting area in the PT  
status control area in the PC memory. Data will be copied between the memory  
tables in the NT600S and the displayed value will change accordingly.  
Reference  
This procedure is convenient to switch predetermined values or character-strings  
according to the situation. By preparing several units of contents, various con-  
tents can be displayed by switching them to suit the situation.  
[“Copy memory table setting” of the PT status control area]  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit  
Word  
n+1  
0
Copy source memory table # (3-digit BCD)  
Copy destination memory table # (3-digit BCD)  
Copy memory  
table setting  
Copy type  
n+2  
Copy type:  
0: Copy between the character-string memory tables  
1: Copy between the numeral memory tables  
Copy source and destination memory table numbers: 000 to 127  
Character-string memory table: 000 to 255  
Numeral memory table: 000 to 511  
ꢃꢈꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Available allocation words  
The PT status control area can be allocated to the following PC areas:  
Symbol C Series PCs Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
DM Data memory  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Reference  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the PT status control area (PC to PT) to the PC  
memory.  
2. Register the memory tables for the numerals and character-strings to be dis-  
played when creating the screen data by using the support tool.  
To display a character-string, use “character display” and specify the charac-  
ter-string memory table by using the support tool.  
To display numerals, use “numeral display” and specify the numeral memory  
table by using the support tool.  
3. Set the copy source data to the memory table when creating the screen data  
by using the support tool.  
Use “table edit”.  
4. Create a PC program to write the copy type, copy destination memory table  
number, and copy source memory table number to the “copy memory table”  
setting word in the PT status control area.  
ꢃꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
Order for writing to the PT status control area (PC to PT)  
First write the “copy destination memory table number”, and then, write the  
“copy source memory table number” to the PT status control area (PC to PT).  
The NT600S reads the area sometimes when the PC is writing the settings. If the  
“copy source memory table number” has been written first andis changed, unex-  
pected memory table may possibly be changed.  
Allocated words that the NT600S reads  
The NT600S reads the allocated words in the PC for the memory tables which  
need to be displayed. If the copy source memory table is allocated to a PC word,  
it may sometimes be used at the initialization only.  
Use of the “copy type”  
Copy will not be executed when the “copy type” is other than “0” or “1”. The  
memory table copy is executed only when the contents of the area are changed.  
To repeat copying of the same copy source and same copy destination, write a  
value other than “0” or “1” for the copy type, and then, write a correct value again.  
Copying a numeral memory table  
If the display method or the number of registered words include discrepancies, a  
numeral memory table may not be copied and displayed correctly.  
Application Example of Copying of a Character-String Memory Table  
This example gives a PC program to switch the character-string display on the  
screen by using the memory table copy operation as the allocated bit is turned ON  
and OFF.  
Support tool settings  
Allocate the memory as shown below by using the support tool.  
PT status control area allocation: Word 0100  
Contents registered to the screen: Character-string memory table #4  
Line 1  
Normal  
Character-string memory table #4  
Character-string memory table settings  
Number of  
Character Digits  
#
Contents  
4
Normal  
Error  
6 digits  
10  
11  
6 digits  
6 digits  
Normal  
ꢃꢈꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
PC ladder program  
Create a PC ladder program as follows:  
09000  
(1)  
@MOV(21)  
Copy type, copy destination memory table #  
#0004  
102  
Copy destination word  
Error flag  
09000  
@MOV(21)  
#0010  
Copy source memory table #  
Copy source word  
101  
(2)  
@MOV(21)  
#0004  
Copy type, copy destination memory table #  
Copy destination word  
102  
Error flag  
@MOV(21)  
#0011  
Copy source memory table #  
Copy source word  
101  
Program operation  
(1) When an error occurs (bit 09000 turns ON), the NT600S displays the mes-  
sage “Error”.  
(2) When the error is cleared (bit 09000 turns OFF), the NT600S display mes-  
sage reverts to “Normal”.  
ꢃꢈꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-2  
6-2-5  
Upgrading Bar Graphs  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Words)  
The following describes the procedure to upgrade the bar graph display on the  
NT600S by changing the contents of the allocated words.  
To change the bar graph display on the NT600S, change the contents of the PC  
words to which the numeral memory tables have been allocated.  
Available allocation words  
The numeral memory tables can be allocated to the following PC areas:  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data Memory  
Allocation  
CV Series PCs  
Data Memory  
Allocation  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: 1 word only  
: NG  
Reference  
Reference  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
The bar graph display cannot use hexadecimal numbers. If hexadecimal num-  
bers are set, the bar graph will not be displayed.  
By writing a negative number (whose most significant digit is “F”) to the allo-  
cated word of a graph set as “Sign display “No””, the graph display will become 0  
% and the % display will show “  
%”.  
For the procedure to write numeral values to the allocated words of the numeral  
memory tables, refer to “Allocation Words and Display of the Memory Tables”  
(page 167).  
For the procedure to change the contents of the numeral memory table (PC  
words), refer to “Changing Displayed Numerals or Character Strings (Changing  
the Contents of Allocated Words)” (page 170, 172).  
ꢃꢈꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
6-3  
Lamps, Touch Switches, and Numeral Setting  
This section describes bit allocation for lamps and touch switches and the method  
used to find the numeral input using the numeral setting function, when communi-  
cating with the PC using the Host link/NT link/C200H direct.  
Reference  
For details on lamps, touch switches and the numeral setting function, refer to 5-6  
Lamps (page 135), 5-7 Touch Switches (page 138), and 5-8 Numeral Setting  
(page 143).  
6-3-1  
Allocation Bits and Display of Lamps  
Lamps are controlled by allocating them to the PC bits. Set the area and bit num-  
ber.  
Available allocation bits  
The lamps can be allocated to the following PC areas:  
Symbol C Series PCs Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
DM Data memory  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
To set the data memory (DM), specify the word number and then the bit number  
(00 to 15).  
Reference  
Since the special auxiliary relays of the CVM1/CV series PCs are allocated to the  
system, they cannot be used for purposes other than the system use.  
The range of respective area varies with the type of PC. Refer to Appendix L PC  
Memory Map (page 291).  
Controlling the lamps in batch  
More than one lamp can be lit or flashing in batch by registering those lamps to  
the same bit.  
[Example of batch lighting]  
Set the lamps L1 to L5 to the same bit number.  
L1  
L2  
L3  
L1  
L2  
L4  
L5  
L3  
L4  
L5  
ꢃꢉꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
6-3-2  
Turning ON (lit) and OFF (unlit) the Lamps  
(Changing the Contents of Allocated Bits)  
The following describes the procedure to change the lamp display status on the  
NT600S by changing the contents of the allocated bits.  
To change the lamp display status on the NT600S, turn ON and OFF the lamp con-  
trol bit allocated in the PC.  
NT600S  
Lamp #2  
PC  
Lamp #1  
Allocated bit (Lamp #1)  
1 (ON)  
1
Lit  
Unlit  
Allocated bit (Lamp #2)  
0 (OFF)  
2
The lamp control bit indicates the lamp status as follows:  
0 (OFF): Unlit  
1 (ON): Lit (reverse display) or flashing  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to set the PC memory area where the lamp control bit is to  
be allocated to.  
2. Register the lamps to the screen when creating the screen data by using the  
support tool.  
3. Create a PC program to turn ON/OFF the lamp control bit.  
Reference  
Use the support tool to set the lamp display attributes whether the lamp is lit or  
flashing when the lamp control bit is turned ON.  
Application Example to Make the Lamp Light or Flash  
This example gives a procedure to control the bits to move a robot arm and turning  
the lamps ON and OFF.  
Support tool settings  
Allocate the memory as shown below by using the support tool.  
Lamp #0: Word 000200 (output bit to raise robot arm), guide display message  
“UP”  
Lamp #1: Word 000201 (output bit to lower robot arm), guide display message  
“DOWN”  
Lamp #2: Word 000202 (output bit to rotate robot arm counterclockwise),  
guide display message “C/CLOCK”  
Lamp #3: Word 000203 (output bit to rotate robot arm clockwise), guide dis-  
play message “CLOCK”  
Lamp #4: Word 000204 (output bit to clamp rotate robot arm), guide display  
message “CLAMP”  
ꢃꢉꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
Lamp #5: Word 000205 (output bit to unclamp rotate robot arm), guide display  
message “UNCLAMP”  
Contents registered to the screen: Lamp #0 to #5  
UP:  
DOWN:  
C/CLOCK: Lamp#2  
Lamp#0  
Lamp#1  
Line 1  
Process 3  
CLOCK:  
CLAMP:  
UNCLAMP:Lamp#5  
Lamp#3  
Lamp#4  
Conveyor Loading Robot Arm  
UP  
CLAMP  
C/  
CLOCK  
CLOCK  
UNCLAMP  
DOWN  
PC ladder program  
No PC ladder program is required to control the NT600S. Only a program to con-  
trol the robot arm movements is required.  
Program operation  
When the ladder program to control the robot arm is executed, the lamps on the  
NT600S screen turn ON and OFF in synchronization with the robot arm move-  
ment.  
For example, lamp #0 lights when the robot arm moves up and goes out when it  
stops moving up.  
ꢃꢉꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
6-3-3  
Allocated Bits, and Display, of Touch Switches  
Method for PC Notification and NT600S Control  
Two types of bit can be allocated to touch switches: notify bits - which serve to  
notify statuses to the PC - and control bits, lamp bit, which control the lighting  
(flashing) of the touch switches. (For other types of function, only lamp bits can be  
allocated.) When a touch switch is pressed the notify bit status changes and, when  
the lamp bit is ON, the touch switch lights (or flashes).  
NT600S  
PC  
Press  
bit  
Notification  
Control  
START  
1
1  
abcde  
1
Lights  
In order to notify the status of a touch switch to the PC, the touch switch must be  
allocated to a specified PC bit so that it can be managed. Designate the area and  
bit number.  
To use touch switches for notification to the PC, the following settings must be  
made using the support tool: “touch switch” -- bit setting” -- notify bit”.  
Types of notification operation  
When using Ver.5 of the direct connection function, the notification operation  
when the touch switch is pressed can be selected from the following four types  
(with Ver.4 direct connection, the type is fixed as “momentary”):  
- Momentary  
When the touch switch is pressed the bit comes ON; when it is released the bit  
goes OFF.  
- Alternate  
Each time the touch switch is pressed, the bit status changes from ON to OFF  
or OFF to ON.  
- Set  
When the touch switch is pressed, the bit comes ON and remains ON even if  
the switch is pressed again.  
- Reset  
When the touch switch is pressed, the bit goes OFF and remains OFF even if  
the switch is pressed again.  
ꢃꢉꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
Notes on the Notification Operation  
The touch switch notification operations are as follows:  
When Using C200H Direct  
Communication or NT Link with  
other than DM Area  
Type of Notification  
Operation  
When Using Host Link or  
NT Link with DM Area  
(1)Notification in word units  
(other bits go OFF)  
Momentary  
(3)Notification in bit units  
(2)Notification in word units  
(however, the word contents  
are read on display and noti-  
fication is based on this  
reading)  
Alternate  
Set  
Reset  
(4)Notification in bit units  
When using touch switch input notification, note the following points:  
- In the case of (1), the other bits in the same word as the notification bit are  
turned OFF by the notification operation.  
- In the case of (2), notification is executed on the basis of the contents of the  
word before display, which means that the other bits are not rewritten. Howev-  
er, if the word contents are changed at the PC side, they will be rewritten based  
on the contents before display.  
- If the screen is switched while a momentary key is being pressed, the touch  
switch itself disappears, so the status “OFF” is notified. In the case of (1) this  
means that the other bits in the word will also be turned OFF.  
- When using the host link, or NT link with the DM area, do not allocate momen-  
tary touch switches and other types of touch switch to the same word, since  
the notification operations are different.  
In the case of (3) and (4), the notification operation has no influence on the other  
bits in the word.  
Possible bit allocations  
Notify bits and lamp bits for touch switches can be allocated to the areas of the  
PC memory listed in the following table.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data Memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data Memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Since all the CVM1/CV-series special auxiliary relays are allocated to the system,  
they cannot be used for applications not related to the system.  
The range of each memory area differs according to the PC type. See “Appendix M  
PC Memory Map” (page 292 of the APPENDICES) for more details.  
When making a data memory (DM) specification, specify the bit number (00 to 15)  
following the word number.  
ꢃꢉꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
6-3-4  
Lit (Flashing) and Unlit Touch Switch Statuses  
(Changing the Status of Allocated Bits)  
This section describes how to change the statuses of allocated bits and thereby  
the statuses of the touch switches displayed by the NT600S.  
The statuses of touch switches displayed by the NT600S are changed by switch-  
ing the control bits allocated in the PC memory ON and OFF.  
NT600S  
PC  
Allocated bit (touch switch #1)  
1 (ON)  
1
Lit  
Touch switch 1  
The status of the control bit reflects the touch switch status, as follows:  
0 (OFF): Unlit  
1 (ON):  
Lit (inverse display) or flashing  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the touch switch control bits to the PC memory.  
2. When creating the screen data using the support tool, register the touch switch  
for a screen.  
3. Create the PC program to switch the control bit of the touch switch ON and  
OFF.  
Reference  
Set whether a touch switch will be continuously lit or blink when its bit has been  
turned ON by setting the support tool touch switch display attributes.  
6-3-5  
Notifying the PC that a Switch has been Pressed  
(Determining Touch Switch Status)  
This section describes how the status of a touch switch (whether it has been  
pressed or not) is ascertained.  
With the NT600S, when a touch switch is pressed, the notify bit allocated to that  
touch switch in the PC memory is automatically notified.  
Touch switch 1  
NT600S  
PC  
ated notify bit (touch switch #1)  
1
ꢃꢉꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
The status of the notify bit reflects the touch switch status, as follows:  
Momentary: 0 (OFF) ... Not pressed  
1 (ON) ... Pressed  
Alternate : The bit allocated for notification is set to 1 (ON) if currently 0, and to  
0 (OFF) if currently 1.  
Set  
: The bit allocated for notification is forcibly set to 1 (ON).  
: The bit allocated for notification is forcibly set to 0 (OFF).  
Reset  
The status of a touch switch is determined by checking the ON/OFF status of its  
notify bit.  
The touch switch notify bits can be allocated to the following areas of the PC  
memory.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
When making a data memory (DM) specification, specify the bit number (00 to 15)  
following the word number.  
Reference  
It is not possible to allocate a momentary switch to the same word as an alter-  
nate/set/reset switch.  
Since all the CVM1/CV-series special auxiliary relays are allocated to the sys-  
tem, they cannot be used for applications not related to the system.  
The range of each memory area differs according to the PC type. See “Appendix L  
PC Memory Map” (page 291) for more details.  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the touch switch notify bits to the PC memory.  
2. When creating the screen data using the support tool, register the touch switch  
for a screen.  
3. Create the PC program to switch the notify bit of the touch switch ON and OFF.  
ꢃꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
Important Points  
When Using C200H Direct  
Communication or NT Link with  
other than DM Area  
Type of Notification  
Operation  
When Using Host Link or  
NT Link with DM Area  
(1)Notification in word units  
(other bits go OFF)  
Momentary  
(3)Notification in bit units  
(2)Notification in word units  
(however, the word contents  
are read on display and noti-  
fication is based on this  
reading)  
Alternate  
Set  
Reset  
(4)Notification in bit units  
When using touch switch input notification, note the following points:  
- In the case of (1), the other bits in the same word as the notification bit are turned  
OFF by the notification operation.  
Press the  
touch switch  
15 14  
1
0
0
1
15 14  
Bit  
1
1
0
0
Bit  
0
1
0
0
Touch switch  
notify bit  
Bits other than notify  
bits are set to 0 (OFF).  
- In the case of (2), notification is executed on the basis of the contents of the word  
before display, which means that the other bits are not rewritten. However, if the  
word contents are changed at the PC side, they will be rewritten based on the  
contents before display.  
- If the screen is switched while a momentary key is being pressed, the touch  
switch itself disappears, so the status “OFF” is notified. In the case of (1) this  
means that the other bits in the word will also be turned OFF.  
- When using the host link, or NT link with the DM area, do not allocate momentary  
touch switches and other types of touch switch to the same word, since the notifi-  
cation operations are different.  
In the case of (3) and (4), the notification operation has no influence on the other  
bits in the word.  
Application  
This example uses the touch switches as normal switches (bits) in order to use the  
NT600S as an operating panel.  
Support Tool Settings  
Make the following settings using the support tool.  
Touch switch #10:  
Function “Notify Bit”  
Display attribute “Light”  
Control bit CH05000 (Run flag) ... Guide message: “RUN”  
Notify bit CH 06000  
ꢃꢉꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
Touch switch #11:  
Function “Notify Bit”  
Display attribute “Light”  
Control bit CH 05001 (Stop flag) ... Guide message: “STOP”  
Notify bit CH 06001  
Data registered for the screen: touch switch #10, touch switch #11  
Touch switch #10  
Line 1  
RUN  
STOP  
Touch switch #11  
PC program  
Create the following ladder program.  
1 scan ON  
Touch switch #10 notify bit  
11212  
06000  
Stop flag  
(touch switch #11 control bit)  
05001  
06001  
05001  
Touch switch #11 notify bit  
Touch switch #10 notify bit  
06000  
06001  
05000  
Run flag  
(touch switch #10 control bit)  
05000  
Touch switch #11 notify bit  
ꢃꢉꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
Program operation  
The operation when the program is executed is presented below.  
Execute program  
Stop flag  
:
1 (ON)  
Stop touch switch : Lit  
Press Run touch switch.  
Press Stop touch switch.  
Run flag  
Run touch switch : Lit  
Stop flag 0 (OFF)  
Stop touch switch : Unlit  
:
1 (ON)  
Run flag  
Run touch switch : Unlit  
Stop flag 1 (ON)  
Stop touch switch : Lit  
:
0 (OFF)  
:
:
6-3-6  
Notification of Numbers to the PC  
This section describes how the numerical data input at an NT600S is ascertained  
by the PC.  
In order to determine when numerical data has been input at the NT600S, the nu-  
meral setting strobe flag in the PT status notify area is used. In order to determine  
the upgraded numeral memory table number, the “content upgrade memory table”  
in the PT status notify area is used.  
When numerical data is input at the NT600S, this is automatically notified to the PT  
status notify area (PT PC) allocated in the PC memory as follows.  
Notification of upgrade:  
PT status numeral setting strobe flag  
turned ON (1)  
Upgraded numeral table number: Stored in the “content upgrade memory  
table”  
When the PC reads the “content upgrade memory table” at the leading edge of the  
numeral setting strobe flag, it determines the numeral memory table number in  
which the numerical data that was changed at the NT600S is stored.  
NT600S  
PC  
12345678  
12345678  
Currently displayed screen  
Content upgrade  
memory table  
Table No.  
Numeral setting  
strobe flag  
PT status  
1  
12345678  
ꢃꢉꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
[“Content upgrade memory table” in the PT status notify area and PT status]  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit  
Word  
m+1  
0
Numerl memory table # (BCD, 3 digits)  
Content upgrade memory table  
0
0
PT status  
PT status  
m+2  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
-- -- --  
9
0
8
0
Bit  
PT status  
0
0
Numeral setting strobe flag  
Numeral memory table #: 000 to 511  
Data is written to the content upgrade memory table as three digits of BCD (binary  
coded decimal) data.  
When the numeral setting strobe flag bit has been notified to the PC it returns to the  
OFF (0) status.  
For details on the method for storing a number in the word allocated for the numer-  
al table, see “Allocation Words and Display of the Memory Tables” (page 167).  
Restrictions on allocating words  
The PT status notify area can be allocated to the PC memory areas listed in the  
following table.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Reference  
Since all the CVM1/CV-series special auxiliary relays are allocated to the system,  
they cannot be used for applications not related to the system.  
The range of each memory area differs according to the PC type. See “Appendix L  
PC Memory Map” (page 291) for more details.  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the PT status notify area (PT PC) to the PC  
memory.  
2. Using the support tool, create a numeral setting screen and allocate the nu-  
meral memory table to the PC memory.  
3. Create a PC program for reading the “content upgrade memory table” in the  
PT status notify area when the numeral setting strobe flag in the PT status  
notify area comes ON (1).  
4. Read the allocated word for the numeral memory table number read in step 3.  
ꢃꢊꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-3  
Application Example  
This example shows the reading of the numeral memory table number after a val-  
ue has been changed by inputting numerical data at the NT600S.  
Setting at the support tool  
Make the following settings using the support tool.  
Allocated word for the PT status notify area : CH0110  
Numeral memory table entry No.3: DM 0005 (saved word: One)  
Numeral memory table entry No.4: DM 0006 (saved word: One)  
Data registered for the screens:  
Numeral setting 1 ... Reference table “numeral memory table #3”  
Numeral setting 2 ... Reference table “numeral memory table #4”  
Numeral memory table entry number 3 (4-digit input)  
Line 1  
Qty.  
800  
unit  
Defect limit  
30  
unit  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
CLR +/--  
Numeral memory table entry number 4 (4-digit input)  
PC program  
Create the following PC ladder program.  
11211  
(1)  
@MOV(21)  
Notification word for content upgrade memory table  
Word that stores the numeral memory table number  
111  
DM0105  
Numeral setting  
strobe flag  
Program operation  
(1) When the numeral setting strobe flag (bit 11211) comes ON (1), the contents  
of CH-0111 (the word where the content upgrade memory table is located) are  
transferred to DM 0105. The number of the numeral memory table that con-  
tains the upgraded data is stored in DM 0105 (in this case it is 003 or 004).  
If the numeral memory table is allocated to a PC word, the value input to it can  
be read easily by referring to the allocated word.  
In this case, the contents of numeral memory table #3 are stored in DM 0005  
and the contents of numeral memory table #4 are stored in DM 0006.  
ꢃꢊꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-4  
6-4  
NT600S Status Control  
The statuses of the NT600S can be controlled from the PC by writing control data  
to the “PT status control bits” of the PT status control area allocated in the PC  
memory.  
NT600S  
PC  
Buzzer s
Copy memory table  
setting  
PT status control bits  
Control data  
6-4-1  
Controllable NT600S Functions  
[“PT status control bits” of the PT status control area]  
1514131211 10 9  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 Bit  
Word  
n+3  
0
0
PT status control designation  
PT status control bits  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
8
Bit  
0
0
0
Item Controlled  
1 (ON)  
0 (OFF)  
OFF  
Screen display (Note 1)  
ON  
Processing priority  
registration  
ON  
OFF  
(Note 2)  
Continuous buzzer  
Intermittent buzzer  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
Backlight mode  
(Note 3)  
ON  
Flash  
Note 1: When “Screen display = ON”, the back-  
light/EL display is ON and when  
“Screen display = OFF”, the backlight/  
EL display is OFF.  
Note 2: Priority registration is only valid when  
NT link (1:N) is set.  
Note 3: These functions cannot be used for  
NT600S-ST211.  
The PC status control bits remain unchanged if the NT600S status is changed with  
the screen attributes or memory switches, which means that the statuses of the  
PT status control bits do not match the actual status of the NT600S. For example,  
the buzzer may sound even though the setting for continuous buzzer bit 13 is  
“OFF”.  
In this kind of case, control the NT600S by using the PT status control bits.  
ꢃꢊꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-4  
Screen display (bit 15)  
The screen display bit is used to display and clear the screen to prevent “burn-in”  
on the CRT. Set bit 15 to 0 (OFF) to clear the screen. (When the LCD display unit  
is used, the backlight will also go OFF at the same time.)  
When the screen has been cleared, the last displayed screencan beredisplayed  
either by turning Bit 15 ON, or by pressing a touch switch. (When the LCD dis-  
play unit is used, The backlight will also light at the same time.)  
Reference  
Instead of turning Bit 15 ON, a screen can be displayed by specifying its screen  
number. For details on screen switching, see “Switching the Screen Display”  
(page 160).  
Priority registration for processing (NT link 1:N connections only) (bit 14)  
It is possible to register one of the multiple PTs connected by the 1:N NT link  
method to have processing priority. The PT for which bit 14 is set ON (1) is given  
priority over the other PTs and has a higher response speed for display, touch  
switches, etc.  
When bit 14 is turned OFF (0), this registration is canceled and the normal re-  
sponse speed is reinstated. If priority registration is set for more than one PT, the  
one for which the registration was made last will have priority.  
By word monitoring with C200HX/HG/HE, the unit number of the PT for which  
priority registration has been set can be confirmed. For details on the monitoring  
operation at the PC side, refer to the manual for the PC used.  
[Connection to RS-232C port of C200HX/HG/HE]  
Channel  
Bit  
0
Unit No.0 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.1 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.2 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.3 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.4 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.5 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.6 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.7 Communication in progress flag, ON when connected  
Unit No.0 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.1 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.2 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.3 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.4 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.5 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.6 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
Unit No.7 Priority registration lamp, ON when registered  
CIO265CH (standard port)  
CIO284CH (port A) (*)  
CIO285CH (port B) (*)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
(*) This is the port of the communication board.  
ꢃꢊꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-4  
Continuous buzzer (bit 13) and intermittent buzzer (bit 12)  
In the case of both buzzers, when the respective bit is ON the buzzer sounds and  
when it is OFF the buzzer does not sound.  
The “continuous buzzer” sounds continuously without interruption.  
The “intermittent buzzer” sounds for 0.5 seconds at 0.5 second intervals.  
If both Bit 13 and Bit 12 are turned ON simultaneously, Bit 13 takes priority and  
the continuous buzzer is selected.  
Reference  
Another way to stop a buzzer sounding is to use a touch switch to which the  
buzzer stop attribute function is allocated.  
Whether or not the buzzer actually sounds also depends on the setting of the  
“buzzer” memory switch of the NT600S. For details on this setting, see “Using  
the buzzer” (page 94).  
Besides operations with the PT status bits, the buzzer status can also be  
controlled using the screen attributes.  
The screen attributes are set with the support tool.  
Buzzer attribute: The setting for this attribute determines whether the  
buzzer is sounded or not and the type of buzzer sound if  
it is sounded.  
Backlight mode (bit 8) (NT600S-ST121 only)  
If bit 8 is turned ON when the screen is displayed (bit 15 = ON), the screen is  
made to flash using the backlight. When bit 8 is turned OFF, normal display is  
resumed.  
When the screen is not displayed (bit 15 = OFF), the backlight mode is invalid.  
Reference  
It is possible to use NT600S switch settings to make the backlight go off auto-  
matically after a set time during which there have been no operations.  
Besides using PT status control bit operations, the NT600S status can also be  
controlled by the screen attributes. The screen attributes are set by using the  
support tool. The functions that can be set using the screen attributes are the  
following:  
Buzzer attribute: Set whether or not the buzzer will sound when the  
screen is displayed and, if it sounds, the type of buzzer.  
ꢃꢊꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-4  
6-4-2  
How to Control NT600S Functions  
This section describes how to control the functions of the NT600S.  
Restrictions on allocating words  
The PT status control area (PC PT) can be allocated to the PC memory areas  
listed in the following table.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
Reference  
Since all the CVM1/CV-series special auxiliary relays are allocated to the system,  
they cannot be used for applications not related to the system.  
The range of each memory area differs according to the PC type. See “Appendix L  
PC Memory Map” (page 291) for more details.  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the PT status control area (PC PT) to the PC  
memory.  
2. Create a PC program to write control data to the “PT status control bits” of the  
PT status control area.  
Control timing of PT status control bits  
The PT status control area (PC PT) is not read when the NT600S starts up. It  
is only read, and control is only executed, when the contents of the PT status  
control area are changed after the NT600S has been started up.  
Since control of the NT600S statuses is executed after the bits corresponding to  
the PT status control bits have changed, to execute control again the corre-  
sponding bits must be specified again.  
Application  
This example is of the NT600S being used as a warning lamp by using PT status  
control bits.  
Support Tool Settings  
Make the following setting using the support tool.  
Allocated word for the PT status control area: 0100  
ꢃꢊꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-4  
PC program  
Create the following PC ladder program.  
09002  
09003  
(1)  
@MOV(21)  
#A000  
Display the screen, sound continuous buzzer  
Word for PT status control  
103  
09003  
(2)  
@MOV(21)  
#9000  
Display the screen, sound intermittent buzzer  
Word for PT status control  
103  
09003  
09002  
(3)  
@ANDW(34)  
103  
Word for PT status control  
Only continuous and intermittent buzzers are “0”  
Word for PT status control  
#CFFF  
103  
Program operation  
(1) The PT status control bits are set as shown below when bit 09002 turns OFF.  
This command block is not executed when bit 09003 is ON.  
Screen display (bit 15)  
1 (ON)  
1 (ON)  
Continuous buzzer (bit 13)  
The NT600S continuous buzzer sounds.  
(2) The PT status control bits are set as shown below when bit 09003 turns OFF.  
Screen display (bit 15)  
1 (ON)  
1 (ON)  
Intermittent buzzer (bit 12)  
The NT600S intermittent buzzer sounds.  
(3) The PT status control bits are set as shown below when both bits 09002 and  
09003 turn ON.  
Continuous buzzer (bit 13)  
Intermittent buzzer (bit 12)  
The NT600S buzzer stops.  
0 (OFF)  
0 (OFF)  
ꢃꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-5  
6-5  
Notification of the Operating Status to the PC  
(Determining the NT600S Operating Status)  
The status (operating statuses, etc.) of the NT600S can be determined from the  
PC by reading the “PT status” word in the PT status notify area allocated in the PC  
memory.  
NT600S  
PC  
PT status notify area  
Currently displayed screen  
Content upgrade memory table  
PT status  
Screen  
number  
PT stopped  
6-5-1  
Ascertainable NT600S Statuses (Notified Operating Statuses)  
[“PT status notification bits” of the PT status notify area]  
1514131211 10 9  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0 Bit  
Word  
m+2  
PT status notification bits  
0
0
PT status  
15 14 13 12 11 10  
9
8
Bit  
0
0
0
0
PT operating status  
(1(ON) = operating / 0 (OFF) = stopped)  
Battery  
(1 (ON) = low / 0 (OFF) = normal)  
Screen switch strobe flag  
Numeral setting strobe flag  
The NT600S statuses that the PC can determine are listed below.  
Low voltage of battery installed in NT600S (battery: option)  
NT600S operating/stopped status  
Screen switches  
Data input  
PT operating status (bit 15)  
When the NT600S is in the RUN mode this bit is set to ON (1). In other modes  
and while the system menu is displayed it is OFF (0). When this bit is OFF allo-  
cated bits and words cannot be read or written to.  
During the run mode, ON (1) is periodically written into this bit. In order to check  
whether the NT600S is operating normally or not, write OFF (0) to this bit : if it is  
ON (1) 30 seconds later the NT600S is running, and if it is OFF (0), the NT600S  
is stopped.  
Caution  
In order to ensure system safety, be sure to periodically read the PT operating  
status bit at the host during operation to confirm that the PT is always operating  
correctly.  
ꢃꢊꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-5  
Battery (bit 13)  
If the voltage of the backup battery for the NT600S memory becomes low, this bit  
is set to ON (1).  
- This bit is valid only when DIP switch 2-8 is ON (1).  
- Backup battery is optional.  
Screen switch strobe flag (bit 12)  
When the screen displayed on the NT600S is switched by a designation from the  
PC or by the standalone function, the screen switch strobe flag comes ON (1).  
On notification to the PC, it returns to the OFF (0) status.  
For details on how the screen switch strobe flag is used, see “Notifying the dis-  
play screen to the PC” (page 162).  
Numeral setting strobe flag (bit 11)  
When numerical data is input to a numeral table using the NT600S numeral set-  
ting function, the numeral setting strobe flag comes ON (1). On notification to the  
PC, it returns to the OFF (0) status.  
For details on how the numeral setting strobe flag is used, see “Notification of  
Numbers to the PC” (page 189).  
6-5-2  
Reading the NT600S Operating Statuses  
This section explains how to determine the status of the NT600S, and ascertain its  
operating status.  
To ascertain the operating status of the NT600S, “PT status” is used.  
The NT600S automatically notifies information such as the operating status to the  
PT status word of the PT status notify area (PT PC) allocated to the PC memory  
as shown below.  
Notification of operation mode:  
Notification of low battery voltage:  
Notification of screen switching:  
PT operating status  
Battery  
Screen switch strobe flag  
Notification of numerical data upgrade: Numeral setting strobe flag  
Restrictions on allocating words  
The PT status notify area (PT PC) can be allocated to the PC memory areas  
listed in the following table.  
Symbol  
DM  
C Series PCs  
Data memory  
Allocated CVM1/CV Series PCs Allocated  
Data memory  
CH  
TIM  
CNT  
HR  
AR  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Internal/Special Relay  
Timer  
Counter  
Counter  
Holding Relay  
Auxiliary Relay  
Link Relay  
--  
Auxiliary Relay  
--  
LR  
: OK  
: NG  
ꢃꢊꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-5  
Reference  
Since all the CVM1/CV-series special auxiliary relays are allocated to the system,  
they cannot be used for applications not related to the system.  
The range of each memory area differs according to the PC type. See “Appendix L  
PC Memory Map” (page 291) for more details.  
Procedure 1. Use the support tool to allocate the PT status notify area (PT PC) to the PC  
memory.  
2. Write a PC program to read the “PT status” word of the PT status notify area  
and check each bit status.  
Report timing of PT status notify bit  
The information in the PC status notify area (PT PC) is written to the PC when  
the NT600S status is changed during operation.  
Example of Using the PT Status Notify Bit  
An operation example in which the NT600S status is checked by operating the PT  
status notify bit is explained below.  
Setting by the support tool  
Perform the following setting with the support tool.  
PT status notify area allocated word:  
PT error storage area allocated word:  
PC program  
CH0110  
DM0001  
Create the following PC ladder program.  
11215  
11213  
11213  
(1)  
@MOV(21)  
#1  
NT600S: stopped, Battery: low  
PT status error storage word  
DM0001  
(2)  
@MOV(21)  
#2  
NT600S: stopped, Battery: normal  
PT status error storage word  
DM0001  
11213  
11213  
11215  
(3)  
@MOV(21)  
#3  
NT600S: operating, Battery: low  
PT status error storage word  
DM0001  
(4)  
@MOV(21)  
#4  
NT600S: operating, Battery: normal  
PT status error storage word  
DM0001  
ꢃꢊꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5-5  
Program operation  
(1) If PT operating status (contact 11215) is turned OFF (0) and battery (con-  
tact 11213) is turned ON (1), “1” (NT600S stop, low battery voltage) is trans-  
mitted to DM0001.  
(2) If PT operating status (contact 11215) is turned OFF (0) and battery (con-  
tact 11213) is turned OFF (0), “2” (NT600S stop, normal battery voltage) is  
transmitted to DM0001.  
(3) If PT operating status (contact 11215) is turned ON (1) and battery (contact  
11213) is turned ON (1), “3” (NT600S running, low battery voltage) is trans-  
mitted to DM0001.  
(4) If PT operating status (contact 11215) is turned ON (1) and battery (contact  
11213) is turned OFF (0), “4” (NT600S running, normal battery voltage) is  
transmitted to DM0001.  
ꢄꢋꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SECTION 7  
Using the RS-232C Interface Unit  
This section describes how to use the NT600S when it is connected to a Host using the RS-232C interface.  
7-1 RS-232C Interface Unit Communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202  
7-1-1 Communication Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202  
7-1-2 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204  
7-1-3 Notification and Control of Touch Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205  
7-1-4 Table of Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
7-2 Commands Sent by the Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208  
7-2-1 Displaying the Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208  
7-2-2 Memory Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209  
7-2-3 Lamps and Touch Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212  
7-2-4 Controlling the NT600S Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215  
7-3 Commands Sent by the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
7-3-1 Screen Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
7-3-2 Memory Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
7-3-3 Lamps and Touch Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
7-4 Terminal Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
7-4-1 Clearing the Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
7-4-2 Displaying a Character-String . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
7-4-3 Displaying Figures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226  
7-5 Key to Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
7-5-1 Use of Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228  
7-6 EXAMPLE PROGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229  
ꢄꢋꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-1  
7-1  
RS-232C Interface Unit Communications  
The communication procedure through the RS-232C circuit and the program flow  
using examples in BASIC are described below.  
7-1-1  
Communication Procedure  
The Host and NT600S communicate according to the following procedure.  
1, 2, 3... 1. The RS-232C circuit must be opened (i.e., communication enabled) before  
communication can start.  
2. Commands are used to control the PT and to receive notification from the  
NT600S.  
3. Close the RS-232C circuit again after communication is complete.  
Host program  
NT600S operation  
RS-232C circuit  
Open circuit  
OPEN command  
Send instruction  
Receive instruction  
Send instruction  
PRINT # command  
Open  
status  
Send instruction  
LINE INPUT # command  
CLOSE command  
Close circuit  
After a circuit has been opened, it can be used until it is closed again.  
OPEN  
Opens the RS-232C circuit. The Host communication conditions are also set.  
Refer to 4-6-4 Setting the RS-232C Communication Conditions.  
PRINT #  
Sends an instruction via the RS-232C circuit to the NT600S.  
LINE INPUT #  
Receives a command from the NT600S. This command is used because com-  
mands from the NT600S are not delimited by commas or double-quotation marks.  
CLOSE  
Closes the RS-232C circuit.  
Reference  
Refer to the Host’s BASIC Manual for more details about the commands.  
ꢄꢋꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-1  
Operation by Operating Commands  
The following describes control of the NT600S using the operating commands,  
and the flow of notifications from the NT600S.  
For the actual procedure for using the operating commands, refer to 7-2 Com-  
mands Sent by the Host (page 208) and 7-3 Commands Sent by the NT600S  
(page 218).  
The operating commands display monitored data from the production line and  
messages to the factory workers. They are also used for NT600S control and  
management.  
The communication flow between the Host and NT600S differs according to the  
following three cases:  
Message from Host to NT600S  
Host program  
NT600S operation  
Message operating command  
Message to PT  
Process message  
Enquiry from Host to NT600S  
Host program  
NT600S operation  
Enquiry operating command  
Response operating command  
Enquiry  
Receive command  
Send response command  
Receive command  
Notification of Operation at NT600S to the Host  
Host program  
NT600S operation  
Notification operating command  
Receive notification  
Send notification command  
Operation by Terminal Commands  
The following describes control of the NT600S using the terminal commands.  
For the actual procedure for using the terminal commands, refer to 7-4 Terminal  
Commands (page 222).  
The terminal commands allow the NT600S to be used as a terminal of the Host to  
display text and graphics independently of the screens stored in the NT600S.  
The Host sends a command and the NT600S processes the message. The  
NT600S does not send back a response to the Host.  
Host program  
NT600S operation  
Terminal command  
Message to PT  
Process message  
ꢄꢋꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-1  
7-1-2  
Precautions  
Some important points to consider when using commands are listed below.  
Command Length  
If a mistake during command specification results in a command being too long,  
the correct length of the command is executed and the remainder is ignored.  
A timeout error results if a mistake during command specification results in a com-  
mand being too short.  
Interval Between  
Transmitted Commands  
As a small number of bytes is transmitted by the Host, the interval between trans-  
missions should not exceed 5 seconds if a command is divided up for transmis-  
sion. A timeout error occurs if the interval between transmissions exceeds 5 se-  
conds.  
When commands are sent too frequently, a buffer overflow error may occur if the  
NT600S cannot keep up with the command processing.  
Control of the NT600S status by the operating commands is restricted by the  
NT600S memory switch settings as listed below.  
Controlling PT Status with  
Operating Commands  
Operating command  
Restriction from memory switch  
setting  
Buzzer control command [ESC] T  
Effective when buzzer turned on  
The entire command is ignored if any point specified at coordinates X, Y with the  
Terminal commands lies outside the screen.  
Coordinate Specification  
with the Terminal  
Commands  
Reference  
If the “automatic reset after communication” memory switch of the NT600S is set  
to ON, no message is displayed when a communication error occurs.  
ꢄꢋꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-1  
7-1-3  
Notification and Control of Touch Switches  
If a touch switch is pressed, the corresponding touch switch number or bit informa-  
tion is sent to the Host. Conversely, to turn ON a touch switch or cause it to flash,  
the touch switch number or bit information is sent from the Host.  
The type of data relating to the touch switch notification is specified with the “bit  
input attribute” in the screen attributes when creating the screen data with the sup-  
port tool. It is not permissible to use both notification and control by a touch switch  
number and notification and control by bit information on the same screen.  
NT600S  
HOST  
Press  
START  
abcde  
Touch switch number or  
bit information  
Lighting command  
Lit  
Bit touch switch method (bit input permitted setting)  
If a touch switch is pressed, bit information is sent in accordance with the posi-  
tion of the touch switch. When this method is used, if more than one touch switch  
is pressed at the same time, the information of all the pressed touch switches (0  
to 63) is reported to the Host.  
Touch switch number method (bit input not-permitted setting)  
If the touch switch status is changed, the touch switch number set when the  
touch switch is created is sent as a 3-digit hexadecimal number.  
Note  
If the touch switches are set in the following positions using the support tool while  
the setting is “bit input permitted”, the following operations will occur due to the  
configuration of the touch switches.  
Take this into consideration when setting touch switch areas.  
Example 1:  
Touch switches are set at positions A, B, C, and D using the minimum switch set-  
ting unit.  
If switches A, B, and C are turned ON at the  
same time, switch D is also set ON.  
A
C
B
Similarly, if switches A, B, and D are turned ON  
at the same time, switch C is also set ON.  
D
Example 2:  
Touch switch areas E, F, and G are set.  
E
F
If switches E and F are turned ON at the same  
time, switch G is also set ON.  
G
ꢄꢋꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-1  
7-1-4  
Table of Commands  
Operating Commands  
Type  
Command  
Name  
Page  
208  
209  
209  
210  
210  
211  
212  
213  
213  
214  
214  
215  
215  
216  
216  
216  
217  
218  
218  
219  
219  
220  
221  
221  
Screen control  
[ESC] 0  
[ESC] X  
[ESC] B  
[ESC] C  
[ESC] D  
[ESC] /  
Display Specified Screen  
Request Screen Number  
Memory table op-  
eration  
Write Character-string Memory Table  
4-digit Write Numeral Memory Table  
8-digit Write Numeral Memory Table  
Copy Memory Table  
Lamp and Touch  
Switch Display  
[ESC] K  
[ESC] Q  
[ESC] R  
[ESC] U  
[ESC] V  
[ESC] P  
[ESC] T  
[ESC] W  
[ESC] Z  
[ESC] ]  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display (Bit Specification)  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display (Number Specification)  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Enquiry  
Touch Switch Disable  
Touch Switch and  
Function Key Input  
Touch Switch Enable  
System Control  
Screen Display Control  
Buzzer Control  
System Menu Display Permission  
PT Status Enquiry  
Initialize Display History  
[ESC] _  
[ESC] Y  
[ESC] E  
[ESC] F  
[ESC] S  
[ESC] J  
[ESC] H  
[ESC] [  
Display Mode Control  
Notification  
Screen Number Response  
4-digit Number Input Notify  
8-digit Number Input Notify  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Response  
Touch Switch Bit Output (from NT600S to Host)  
Touch Switch Number Output (from NT600S to Host)  
PT Battery Status Response  
Terminal Commands  
ꢄꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Type  
Command  
[ESC] &  
[ESC] )  
[ESC]  
Name  
Page  
222  
222  
223  
223  
224  
224  
224  
225  
225  
226  
226  
227  
Delete  
Clear Screen  
Character Size  
Character Specify Size  
Specify Character Enlargement  
Normal Display  
Character Display  
Attributes  
[ESC] !  
[ESC] ”  
[ESC] #  
[ESC] $  
[ESC] %  
[ESC] +  
[ESC] 4  
[ESC] 7  
[ESC] 8  
Set Inverse Display  
End Inverse Display  
Set Flashing Display  
End Flashing Display  
Set Cursor Position  
Specify Displayed Characters  
Draw Polyline  
Character String  
Display  
Graphic Display  
Draw Circle  
ꢄꢋꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
7-2  
Commands Sent by the Host  
The operating commands sent by the Host are described below.  
Note  
All data values must be sent in ASCII code.  
Example:  
m
m
2
1
35  
41  
2-bit hexadecimal 5AH  
d
d
d
1
1
2
31  
32  
33  
3-bit BCD  
123  
7-2-1  
Displaying the Screen  
This section describes the procedure for screen display by the Host and also that  
for checking the displayed screen. For details on the screen display function of the  
NT600S, refer to 5-2 Outline of Functions (page 119) and 5-3 Screen Display  
(page 124).  
Switching the Display Screen  
By sending a command from the Host, the specified screen is displayed.  
If a screen number is specified by the Host using the following command, the dis-  
play screen is switched to the corresponding screen (screen number: 1 to 1000).  
Screen number 0 is a white screen (no display).  
Continuous screens and overlapping screens  
- To display continuous screens or overlapping screens, it is necessary to speci-  
fy a parent screen. If a child screen is specified, only the specified screen is  
displayed.  
Reference  
For continuous screens and overlapping screens, refer to 5-3 Screen Display  
(page 124).  
Display Specified Screen  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
0
m
m
m
m
4
1
2
3
30  
m m m m : Number of displayed screen (4-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
4
0000: No display  
0001 to 03E8 : Screen #1 to #1000  
H
Description  
The specified screen is displayed on the NT600S when a screen number is sent  
from the Host with this command.  
ꢄꢋꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Inquiry of the displayed screen  
A screen number can be inquired using the following command to know the num-  
ber of the displayed screen.  
Request Screen Number  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
x
58  
Description  
Enquires what number screen is displayed on the NT600S. The NT600S returns  
the number of the displayed screen using the Screen Number Response Com-  
mand (refer to 7-3 Screen Number Response).  
7-2-2  
Memory Tables  
The procedure used for writing character-strings/numerals to memory tables from  
the Host is described below.  
For the functions of memory tables, refer to 5-4 Memory Tables (page 128).  
Writing Character-Strings  
A character-string can be written to a character-string memory table in the  
NT600S using the following command.  
Write Character-string Memory Table  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
B
n
n
d
d
c
c
c
c
n
1
2
1
2
1
2
3
42  
n n :  
Character string length as a number of normal characters (2-digit  
hexadecimal)  
1
2
01 to 28 (1 to 40)  
H
d d :  
Character-string memory table address of write destination  
(2-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
00 to FF (0 to 255)  
H
c c c to c : Character-string data  
1 2 3  
n
Description  
Writes the character-string data to the character-string memory table.  
The character-string data can contain a mixture of normal alphanumeric charac-  
ters and marks. When determining the character string length, count each mark as  
two normal characters.  
ꢄꢋꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Reference  
If the actual character string is longer than the specified character string length,  
the specified number of characters is written and the remainder are discarded.  
A timeout error message is displayed if the actual character string is shorter than  
the specified character string length.  
Writing Numerals  
A numeral (4 digits or 8 digits) can be written to a numeral table in the NT600S  
using the following commands.  
4-digit Write Numeral Memory Table  
Format  
[ESC]  
C
d
d
d
n
n
n
n
4
1
2
3
1
2
3
1B  
43  
d d d : Numeral memory table address of write destination (3-digit hexadeci-  
1
2
3
mal)  
000 to 1FF (o to 511)  
H
n n n n : Number data (4-digit BCD or 4-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
4
Description  
Writes 4-digit number data (decimal or hexadecimal) to the specified numeral  
table.  
If a 4-digit number data is written while an 8-digit numeral is displayed, the lower  
4 digits are updated.  
8-digit Write Numeral Memory Table  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
D
d
3
d
d
n
n
n
n
n
5
1
2
1
2
3
4
44  
n
n
n
8
6
7
d d d : Numeral memory table address of write destination (3-digit hexadeci-  
1
2
3
mal)  
000 to 1FF (0 to 511)  
H
n n n n n n n n : Number data (8-digit BCD or 8-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Description  
Writes the 8-digit number data (decimal or hexadecimal) to the specified numer-  
al memory table  
To write a negative numeral (decimal), specify “F” for “n ” (in this case, a 7-digit  
1
numeral is written.)  
ꢄꢃꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Copying the Memory Table Use the following command to change numerals or character-strings to be dis-  
played on the NT600S after copying the contents of a memory table.  
Copy Memory Table  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
/
m
s
s
s
d
d
d
3
1
1
2
3
1
2
2F  
m : Type of memory table  
1
0 (30 ): Character-string memory table  
H
1 (31 ): Numeral memory table  
H
s s s : Copy source memory table address (see table below)  
1 2 3  
d d d : Copy destination memory table address (see table below)  
1
2
3
Character-string  
Numeral memory table address  
memory table address  
000 to 255 (3-digit BCD)  
000 to 511 (3-digit BCD)  
Description  
Copies the contents of the copy source memory table to the copy destination  
memory table. The memory table contents are copied to a memory table of the  
same type: character-string memory table to character-string memory table or nu-  
meral table to numeral memory table.  
Operation 1. Register the memory table - which contains the numerals or character-string  
to be displayed - for the screen when creating the screen data using the sup-  
port tool.  
In the case of a character-string, use the “character-string display” mode of the  
support tool to specify the character-string memory table.  
In the case of a numeral, use the “numeral display” mode of the support tool to  
specify the numeral memory table.  
2. When creating the screen data using the support tool, set the copy sourcedata  
in the memory table.  
Use the “table edit” mode.  
Reference  
This method can be conveniently used to switch the numeral or character-string  
display according to the operating status. If several sets of copy source data are  
prepared in advance, it is possible to display the data that matches the operating  
status.  
ꢄꢃꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
7-2-3  
Lamps and Touch Switches  
The procedure for changing/checking the display status of lamps and touch  
switches, and that for disabling input from the touch switches using commands  
from the Host are described below.  
For the functions of lamps and touch switches, refer to 5-6 Lamps (page 135) and  
5-7 Touch Switches (page 138), respectively.  
Changing the Display Status It is possible to turn lamps and touch switches on or cause them to flash using  
commands from the Host.  
Two methods can be used to turn specified lamps and touch switches ON/OFF  
using the Host: bit specification and number specification. (page 205).  
The commands are described below.  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display (Bit Specification)  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
K
m0  
m0  
m1  
m1  
m2  
m2  
m3  
m3  
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
4B  
m4  
m4  
...  
m13  
m13  
2
[CR]  
0D  
1
2
1
m0,m13: Specification of lamps and touch switches (2-digit hexadecimal)  
The relationship between the lamp and touch switch number and an  
expression of m0 to m13 in bits is given in the following table.  
mx  
mx  
2
Bit  
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Parameter  
m0  
07  
06  
05  
04  
03  
02  
01  
00  
m1  
m2  
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
71  
79  
87  
95  
103  
111  
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
70  
78  
86  
94  
102  
110  
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
69  
77  
85  
93  
101  
109  
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
68  
76  
84  
92  
100  
108  
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
67  
75  
83  
91  
99  
107  
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
66  
74  
82  
90  
98  
106  
09  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
65  
73  
81  
89  
97  
105  
08  
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
64  
72  
80  
88  
96  
104  
m3  
m4  
m5  
m6  
m7  
m8  
m9  
m10  
m11  
m12  
m13  
mx1: Higher 4 bits of mx (x: 0 to 13)  
mx2: Lower 4 bits of mx  
ꢄꢃꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Bit ON: The lamp or touch switch is turned on (or caused to flash).  
Bit OFF: The lamp or touch switch is turned off.  
Example  
To turn on lamps and touch switches with the numbers 1, 5, 6, 7, and 26  
m0 m0 m1 m1 m2 m2 m3 m3 m13 m13 =  
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
E200000400000000000000000000  
Description  
Changes the display status of the lamps or touch switches.  
Whether the lamp or touch switch which corresponds to the specified bit is  
turned on or flashes is determined by the setting made using the support tool.  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display (Number Specification)  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
Q
m
n
n
n
3
1
1
2
51  
m : Display status  
1
m
Display Status  
1
0 (30 )  
Not lit (normal display)  
Lit  
H
1 (31 )  
H
2 (32 )  
Flashing inverse  
All not lit  
H
3 (33 )  
H
n n n : Lamp or touch switch address (3-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
000 to 0FF (0 to 255)  
H
Description  
Changes the lamp or touch switch lighting status.  
Specify the display status as 3 (all not lit) to turn off all the lamps and touch  
switches. In this case, specify the lamp or touch switch number to any number in  
the permitted range.  
Reference  
The display attributes set with the Support Tool determine if lamps #0 to #111 light  
continuously or flash. The display status set with this command is ignored.  
Enquiry of the Display Status Use the following command to enquire whether a lamp or touch switch is displayed  
continuously lit or flashing by specifying its number.  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Enquiry  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
R
n
n
n
3
1
2
52  
n n n : Lamp or touch switch address (3-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
000 to 0FF (0 to 255)  
H
ꢄꢃꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Description  
Enquires the status of a lamp or touch switch specified by its address.  
The NT600S returns the Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Response Com-  
mand (refer to 7-3 Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Response) to report the  
display status.  
Disabling/Enabling the Touch Switch Input  
It is possible to enable or disable input from the touch switches on the displayed  
screen.  
The following commands are used for this control.  
Touch Switch Disable  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
U
m
1
55  
m : Switch whose input is to be disabled.  
1
0 (30 ): Touch switches  
H
2 (32 ): Touch switches  
H
Description  
Reference  
Disables touch switch and function key input and notification to the Host.  
Use the Touch Switch Enable Command (refer to 7-2-3 Touch Switch Enable) to  
use a disabled touch switch again. Disabled touch switches are also enabled  
when the NT600S power is turned off.  
Touch Switch Enable  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
V
m
1
56  
m : Switch whose input is to be enabled.  
1
0 (30 ): Touch switches  
H
2 (32 ): Touch switches  
H
Description  
Reference  
Enables input and notification to the Host of a disabled touch switch or function  
key.  
Disabled touch switches are also enabled when the NT600S power is turned off.  
ꢄꢃꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
7-2-4  
Controlling the NT600S Status  
The NT600S status can be controlled by the Host.  
Turning OFF the Backlight / Preventing Afterimage  
By turning off the backlight or the screen using the following command, the back-  
light service life can be maximized when using the LCD model NT600S and the  
generation of afterimages can be prevented when using the EL model NT600S.  
Screen Display Control  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
P
m
1
50  
m : Display on or off  
1
0 (30 ): on  
H
1 (31 ): off  
H
Description  
Reference  
Turns off the backlighting of LCD model PTs; turns off the entire display of EL  
model PTs.  
The display is switched back on when any point on the NT600S’s screen is  
pressed.  
The specified screen is displayed when the Display Specified Screen Command  
(refer to 7-2-1 Display Specified Screen) is transferred.  
Turning the Buzzer ON/OFF By using the following command, it is possible to control the ON/OFF status of the  
buzzer built into the NT600S from the Host.  
Two buzzer modes are provided; continuous beep and short intermittent beep.  
Buzzer Control  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
T
m
1
54  
m : Buzzer status  
1
0 (30 ): Buzzer off  
H
1 (31 ): Continuous buzzer  
H
2 (32 ): Short intermittent buzzer  
H
3 (33 ): Long intermittent buzzer  
H
Description  
Controls the NT600S buzzer.  
Reference  
The buzzer turned on with this command can be stopped with a stop command, by  
displaying a screen with no buzzer attributes.  
It is also possible to stop the buzzer using the “buzzer stop key (230)”, which is one  
of the system keys.  
ꢄꢃꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Displaying the System Menu By using the following command, it is possible to enable or disable display of the  
NT600S system menu.  
System Menu Display Permission  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
W
m
1
57  
m : System menu display permission/inhibition  
1
0 (30 ): Display permitted  
H
1 (31 ): Display inhibited  
H
Description  
System menu is displayed when “display permitted” is set, and from the system  
menu, selection of transmit mode or maintenance mode is possible. If “display in-  
hibited” is set, the system menu is not displayed.  
Enquiry of the Battery Voltage Status  
To check the voltage status of the built-in NT600S battery, use the following com-  
mand.  
Reference  
The battery is optional.  
PT Status Enquiry  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
Z
5A  
Description  
Determines if the built-in PT battery voltage is low.  
The PT returns the PT Battery Status Response Command (see 7-3 PT Battery  
Status Response) to report the battery status.  
Whether or not report is made is determined by the ON/OFF setting of DIW  
SW2-8.  
Initializing the Display History Data Memory  
The display history record stored in the NT600S can be cleared (initialized) by giv-  
ing the following command from the Host.  
For details of the display history function, refer to Display History (page 110).  
Initialize Display History  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
]
5D  
Description  
Deletes the entire contents of the display history.  
ꢄꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-2  
Controlling the LCD Screen When the LCD screen is used, the normal or inverse display mode can be selected  
by using the following command.  
Display Mode Control  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
_
m
1
5F  
m : Specifies the display mode:  
1
0(30 ): Normal display (white background)  
H
1(31 ): Inverse display (black background)  
H
Description  
Controls the display mode of the LCD (liquid crystal display) screen.  
Reference  
This command is only valid for the following PTs:  
NT600S-ST121-V  
NT600S-ST121B-V  
ꢄꢃꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-3  
7-3  
Commands Sent by the NT600S  
The operating commands sent by the NT600S to the Host are described below.  
7-3-1  
Screen Display  
Notifying the Display Screen The screen number of the screen currently displayed on the NT600S is sent to the  
Host on execution of the following command.  
Screen Number Response  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
Y
[CR]  
0D  
m
m
m
m
4
1
2
3
59  
m m m m : Number of displayed screen (4-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
4
0000 to 03E8 (0 to 1,000)  
H
Description  
The NT600S returns this command to report the currently displayed screen  
number to the Host in response to the Request Screen Number Command (refer  
to 7-2-1 Request Screen Number) sent from the Host.  
The new screen number is report to the Host with this command after the dis-  
played screen is switch with the Stand-alone functions (screen switch function).  
If the screen is switched by pressing a touch switch, the screen number of the  
newly displayed screen is sent to the Host by executing this command.  
7-3-2  
Memory Table  
Notifying Input to the Numeral Memory Table  
The 4-digit or 8-digit number data input to the numeral memory table of the  
NT600S is sent to the Host by executing the following commands.  
4-digit Number Input Notify  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
E
[CR]  
0D  
d
d
n
n
n
n
4
d
1
2
1
2
3
3
45  
d d d : Numeral memory table address to which number was input (3-digit hex-  
1
2
3
adecimal)  
000 to 1FF (0 to 511)  
H
n n n n : Input number data (4-digit BCD)  
1
2
3
4
ꢄꢃꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-3  
Description  
A number with 4 transferred digits set with the NT600S number setting function is  
reported to the Host with this command.  
8-digit Number Input Notify  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
F
d
d
d
n
n
n
n
n
5
1
2
3
1
2
3
4
46  
[CR]  
0D  
n
n
n
8
6
7
d d d : Numeral memory table address to which number was input (3-digit hex-  
1
2
3
adecimal)  
000 to 1FF  
H
n n n n n n n n : Input number data (8-digit BCD)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Description  
A number with 8 transferred digits set with the PT number setting function is re-  
ported to the Host with this command.  
7-3-3  
Lamps and Touch Switches  
Notifying the Display Status The lit/flashing status of the lamps and touch switches which are set on the screen  
currently displayed on the NT600S is sent to the Host by executing the following  
command.  
Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status Response  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
S
m
n
n
n
3
1
1
2
53  
m : Display status  
1
m
Display status  
1
0 (30 )  
Not lit (normal display)  
Lit  
H
1 (31 )  
H
2 (32 )  
Flashing inverse  
H
n n n : Lamp or touch switch address (3-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
000 to 0FF (0 to 255)  
H
Description  
The NT600S returns this command to report the lamp or touch switch number dis-  
play status to the Host in response to the Lamp and Touch Switch Display Status  
Enquiry Command (see 7-2-3) sent from the Host.  
Reference  
Lamps 0 to 111 are reported as being lit when in the “flashing inverse” status.  
ꢄꢃꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-3  
Notifying that a Touch Switch Has Been Pressed  
When “On” is set for “Bit In” when setting the screen attribute with the support tool,  
the “touch switch pressed” status is sent to the Host in the bit information.  
If “Off” is set for “Bit In”, the address corresponding to the touch switch is sent to the  
Host in a 3-digit hexadecimal value when the touch switch is pressed.  
The commands used for this report are described below.  
Touch Switch Bit Output (from NT600S to Host)  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
J
s0  
s0  
s1  
1
s1  
s2  
s2  
s3  
s3  
2
1
2
2
1
2
1
4A  
[CR]  
0D  
s4  
s4  
s5  
s5  
s6  
s6  
s7  
s7  
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
s0,s7: Status of the touch switch (2-digit hexadecimal value for each switch)  
The relationship between the touch switch number and an expression of  
s0 to s7 in bits is given in the following table.  
sx  
sx  
2
Bit  
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Parameter  
s0  
s1  
s2  
s3  
s4  
s5  
s6  
s7  
07  
15  
23  
31  
39  
47  
55  
63  
06  
14  
22  
30  
38  
46  
54  
62  
05  
13  
21  
29  
37  
45  
53  
61  
04  
12  
20  
28  
36  
44  
52  
60  
03  
11  
19  
27  
35  
43  
51  
59  
02  
10  
18  
26  
34  
42  
50  
58  
01  
09  
17  
25  
33  
41  
49  
57  
00  
08  
16  
24  
32  
40  
48  
56  
sx1: Higher 4 bits of sx (x: 0 to 7)  
sx2: Lower 4 bits of sx  
Bit ON: The touch switch is on.  
Bit OFF: The touch switch is off.  
Example  
Touch switches at addresses 0, 3, 21, and 27 are ON  
s0 s0 s1 s1 s2 s2 s3 s3 s7 s7 =0900200800000000  
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
1
2
Description  
If the touch switch status is changed while the screen for which the “Bit Input,  
Touch Switch” attribute is set is displayed, the status of the corresponding bit is  
reported to the Host.  
This report is made each time a touch switch is turned ON or OFF.  
ꢄꢄꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-3  
Touch Switch Number Output (from NT600S to Host)  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
H
[CR]  
0D  
m
m
m
3
1
2
48  
m m m : Address of the pressed touch switch (3-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
3
000 to 0E2 , 0E7 to 0FE (0 to 226, 231 to 254)  
H
H
Description  
If a touch switch is pressed while the screen for which the “Bit In = Off” attribute is  
set is displayed, the address of the pressed touch switch is reported to the Host.  
Reference  
If more than one touch switch is pressed at the same time, only the address of  
the touch switch which was pressed first is reported to the Host.  
When a touch switch which is set as a ten key switch (231 to 254) is pressed, it is  
not reported to the Host.  
When a touch switch which is set as a system key (227 to 230, 255) is pressed, it  
is not reported to the Host.  
Notifying Low Battery Voltage  
The status of the battery in the NT600S is sent to the Host by executing the follow-  
ing command.  
PT Battery Status Response  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
[
[CR]  
0D  
m
m
2
1
5B  
m m : Battery voltage status (2-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
00 (30 30 ): Normal voltage  
H
H
01 (30 31 ): Low voltage  
H
H
Description  
The NT600S returns this command to report the battery voltage status to the Host  
in response to the PT Battery Status Enquiry Command (refer 7-2-4 PT Battery  
Status Enquiry) sent from the Host.  
Whether or not report is made is determined by the ON/OFF setting of DIW  
SW2-8.  
ꢄꢄꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-4  
7-4  
Terminal Commands  
Terminal commands allow the display of information from the Host as text and  
graphics, independently of the screen stored in the NT600S.  
Reference  
All data values must be sent in ASCII code.  
Example:  
m
m
2
1
35  
41  
2-bit hexadecimal 5AH  
d
d
d
1
1
2
31  
32  
33  
3-bit BCD  
123  
7-4-1  
Clearing the Screen  
The screen displayed on the NT600S can be cleared by the following command.  
Clear Screen  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
&
26  
Description  
Clears all text and graphics on the NT600S screen.  
Reference  
After the display of number, text, lamps or touch switches is upgraded, only the  
upgraded parts are re-displayed.  
7-4-2  
Displaying a Character-String  
Specifying the Character Size  
The size (normal or 1/2 size) of characters to be displayed can be specified by the  
following command.  
Character Specify Size  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
)
m
1
29  
m : Character size  
1
0 (30 ): Normal size, 16 x 8 dots (H x W)  
H
1 (31 ): 1/2 size, 8 x 8 dots (H x W)  
H
Description  
Specifies if 1-byte alphanumeric characters sent subsequently are displayed as  
normal characters or 1/2-size characters.  
ꢄꢄꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-4  
Reference  
The character string is specified with the Specify Displayed Characters Com-  
mand (refer to 7-4-2 Specify Displayed Characters).  
Both normal characters and 1/2-size characters are enlarged as specified by  
the Specify Character Enlargement Command (refer to 7-4-2 Specify Character  
Enlargement below).  
The character size specified with this command remains valid until the screen  
display is switched or another character size is specified with the command.  
The default character size is normal characters.  
Specifying the Character Scale  
The enlargement scale for displaying the characters or marks on the screen can  
be specified by the following command.  
Specify Character Enlargement  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
m
1
2A  
m : Character enlargement  
1
0 (30 ): No enlargement  
H
1 (31 ): Enlarge height x 2  
H
2 (32 ): Enlarge width x 2  
H
3 (33 ): 2 x 2 enlargement  
H
4 (34 ): 3 x 3 times enlargement  
H
5 (35 ): 4 x 4 times enlargement  
H
6 (36 ): 8 x 8 times enlargement  
H
9 (39 ): 8 x 8 times enlargement  
H
Description  
All text and marks sent after this command are displayed in the specified size.  
Reference  
The character string is specified with the Specify Displayed Characters Com-  
mand(refer to 7-4-2 Specify Displayed Characters).  
The enlargement specified with this command remains valid until the screen  
display is switched or another enlargement is specified with the command. The  
default enlargement is no enlargement.  
Canceling the Inverse/Flashing Display  
The set display mode (inverse, flashing, flashing inverse) is canceled by the fol-  
lowing command, returning the screen to the normal display.  
Normal Display  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
!
21  
Description  
Cancels all display attribute settings(inverse, flashing, flashing inverse) for char-  
acters and marks so that all characters are displayed as “normal” characters (not  
inverse or flashing).  
ꢄꢄꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-4  
Specifying the Inverse Display  
Use the following command to set the inverse display mode.  
Set Inverse Display  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
22  
Description  
Reference  
Sets the display attribute to inverse so that all characters and marks sent subse-  
quently are highlighted. Other attributes remain unchanged.  
The Set Inverse Display Command is cancelled by the End Inverse Display  
Command or the Normal Display Command.  
The setting with this command remains valid until the screen display is switched  
or another display attribute setting is made. The default display attributes are  
set to a normal display when a screen is initially displayed.  
Use this command with the Set Flashing Display Command (refer 7-4-2 Set  
Flashing Display) to produce a flashing inverse display.  
Canceling the Inverse Display  
Use the following command to cancel the inverse display mode.  
End Inverse Display  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
#
23  
Description  
Reference  
Clears the inverse display attribute so that all characters and marks sent subse-  
quently are not highlighted. Other attributes remain unchanged.  
The inverse display attribute is set with the Set Inverse Display Command.  
The setting with this command remains valid until the screen display is switched  
or another display attribute setting is made. The default display attributes are  
set to a normal display when a screen is initially displayed.  
Specifying the Flash Display  
Use the following command to set the flash display mode.  
Set Flashing Display  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
$
24  
Description  
Sets the display attribute to flashing so that all characters and marks sent subse-  
quently are displayed flashing. Other attributes remain unchanged.  
ꢄꢄꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-4  
Reference  
The Set Flashing Display Command is cancelled by the End Flashing Display  
Command or the Normal Display Command (refer to 7-4-2 Normal Display and  
7-4-2 End Flashing Display).  
The setting with this command remains valid until the screen display is switched  
or another display attribute setting is made. The default display attributes are  
set to a normal display when a screen is initially displayed.  
Use this command with the Set Inverse Display Command (refer to 7-4-2 Set  
Inverse Display) to produce a flashing inverse display.  
Canceling the Flash Display  
Use the following command to cancel the flash display mode.  
End Flashing Display  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
%
25  
Description  
Reference  
Clears the flashing display attribute so that all characters and marks sent subse-  
quently are not flashing. Other attributes remain unchanged.  
The flashing display attribute is set with the Set Flashing Display Command.  
The setting with this command remains valid until the screen display is switched  
or another display attribute setting is made. The default display attributes are  
set to a normal display when a screen is initially displayed.  
Specifying the Display Position  
The display position of a character-string can be specified by the following com-  
mand.  
Set Cursor Position  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
+
x
x
x
y
y
y
3
1
2
3
1
2
2B  
x x x : X coordinate (3-digit BCD)  
1 2 3  
y y y : Y coordinate (3-digit BCD)  
1 2 3  
Description  
X coordinate  
Y coordinate  
000 to 639  
000 to 399  
Before displaying a character string with the Terminal commands, use this com-  
mand to set the bottom-left point of the first character to be displayed.  
Reference  
The cursor position set with this command is also the bottom-left point of the first  
character displayed if the displayed characters are enlarged.  
ꢄꢄꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-4  
Specifying the Character-string  
The character-string to be displayed can be specified by the following command.  
Specify Displayed Characters  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
4
n
n
c
c
c
c
n
1
2
1
2
3
34  
n n : Character string length as a number of normal characters (2-digit hexadeci-  
1
2
mal)  
01 to 50H (1 to 80)  
c c c to c : Character-string to display  
1 2 3  
n
Description  
The character string is displayed from the cursor position.  
The character-string data can contain a mixture of normal (alphanumeric) char-  
acters and marks. Refer to Appendix M Special Characters for details.  
The character string is displayed according to the enlargement and display at-  
tributes set with commands.  
Reference  
The character string continues on the next line if it cannot fit into a single line.  
Set the position where the character string is displayed with the Set Cursor Posi-  
tion Command (refer to 7-4-2 Set Cursor Position).  
7-4-3  
Displaying Figures  
Displaying the Line  
Use the following command to display a polyline.  
Draw Polyline  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
7
m
m
x0  
yn  
x0  
yn  
x0  
yn  
y0  
y0  
y0  
3
1
2
1
1
2
2
3
3
1
2
37  
xn  
xn  
xn  
3
1
2
m , m : Number of lines to draw (2-digit hexadecimal)  
1
2
01 to 28 (1 to 40)  
H
x0 x0 x0 to xn xn xn :X coordinates of line end points (3-digit BCD)  
1
2
3
1
2
3
y0 y0 y0 to yn yn yn :Y coordinates of line end points (3-digit BCD)  
1
2
3
1
2
3
X coordinate  
Y coordinate  
000 to 639  
000 to 399  
Description  
Draws the specified number of lines between the specified points.  
ꢄꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-4  
Displaying the Circle  
Use the following command to display a circle.  
Draw Circle  
Format  
[ESC]  
1B  
8
x
x
x
y
y
y
r
1
r
2
r
3
1
2
3
1
2
3
38  
x x x : X coordinate of circle center (3-digit BCD)  
1 2 3  
y y y : Y coordinate of circle center (3-digit BCD)  
1 2 3  
X coordinate  
Y coordinate  
000 to 639  
000 to 399  
r r r : circle radius in dots (3-digit BCD)  
1 2 3  
000 to 199  
Description  
Draws a circle of the specified radius around the circle center point.  
ꢄꢄꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-5  
7-5  
Key to Programs  
The following programs include all the commands that can be used with the  
NT600S.  
7-5-1  
Use of Programs  
The sample program appears as follows on the screen.  
Menu bar Sub-menu  
Parameter input column  
Send command column  
Run confirm column  
Receive command  
display column  
Use the program as shown below.  
Execute program  
[ESC]  
[ESC]  
Interrupt display when  
command received  
Select type of send  
command  
Main Menu  
[ESC]  
Select send command  
Input parameter  
Sub-menu  
Input parameter column  
Send command column,  
confirm execution  
Confirm send command  
Execute transfer  
command  
Up, Down, Left, Right keys: select item  
Enter key: confirm  
[Esc]: stop  
End program  
Note  
1. This sample program is written in N88BASIC (86) (NEC) for a PC-9801 com-  
puter. Modify this program for use with any other computer language or com-  
puter such as an IBM PC/AT or compatible.  
2. The interval between parameter input and command transmission is a hold  
interval for interrupt processing of the received command. If an interrupt is  
permitted between the interval of parameter input and a command is re-  
ceived, all subsequent receive interrupts are displaced. If this occurs, send an  
enquiry command to read all the accumulated receive data.  
3. When a parameter is input, no check is made that the parameter is in the per-  
mitted range. Make sure that parameters are input within the permitted range.  
ꢄꢄꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
7-6  
EXAMPLE PROGRAM  
ꢄꢄꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6-6  
ꢄꢅꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢌꢍꢎꢏꢐꢑꢒ   
ꢏꢓꢔꢕꢖꢗꢘꢙꢚꢔꢔꢛꢀꢜꢝ  ꢜ! " ꢀꢜꢛꢘꢜ ꢜ#ꢘ  
ꢄꢆꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-1  
8-1  
Hardware Faults  
When a fault relating to the operation of the NT600S occurs, find the symptoms in  
the table below and respond by following the corresponding “Remedy” indicated in  
the table.  
Caution  
Confirm system safety before turning the power ON/OFF or resetting.  
Otherwise the system may operate unpredictably.  
Do not disassemble for repairs or modification.  
Otherwise the product may malfunction.  
NT600S Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
POWER LED fails to  
come ON  
Power is not being supplied.  
Check the connections and make sure that power is  
supplied correctly.  
(Refer to “2-2-2 Power Supply Connection”, page 28.)  
Contact your OMRON service center.  
Power supply fuse has blown  
Nothing is displayed on  
the screen (it is  
completely white/LCD or  
black/EL).  
Screen #0 has been read at the host This is not an error. Change the screen number.  
side.  
(Refer to “4-3 Screen Display”, page 124.)  
In communication with the Host,  
Transfer the screen data to the PT using the support  
screen data is not transferred to the tool.  
NT600S through RS-232C.  
Meaningless characters  
are displayed.  
The DIP switches at the rear of the  
terminal have been left at their  
factory setting (SW2-2 is OFF).  
Set DIP switch SW2-2 on the rear of the PT to ON and  
switch the power back on.  
Communication with the  
support tool not possible. established.  
The Transmit Mode has not been  
Display the system menu and select the Transmit  
Mode.  
(Refer to “4-5 Registering the Screen Data”, page 79.)  
Check the installation of the connector cable.  
Not connected to the support tool.  
(Refer to “2-3 Connecting to the Support Tool”, page  
30.)  
PT type setting and direct connection Using the ”Tool Settings” of the support tool, set the  
setting at the support tool do not  
match the NT600S.  
PT type and direct connection settings that match the  
NT600S.  
The NT600S Support Tool Mode  
setting does not match the support  
tool used.  
Match the setting for the “Support Tool Mode” option in  
the memory switch menu of the Maintenance mode  
with the support tool being used.  
Cannot communicate with Memory switch settings do not  
Check the communication setting in the “Memory  
Switch” menu of the Maintenance Mode, and match  
the PC and NT600S settings.  
the PC /Host.  
match.  
(Refer to “4-6 Setting the Conditions of  
Communications with the PC/Host by Using the  
Memory Switches”, page 83.)  
NT600S and PC/HOST are not  
correctly connected.  
Check that the type, length and installation of the  
connector cable match the specifications.  
(Refer to “2-4 Connection to a PC by the Host Link”,  
page 31, “2-5 Connection to a PC by the NT Link”,  
page 43.“3-7 Connection to a PC by C200H Direct”,  
page 56, “3-8 Host Connection by RS-232”, page 63.)  
When NT link (1:N), there is unit  
number duplication.  
Set again with no duplication.  
In a host link connection, the PC  
termination resistance setting is  
incorrect.  
Set the PC termination resistance correctly.  
(Refer to “2-4 Connection to a PC by the Host Link”,  
page 31.)  
Power not supplied to the NT600S,  
PC, or host  
Check the power supply.  
ꢄꢆꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-1  
NT600S Symptoms  
Cause  
Remedy  
Buzzer sounds, RUN LED Malfunction due to external noise.  
is OFF.  
Distance the communication cable from the source of  
the noise and insert a noise filter in the power supply  
line.  
Touch panel does not  
respond  
Malfunction due to external noise  
Touch panel is broken.  
Distance the communication cable from the source of  
the noise and insert a noise filter in the power supply  
line.  
Check the touch panel by performing the touch panel  
test in the I/O check in the maintenance mode.  
PC mode changes to  
monitor mode.  
The NT600S changes the mode  
during host link communication.  
This is normal with the NT600S specification. When  
using a PC that can also be connected using the NT  
link, connect it with the NT link (the mode is not  
changed when using the NT link).  
ꢄꢆꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-2  
8-2  
Responding to Displayed Error Messages  
When the NT600S displays an error message, find the corresponding symptoms  
in the appropriate table below and respond by following the “Remedy” indicated in  
the table.  
8-2-1  
Errors Occurring when the Power is Turned ON  
The table below shows the errors that can occur when the power supply to the  
NT600S is turned ON, and their remedies.  
Message  
Cause  
Remedy  
The Screen Data  
Corrupted  
There is an error in the registered  
screen data.  
After initializing the screen data memory in the  
Maintenance Mode, transmit the screen data once  
more with the support tool.  
The Mark Data Corrupted There is an error in the registered  
mark data.  
After initializing the screen data memory in the  
Maintenance Mode, transmit the screen data once  
more using the support tool.  
Screen data is not  
registered.  
There is no screen data.  
Transmit screen data from the support tool.  
The counters of memory  
switches were corrupted. switch settings.  
There is an error in the memory  
Press the [Confirm] touch switch. The NT600S  
restores the normal state, with the memory switch  
settings reset to the initial settings.  
An error occurred in the  
unit.  
There is an error at the C200H  
interface unit.  
Contact your OMRON service center.  
8-2-2  
Errors Occurring During Operation  
The table below shows the errors that can occur during operation of the NT600S,  
and their remedies.  
Message  
Cause  
Remedy  
Setting Error  
Bits or words allocated to the PC  
memory cannot be found in the  
screen data.  
Check the memory area in the PC used and correct  
the bit and word allocations in the screen data.  
I/O register command is  
not available or switch  
settings are wrong.  
The PC model is one that does not  
allow connection of the NT600S.  
Check the model of the PC currently used to  
determine whether the NT600S can be connected to it  
or not; select a model to which the NT600S can be  
connected.  
Settings of the Host link unit are  
wrong.  
Check the setting of the switches on the Host link unit.  
8-2-3  
Errors Occurring on Screen Data Initialization and Transfer  
The table below shows the errors that can occur when data is written to the  
NT600S screen data memory, and their remedies.  
Message  
Cause  
Remedy  
Screen Initialization Error Hardware fault or screen data  
memory life reached  
If the same message is displayed even after executing  
screen data memory initialization or screen data  
transmission several times, contact your OMRON  
service center.  
ꢄꢆꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-2  
8-2-4  
Communication Errors  
This section describes the errors relating to communication with the PC that can  
occur during operation, and their remedies.  
Operation when a communication error occurs  
When a communication error occurs, the error message is displayed at the  
NT600S, and the buzzer sounds. Error messages are displayed when the “Auto-  
matic Reset” memory switch is not set (OFF).  
Note  
Some error messages are displayed even if the “Automatic Reset” memory switch  
is set (ON).  
Procedure when a communication error occurs  
When an error message is displayed, press the [confirm] touch switch displayed  
on the screen. The screen display will return to the RUN mode.  
Display of communication errors  
As shown below, communication errors are displayed in the center of the screen,  
together with a classification indicating whether they are receive or send errors.  
[Screen when an error has occurred during reception]  
<Error Description>  
Parity Error  
Overflow Error  
Overrun Error  
RECEIVING ERROR  
Framing Error  
Buffer Overflow  
Time Out  
RESTORE  
NAK Received  
Unit No. Error  
FCS Error  
Sum Error  
End Code Error  
[Screen when an error has occurred during sending]  
SENDING ERROR  
<Error Description>  
Time Out  
RESTORE  
ꢄꢆꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-2  
Message  
Parity Error  
Cause  
Remedy  
Communication parameters set  
incorrectly.  
Check whether the parity bit, data bit length, baud  
rate, stop bit length, and flow control settings of the  
PC/Host match the settings of the NT600S.  
Framing Error  
Overrun Error  
Overflow Error  
Noise caused data corruption during Use a noise-resistant cable if communication occurs  
communication.  
in an environment with high levels of noise.  
The connectors of the connecting  
cable are not connected correctly.  
Reconnect the cable.  
Buffer Overflow  
Time Out  
The NT600S receive buffer is full.  
Lengthen the command transmission intervals. If this  
error occurs frequently, set flow control for  
communications.  
The connectors of the connecting  
cable have become disconnected.  
Reconnect the cable.  
The PC/Host is stopped.  
Make sure the PC/Host is able to communicate with  
the NT600S.  
During transmission of one  
Confirm the proper command length.  
command, a time lapse exceeding 5 Check the cable connection.  
seconds is detected.  
NAK Received  
Noise caused data corruption during Use a noise-resistant cable if communication occurs  
(end code simultaneously communication.  
in an environment with high levels of noise.  
displayed)  
Check the end code by referring to the PC user’s  
manual.  
Unit No. Error  
The unit No. does not match that set Set the PC unit No. to “0”.  
on the PC.  
The PC is transmitting incorrect data. Check PC operation.  
Noise caused data corruption during Use a noise-resistant cable if communication occurs  
communication.  
in an environment with high levels of noise.  
FCS Error  
Sum Error  
The PC is transmitting incorrect data. Check PC operation.  
Noise caused data corruption during Use a noise-resistant cable if communication occurs  
communication.  
in an environment with high levels of noise.  
End Code Error  
There is an error at the NT600S or  
the C200H interface unit.  
Contact your OMRON service center.  
If an error occurs during the execution of a command, that command becomes  
invalid and it is not executed.  
ꢄꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-3  
8-3  
Maintenance of the NT600S  
Carry out maintenance work in order to ensure that the NT600S is always used in  
its optimum condition.  
WARNING  
Do not attempt to take the NT600S apart and do not touch any internal parts while  
the power is being supplied. Doing either of these may result in electrical shock.  
Spare PT  
Backlight  
It is advisable to have a spare NT600S available to minimize system downtime in  
the event of an NT600S failure or if the screen display becomes difficult to readdue  
to deterioration of the display unit.  
When the backlight in the display is getting dim and the screen cannot be read eas-  
ily, replace the backlight. The backlight can be replaced at the rear of the NT600S  
while it is mounted in an operation panel.  
Models that use a backlight  
NT600S-ST121-EV  
NT600S-ST121B-EV  
Replaceable Backlight Model  
NT600S-CFL01  
Guide to Backlight Replacement  
Under normal conditions it can be assumed that the backlight will need to re-  
placed after about 20,000 hours. However, the life of the backlight does vary in  
accordance with the environment in which it is used and it should be replaced  
when it is getting dim and the screen is getting hard to read.  
ꢄꢆꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-3  
Replacing the Backlight  
WARNING  
Switch off the power before replacing the backlight. Otherwise you could sustain  
an electric shock.  
Operation 1. Turn off the power to the NT600S and remove the lid of the CFL case, located  
at the upper right part of the rear of the NT600S: remove the screw with a Phil-  
ips head screwdriver, then open the CFL case lid.  
Screw securing CFL case lid  
CFL case lid  
2. Disconnect the backlight connector from the NT600S.  
ꢄꢆꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-3  
3. Remove the backlight (  
-shaped).  
Remove the backlight, lifting it upward, by pulling the left handle after pushing  
the right handle to the right.  
4. Fit a new backlight.  
Hold the handle and insert the projection at the right side face of the unit into  
the hole in the NT600S. Then, push the right handle until it clicks. After con-  
firming the click, check the whether the backlight has been set correctly or not  
by viewing the NT600S from the top.  
- The backlight is fitted in the correct position if the handle is upright.  
- If the handle is tilted, it indicates that the backlight is not fitted correctly. Repeat  
the step above until the backlight is fitted correctly.  
5. Connect the backlight connector to the NT600S.  
Plug in the connector after making sure the polarity is correct. Take care to en-  
sure that the connector cord will not be damaged while the connector is in-  
serted. After connecting the connector, store the cord inside the NT600S prop-  
erly.  
6. Close the CFL case lid and secure it with the screw.  
Tighten the screw securely after making sure that the connector cord is not  
caught by the lid.  
ꢄꢆꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-3  
Replacing the Battery  
The NT600S uses a lithium battery to back up the memory contents.  
The battery life is 5 years if the NT600S is used in a location where the ambient  
temperature is 25 C. If the temperature at the location of use is higher than this,  
the battery life will be shorter. Change the battery at suitable intervals in accor-  
dance with the operating environment of the NT600S.  
It is advisable to keep a spare battery so that the battery can be replaced immedi-  
ately if replacement becomes necessary.  
Battery Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C500-BAT08  
Battery Replacement Clues Replace the battery in the following cases. The battery must be replaced within 5  
days.  
- When 5 years have passed since the installation of a new battery.  
- When the RUN LED is lit.  
Battery replacing method  
Replace the battery by following the procedure given below.  
To protect the contents of the memory, the battery must be replaced in less than  
5 minutes.  
Operation 1. Keep the power ON for at least 1 minute and then turn it OFF.  
Note  
Unless the power is kept ON for at least 1 minute, the memory contents cannot be  
retained for more than 5 minutes without a battery.  
2. Turn off the power to the NT600S and remove the lid of the CFL case, located  
at the upper right part of the rear of the NT600S: remove the screw with a Phil-  
ips head screwdriver, then open the CFL case lid.  
Screw securing CFL case lid  
CFL case lid  
ꢄꢇꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-3  
3. Pull out the battery together with the connector.  
4. Install a new battery.  
Insert the battery connector, keeping it straight.  
5. Close the CFL case lid and secure it with the screw.  
Reference  
Caution  
The battery may be replaced while the power is ON. In this case, there are no re-  
strictions on battery replacement time.  
Never short the + and -- terminals of the battery. Do not recharge, take apart, de-  
form, or discharge it into open flame.  
Attempting any of these will lead to hazards such as fire, leakage of electrolyte,  
rupture, etc.  
Note  
When replacing a battery, ensure that the battery terminal does not touch the  
board in the NT600S.  
ꢄꢇꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-4  
8-4  
Inspection and Cleaning  
Clean and inspect the NT600S regularly to ensure that it is always used in its opti-  
mum condition.  
Cleaning Method  
If the display is dirty the screen is difficult to see. Clean the screen from time to time  
as follows.  
In daily cleaning, wipe the display with a soft dry cloth.  
If the soiling cannot be removed with a dry cloth, wet the cloth with diluted neutral  
detergent (2%), wring it out well and wipe the display with it.  
If rubber or vinyl products, tape, etc. are left stuck to the display for long periods  
they will cause staining. If such items are stuck to the display, remove them dur-  
ing cleaning.  
Note  
Never use volatile solvents such as benzene or thinners, or chemical dusters.  
These could cause degeneration of the coatings of the NT600S display and body.  
Inspection Method  
In normal environments, inspect the NT600S at intervals of between 6 months and  
a year. In environments that are extremely hot and humid, or very dusty environ-  
ments, shorten the inspection interval.  
Items required for the inspection  
Prepare the following items before starting the inspection.  
- The tools supplied with the NT600S  
- Screwdrivers (Philips, flat-head)  
- Tester (or digital voltmeter)  
- Industrial alcohol  
- 100% cotton cloth  
- Hygrometer (required in some cases)  
- Thermometer (required in some cases)  
- Synchroscope (required in some cases)  
- Pen-writing oscilloscope (required in some cases)  
ꢄꢇꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7-4  
Points inspected  
Inspect the following points to determine if there is any divergence from the  
stated criteria. If there is, either improve the surrounding environment so that the  
values fall within the stated range, or adjust the NT600S.  
Point Inspected  
Inspection Details  
Criterion  
Inspection Instrument  
Power supply voltage  
Fluctuation in power supply  
terminal voltage  
Permissible voltage fluctuation Tester  
range  
(24 VDC --15% +10%)  
Ambient environmental  
conditions  
Ambient temperature  
(temperature in the operation  
panel)  
0 to 50 C  
Thermometer  
Ambient humidity  
(humidity in the operation  
panel)  
35% to 85%RH  
Hygrometer  
Presence/absence of dust  
Dust must not be settled  
To be no looseness  
Visual inspection  
Accessory tools  
Mounting conditions  
Looseness of mounting  
brackets etc.  
Connector connections of  
connecting cable  
To be fully inserted and locked,  
with no looseness  
Looseness of screws in  
external wiring  
To be no looseness  
Philips screwdriver  
Visual inspection  
Visual inspection  
Conditions of external  
connecting cables  
Faults such as incipient  
disconnections.  
Components with limited  
lives  
Brightness of the backlight  
Must be sufficiently bright.  
Backlight life:  
Brightness is halved after  
about 20,000 hours in use.  
Brightness of EL display unit  
Must be sufficiently bright.  
EL display unit life:  
Visual inspection  
Brightness is reduced by 30%  
after about 30,000 hours in  
use.  
Caution  
Do not disassemble for repairs or modification. Otherwise, the product may  
malfunction.  
The disposal of the NT600S (and used backlights) may be regulated by national  
or local authorities. Dispose of them in accordance with the laws and regula-  
tions of the relevant country and local authority.  
Cautions on replacing the NT600S  
When replacing the NT600S after discovering a fault during inspections, note the  
following points:  
Be sure to switch the power OFF before replacement.  
After replacement, check that the new NT600S is not subject to the same error.  
If a faulty unit is returned for repairs, write as detailed a description of the fault as  
possible and send this description together with the unit to the OMRON address  
indicated on the back cover of this book.  
ꢄꢇꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢄꢇꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
APPENDIX A  
Specifications  
General Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
Power supply voltage  
24 VDC  
20.4 VDC to 26.4 VDC (24 VDC --15% +10%)  
Allowable power supply voltage range  
Power consumption  
24V, less than 15W (ST121 (B)-EV  
24V, less than 25W (ST211 (B)-EV  
)
)
Inrush current  
3 A max.  
Ambient operating temperature  
Storage temperature  
0 to +50 C (with no freezing)  
--20 to +70 C (with no freezing)  
Ambient operating humidity  
Operating environment  
35 to 85% RH (with no condensation)  
No corrosive gases.  
Resistance to electrostatic discharge  
Level 3 (IEC801-2)  
In air 8 kV, contact 6 kV, indirect 7 kV  
Electromagnetic field strength  
Fast transient/burst noise  
10 V/m (IEC801-3)  
Power supply line: 2 kV (IEC801-4)  
I/O line: 0.25 kV  
Damped oscillatory wave  
Vibration resistance  
Power supply line: 1 kV (IEC255-4)  
10 to 22 Hz with 1.5 mm double amplitude for a total of 30 min. in X, Y, and Z  
directions.  
2
22 to 500 Hz with 1.5 G {14.7 m/s } acceleration in X, Y, and Z directions.  
Shock resistance  
Durability: 30 G, 3 times each in X, Y, and Z directions.  
Malfunction: 20 G, 3 times each in X, Y, and Z directions.  
275 (W) x 192 (H) x 71 (D) mm  
Dimensions (mm)  
Weight  
1.8 kg max.  
Enclosure ratings  
Front panel:  
Equivalent to IP65 (front face waterproof construction).  
Rear case:  
Terminals:  
IP20  
IP00  
Applicable standards  
EN61131-2 (1994)  
EN50081-2 (1992)  
ꢄꢇꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
Performance Specifications  
Display Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
640 dots (vertically) x 400 dots (horizontally) (dot size: 0.30 mm)  
Dot matrix of STN  
liquid crystal display  
panel  
Number of dots  
(resolution)  
Effective display area 192 mm (vertically) x 120 mm (horizontally)  
View angle  
Left direction: 50  
Right direction: 40  
Life expectancy  
Number of dots  
50,000 hours minimum  
EL  
640 dots (vertically) x 400 dots (horizontally) (dot size: 0.30 mm)  
(electro luminescence) (resolution)  
display panel  
Effective display area 192 mm (vertically) x 120 mm (horizontally)  
View angle  
Left direction: 80  
Right direction: 80  
Life expectancy  
30,000 hours minimum  
(till brightness becomes 30% weaker)  
Backlight  
Life expectancy  
Average: 20,000 hours  
(white cold cathode  
tube)  
(the time taken for the brightness to decline to half its original value at  
normal temperature and humidity)  
Automatic turn-off  
Can be set to turn off in 10 minutes or 1 hour, or to remain on.  
Lit while power is being supplied.  
Indicators  
POWER indicator  
(Green LED)  
RUN indicator  
(Green, Orange, Red  
LED)  
Lit during operation  
Lit in orange or red if the battery voltage becomes low.  
Panel Specifications  
Item  
Specification  
Touch panel  
Number of switches: Max. 128 registrable per screen (8 vertically x 16  
horizontally)  
Input:  
Pressure-sensitive type  
Operating force: 100 gf min.  
Life expectancy: 1 million operations minimum  
ꢄꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
Display Capacity  
Item  
Specification  
Display  
Character displays  
Fixed character data (character strings registered for each screen)  
elements  
Character string  
displays  
256 strings per file (40 bytes (40 normal characters) per string), 50 positions  
per screen  
Numeral displays *  
Graph displays *  
Graphic displays  
Lamps  
50 positions per screen, 8-digit display  
50 per screen  
Can be displayed wherever required  
No restriction on total number, 255 per screen  
No restriction on total number, 128 per screen  
Display of set numerical values 50 per screen  
Displays screens registered as normal.  
Touch switches  
Numeral settings *  
Normal screen  
Overlapping screens  
Screen types  
A maximum of 8 registered screens can be displayed overlapped with each  
other.  
Continuous screens  
A maximum of 8 screens can be displayed sequentially by scrolling.  
(The screen can be changed by pressing the and touch switches)  
Screen attributes  
Buzzer, numeral setting, bit input of lamps and touch switches, display history  
recording, backlight  
Number of registered screens  
Screen registration method  
1000 max.  
Transfer screen data created using the support tool to the NT600S.  
Saved to flash memory (recording format unique to NT600S)  
Screen saving method  
(screen data memory)  
* Number of numeral memory tables that can be used:  
Number used for numeral display + number used for graphics + number used for numeral settings  
512  
Display Element Specifications  
Item  
Display characters  
Specification  
Half-size characters (8 x 8 dots): Alphanumerics and symbols  
Normal characters (8 x 16 dots): Alphanumerics and symbols  
Marks (16 x 16 dots): User-defined pictographs  
Horizontal and vertical magnifications of 4x, 9x, 16x, and 64x  
Enlarged characters up to 4x  
Enlargement function  
Smoothing processing  
Character display attributes  
Graphics  
Normal, inverse, flashing, inverse flashing  
Rectangles, circles  
Data Quantities  
Specification  
Item  
Direct Connection  
256 strings comprising 40 characters each  
512 max. (8 digits each)  
64 marks  
RS-232C Communication  
Strings  
Numeral data  
Marks  
Touch switches  
Lamps  
No limits if direct specification function Combined total of 256 for lamps and  
is used. touch switches  
ꢄꢇꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
Special Features  
Item  
Specification  
Buzzer  
Two types: Continuous sound and intermittent sound  
Setting:  
Set “key press sound” in the “Memory Switch” menu of the  
Maintenance Mode ON.  
If “ERR ON” is set the buzzer only sounds when an error occurs.  
ON: The buzzer sounds on designation from the PC/Host, when a screen  
with a buzzer-ON specification is called, or on display of an error screen  
such as for a receive error.  
OFF: The buzzer is turned off on designation from the PC/Host, by touch  
switch input, or when a screen without a buzzer-ON specification is  
displayed.  
Sound pressure: Min. 80 dB, average 87 dB (measured 10 cm from front face)  
Maintenance functions  
Backup by battery  
Self-test for memory, switches, etc.  
Status setting confirmation for communications and other conditions.  
Simple communications confirmation.  
Connecting an optional battery makes the display history recording and  
resume functions available. (Data retaining time: 5 years (at 25 C))  
If battery voltage becomes low, the RUN LED on the front panel lights in  
orange and the communication flag (BAT LOW) to the Host is turned ON  
(set to “1”).  
The battery can be replaced at the rear of the NT600S while it is running.  
0.2 second input sound when a touch switch is pressed  
Key input sound setting  
Setting: Set “key press sound” of the “Memory Switch” menu in the  
Maintenance mode ON.  
Display history recording  
Resume function  
Available only when the optional battery is installed.  
With the standard specification, these functions are not available since the  
battery is not installed.  
ꢄꢇꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A  
Communications Specifications  
[For a Host Link]  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Communications settings  
EIA RS-232C  
Start-stop synchronization  
Baud rate: 9600, 19,200 bps  
Data length: 7 bits  
Stop bit:  
Parity:  
2 bits  
Even  
Connector  
9-pin, D-SUB connector (female)  
1 to 1  
Number of units connected  
Transmission distance  
Communications protocol  
Max. 15 m  
C-series SYSWAY (1:N)  
[For an NT Link (1:1)]  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-232C  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female)  
Number of units connected  
Transmission distance  
1 to 1  
Max. 15 m  
[For an NT Link (1:N)]  
Item  
Specification  
Communications standard  
Connector  
EIA RS-232C  
9-pin D-SUB connector (female)  
1:1 to 8  
Number of units connected  
RS-232C cable  
: Max. 2 m (*)  
Transmission distance  
RS-422A/485 cable : Total length 500 m (*)  
(*)When NT-AL001 used  
[For RS-232C]  
Item  
Specification  
Communication standard  
Communication settings  
EIA RS-232C  
Start-stop synchronization  
Baud rate: 2400/4800/9600/19200 (bps)  
Data length: 7, 8  
Stop bit:  
Parity:  
1, 2  
Even/Odd/None  
Flow control:RS/CS control  
XON/XOFF control  
None  
Connector  
9-pin D-SUB (female)  
1-to-1  
Number of units connected  
Transmission distance  
Max. 15 m  
ꢄꢇꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix B  
APPENDIX B  
Dimensions  
[ Body ]  
NT600S-ST121(B)-V  
NT600S-ST211(B)-V  
263  
(10.34)  
POWER  
RUN  
192  
180  
(7.55)  
(7.08)  
6(0.24)  
71  
(2.79)  
275  
(10.81)  
Unit : mm (inch)  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix B  
[ Installation ]  
15.5 (0.61)  
Installation panel  
34 (1.34)  
(min.)  
Installation fitting  
180 (7.09)  
38 (1.5)  
(max.)  
287 (11.3)  
Unit : mm (inch)  
[ Cable Installation ]  
RS232C cable  
45 (1.77)  
Unit : mm (inch)  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C  
APPENDIX C  
Handling the RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit  
This section shows the dimensions of the RS-232C/RS-422 converter unit (NT-AL001), and describes the methods  
for installing and removing it. Refer to this information when designing the control panel.  
Dimensions  
53.5  
(2.11)  
110  
(4.33)  
74.5 (2.93)  
30  
(1.18)  
4
100.2 (3.94)  
(0.16)  
105 (4.13) or less  
45 (1.77)  
30  
(1.18)  
(Unit: mm)  
With RS-422A terminal block cover closed: 30 (W) x 114 (H) x 100.2 (D) mm  
With RS-422A terminal block cover open: 30 (W) x 114 (H) x 119.5 (D) mm  
Installation and Removal  
The RS-232C/RS-422A converter unit (NT-AL001) is installed on a DIN rail or in an operation panel.  
The RS-422A terminal block of the converter unit can easily be removed.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C  
Installation on a DIN Rail  
Hook the top part of the rear of the converter unit ((a) in the figure) onto the top edge of the DIN rail, and push the unit  
in direction (b).  
Then fit end plates on the right and left sides of the converter unit so that the unit cannot shift sideways.  
(a)  
(b)  
Removal from the DIN Rail  
Remove the end plates at right and left, then insert a flat-tipped screwdriver into the rail stopper on the bottom of the  
unit and pry the unit away.  
Installation in an Operation Panel  
Make two screw holes in an operation panel wall at least 2 mm thick and securethe converter to the wall with screws.  
30  
(1.18)  
110 (4.33)  
100 (3.94)  
2-M4  
21  
(0.83)  
(Unit: mm)  
Note  
In order to ensure a strong installation, the wall of the operation panel must be at  
least 2 mm thick.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix D  
APPENDIX D  
NT600S Installation Environment  
When installing the PT in the operation panel, observe the following points. See also the section “Getting Starting”.  
The view angle of the LCD screen is 50 to the left and 40 to the right. Install it at a position and height where  
operators will be able to see it well.  
Do not install the unit at locations where the ambient temperature goes outside the range 0 to 50 C or where the  
relative humidity goes outside the range 35 to 85% RH.  
If the ambient temperature exceeds the range indicated above, install a fan or an air conditioner.  
Louvre  
PT  
ntrol panel  
Provide sufficient space for ventilation  
Do not install the unit directly above equipment that generates a lot of heat (heaters, transformers, large capacity  
resistors, etc.)  
To ensure that the unit can be operated and maintained without difficulty, install it at a distance from high-voltage  
equipment and power equipment.  
Install the unit as far as possible from personal computers, amateur radio equipment, radios, etc. The radio  
waves generated by the unit may cause interference that will affect these types of equipment.  
Caution  
Do not install the NT600S at sites subject to the following conditions.  
Otherwise, the product may malfunction.  
Severe temperature variations  
Temperatures or humidities outside the ranges stated in the specifications  
High humidity, condensation  
Splashing chemical agents  
Severe oil splashing  
Corrosive or flammable gases  
Strong vibrations or shocks  
Direct exposure to wind and rain (outdoor sites)  
Strong ultra-violet irradiation  
Take adequate measures to ensure shielding if the NT600S is used at a location  
subject to any of the following conditions.  
Otherwise, the product may malfunction.  
Static electricity, or noise from other equipment  
Strong electromagnetic fields  
Nearby power cables  
Potential exposure to radioactivity  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix D  
Take the following points into account in order to prevent noise  
(1) Avoid installing the unit in panels in which high-voltage equipment is also installed.  
(2) Install the unit at a distance of at least 200 mm from power lines.  
Power line  
0 mm min.  
NT600S  
200 mm min.  
(3) If the unit is installed next to equipment that generates a strong electric or magnetic field (solenoids, etc.), pro-  
vide a gap of at least 40 mm.  
40 mm min.  
PT  
Solenoid  
Note  
When using the RS-232C +5V output, check the current capacity of the con-  
nected equipment. The maximum current value of the NT20S +5 V output is 150  
mA.  
Transportation and Storage of the PT  
Note on transportation  
Pack the PT in the packaging intended for it before transporting it.  
Note on storage  
Maintain the storage ambient temperature (--20 to 70 C) and storage ambient humidity (35 to 85% RH).  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
APPENDIX E  
Method for Making the Cable for Connection to the PC/Host  
Explained below is the method for making the cable that connects the NT600S and the PC/Host.  
Connect the wires to the connectors in accordance with the connector specification for each unit.  
Making the Cable for Connection to the PC  
Parts Required  
Two connectors, two connector covers and one cable are required to make up a connecting cable. One connector  
and one connector cover is supplied with most PCs.  
Remarks  
Name  
Model  
Delivered with  
Connector  
XM2A-0901  
C series CQM1, C200HS,  
C200HX/HG/HE  
9-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
CVM1/CV series CPU unit  
CV500-LK201  
XM2A-2501  
C500-LK203  
C500-LK201  
C200H-LK201  
25-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
DB-25P  
C500-LK201-V1  
C120-LK201-V1  
25-pin, manufactured by JAE  
Connector  
Cover  
XM2S-0911  
C series CQM1, C200HS,  
C200HX/HG/HE  
CVM1/CV series CPU unit  
CV500-LK201  
9-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
XM2S-2511  
DB-C2-J9  
Note  
C500-LK203  
C500-LK201  
C200H-LK201  
25-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
25-pin, manufactured by JAE  
C500-LK201-V1  
C120-LK201-V1  
When connecting the NT600S to an OMRON PLC C  
connector hood must be prepared separately since they are not supplied with the  
H.  
The connector provided in the CPU unit of the C  
connection, the following connector and connector hood should be prepared.  
Connector: XM2A-0901 (9-pin type, OMRON)  
H , the connector and the  
C
H is a 9-pin connector. For the  
Connector hood: XM2S-0911 (9-pin type, OMRON)  
Prepare the cable recommended by OMRON.  
The recommended cables are indicated in the following table.  
Name  
Type  
AWG28 5P  
Remark  
Multiconductor shielded cable (FUJIKURA, Ltd.)  
IFVV-SB  
Cable  
CO-MA-VV-SB  
5P 28AWG  
Multiconductor shielded cable (HITACHI Cable, Ltd.)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Connector Specifications and Wiring for OMRON Units  
The combination of pin numbers to which the connecting wires are connected differs according to the connector  
specifications for each unit. Check the connector specifications of the unit to be connected and make the wiring  
connections for the items in the connection combination indicated below which are applicable.  
[NT600S Connector Specifications (9-pin)]  
Electrical characteristics:  
Signal direction:  
Complies with EIA RS-232C  
Signal input and output is relative to NT600S.  
1
Connector Pin No.  
Signal Name  
Abbreviation  
FG (*1)  
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
Frame ground  
Send data  
SD (TXD)  
RD (RXD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
+5V  
Receive data  
Request to send  
Clear to send  
+5V Output150mA max. (211(B)-EV  
100mA max. (121(B)-EV  
)
)
9
5
9
Signal ground  
SG  
(*1) FG is not used.  
Check the current capacity of the supplied equipment before using the No.6 pin  
(+5 V output). The +5 V output for NT600S is +5 V 5%, 150 mA max. in the case  
Correct Use  
of ST211(B)-EV and +5 V 5%, 100 mA max. in the case of ST121(B)-EV  
.
Connecting an NT600S to a C-Series Host Link  
C-Series Host Link Unit 25-pin Connector Specifications  
Applicable Host Link Unit:  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C500-LK201-V1  
C500-LK203  
C120-LK201-V1  
Electrical characteristics:  
Signal direction:  
Complies with EIA RS-232C  
Signal input and output is relative to the PC.  
Signal Direction  
Connector  
Pin No.  
1
14  
Abbreviation  
FG  
Signal Name  
Input  
--  
Output  
--  
1
2
Frame ground  
Send data  
SD (TXD)  
RD (RXD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
SG  
3
Receive data  
4
Request to send  
Clear to send  
5
7
Signal ground  
--  
--  
--  
--  
14  
15  
17  
20  
24  
Optical connector +5V (see note 2)  
+5V  
Send signal element timing 2 (see note 1) ST2  
25  
13  
Receive signal element timing (see note 1)  
Data terminal ready  
RT  
ER (DTR)  
ST1  
Data signal element timing (see note 1)  
Note 1. No element timing signals on C200H-LK201  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. C500-LK201 and C200H-LK201(-V1) only  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Wiring Connections  
The NT600S does not use pin 4 (RS) or pin 5 (CS). Either short the RS and CS pins of the PC connector together  
or set the CTS setting selector switch at the rear face of the host link unit to “0V” (see in the figure).  
Connect the cable shielding wire to the connector cover and pin 1 at the host link unit end of the cable only.  
NT600S  
PC (host link unit)  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Pin  
number  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
--  
3
RS-232C  
interface  
4
RS-232C  
interface  
5
6
7
SG  
--  
--  
8
Shielding  
wire  
SG  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
20  
ER  
25-pin connector  
Connecting an NT600S to a C-Series CPU (C  
H)  
C-Series CPU Unit (C  
Applicable CPU:  
H) 9-pin Connector Specifications  
C20H/C28H/C40H/C60H  
Electrical characteristics:  
Signal direction:  
Complies with EIA RS-232C  
Signal input and output is relative to the PC.  
Signal Direction  
Connector  
Pin No.  
1
6
Abbreviation  
FG  
Signal Name  
Input  
--  
Output  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
7
Frame ground  
Send data  
SD (TXD)  
RD (RXD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
SG (GND)  
Receive data  
Request to send  
Clear to send  
Signal ground  
9
5
--  
--  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Wiring Connections  
The NT600S does not use pin 4 (RS) or pin 5 (CS). Short the RS and CS pins of the PC connector together (see  
in the figure).  
Connect the cable shielding wire to the connector cover and pin 1 at both the NT600S and CPU ends of the cable.  
NT600S  
PC CPU  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Pin  
number  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
--  
--  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
--  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
SG  
--  
--  
Shielding  
wire  
SG  
--  
9-pin connector  
Connecting an NT600S to a CVM1/CV-Series Host Link Unit  
CVM1/CV-Series Host Link Unit Connector Specifications  
Applicable host link unit:  
Electrical characteristics:  
Signal direction:  
CV500-LK201  
Complies with EIA RS-232C  
Signal input and output is relative to the PC.  
Communication Port 1 (25-pin Connector)  
Signal Direction  
Connector Pin  
Abbreviation  
FG  
Signal Name  
Frame ground  
1
14  
No.  
Input  
--  
Output  
Connector cover  
--  
--  
1
2
Frame ground  
Send data  
FG  
--  
SD (TXD)  
RD (RXD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
SG (GND)  
CD (DCD)  
+5V  
3
Receive data  
4
Request to send  
Clear to send  
5
7
Signal ground  
--  
--  
8
Carrier detected  
Optical connector +5V  
Data terminal ready  
25  
13  
14  
20  
ER (DTR)  
Communication Port 2 (9-pin Connector)  
Signal Direction  
1
Connector  
Pin No.  
6
Abbreviation  
Signal Name  
Input  
--  
Output  
--  
Connector cover  
Frame ground  
Send data  
FG  
2
3
4
5
9
SD (TXD)  
RD (RXD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
SG (GND)  
Receive data  
Request to send  
Clear to send  
Signal ground  
9
5
--  
--  
ꢄꢈꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Wiring Connections  
CVM1/CV-series host link units have two types of connector, which must be wired differently.  
The NT600S does not use pin 4 (RS) or pin 5 (CS). Either short the RS and CS pins of the PC connector together  
or set the CTS setting selector switch at the rear face of the host link unit to “0V” (see in the figure).  
Connect the cable shielding wire to the connector cover and pin 1 at the host link unit end of the cable only.  
Communication Port 1 (25-pin Connector)  
NT600S  
PC (host link unit)  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Pin  
number  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
--  
3
RS-232C  
interface  
4
RS-232C  
interface  
5
6
7
SG  
--  
--  
8
Shielding  
wire  
SG  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
20  
ER  
25-pin connector  
Communication Port 2 (9-pin Connector)  
NT600S  
PC (host link unit)  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Pin  
number  
Connector cover  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
--  
2
3
4
5
6
7
--  
9
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
CD  
--  
--  
SG  
SG  
9-pin connector  
Shielding  
wire  
ꢄꢈꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Connecting an NT600S to a C Series C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, or CPM1, CQM1, CVM1/CV Series (-V ) CPU  
Unit (Including Communication Port)  
C-Series C200HS, C200HX/HG/HE, CPM1, CQM1, CVM1/CV-Series (-EV ) CPU Unit 9-pin Connector Specifi-  
cations  
Applicable CPU:  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
CPM1-10CDR-  
C200HE-CPU32-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HG-CPU33-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV  
CVM1-CPU11-EV  
CVM1-CPU21-EV  
C200HX-CPU34-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
CQM1-CPU41-E  
CQM1-CPU42-E  
CQM1-CPU43-E  
CQM1-CPU44-E  
CPM1-20CDR-  
CPM1-30CDR-  
Note  
The host link function incorporated in CV/CVM1 CPUs (with the exception of  
-EV ) cannot be used.  
Electrical characteristics:  
Signal direction:  
Complies with EIA RS-232C  
Signal input and output is relative to the PC.  
1
6
Signal Direction  
Connector  
Abbreviation  
Signal Name  
Pin No.  
Input  
Output  
Connector cover  
Frame ground  
FG  
--  
--  
2
3
4
5
9
Send data  
SD (TXD)  
RD (RXD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
SG (GND)  
Receive data  
Request to send  
Clear to send  
Signal ground  
9
5
--  
--  
Wiring Connections  
The NT600S does not use pin 4 (RS) or pin 5 (CS). Either short the RS and CS pins of the PC connector together  
or set the CTS setting selector switch at the rear face of the host link unit to “0V” (see in the figure).  
NT600S  
PC (host link unit)  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Abbrevi-  
atioon  
Pin  
number  
Connector cover  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
--  
2
3
4
5
--  
--  
--  
9
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
--  
--  
--  
SG  
SG  
9-pin connector  
Shielding  
wire  
ꢄꢈꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Connecting an NT600S to an RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit (NT-AL001)  
Connecting to an RS-232C/RS-422 converter unit allows transmissions over distances greater than 15 m (maxi-  
mum of 500 m).  
NT600S  
RS-232C  
RS-422A  
Reference  
When connecting a C200HX/HG/HE and an RS-232C/RS-422 converter unit, use  
a converter unit whose lot number is 15Y5 or later. Converter units of lot numbers  
previous to 15Y5 cannot be connected.  
NT-AL001 RS-232C Connector Specifications (9-pin Type)  
Electrical characteristics: Conform to EIA RS-232C  
Signal direction: Signal input and output is relative to the NT-AL001.  
Signal Direction  
Connector  
Pin No.  
Abbreviation  
FG  
Signal Name  
Input  
--  
Output  
--  
Grounding or earth for safety  
Connector cover  
purposes  
2
3
4
5
6
9
Send data  
SD (TxD)  
RD (RxD)  
RS (RTS)  
CS (CTS)  
+5V  
Receive data  
Request to send  
Clear to send  
+5V input  
Signal ground  
SG (GND)  
--  
--  
ꢄꢈꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
NT-AL001 RS-422A terminal block specifications  
Connected terminal block: RS-422A terminal block (M3 screws)  
Electrical characteristics: Conform to EIA RS-422A  
Signal direction: Signal input and output is relative to the NT-AL001.  
Signal Direction  
Terminal Block  
Signal Name  
Abbreviation  
CSA  
Pin No.  
Input  
Output  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Request to send (--)  
Request to send (+)  
Receive data (--)  
Receive data (+)  
Send data (--)  
CSB  
RDA  
RDB  
SDA  
Send data (+)  
SDB  
Signal ground  
SG (GND)  
FG  
--  
--  
--  
--  
Functional ground  
Note  
The CSB and CSA signals are for special applications.  
Wiring  
[For NT600S-ST211(B)-V  
]
NT600S  
NT-AL001  
Host  
RS-232C  
RS-422A  
Terminal  
No.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Signal Name  
Ground for safety  
Signal ground  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
SG  
Receive data (+)  
Receive data (--)  
Send data (+)  
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
CSB  
RS-422A  
interface  
RS-422A  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
Send data (--)  
Request to send (+)  
Request to send (--)  
*
*
--  
CSA  
SG  
SG  
Terminal block  
(9-pin)  
Shielding  
wire  
(9-pin)  
Shielding  
wire  
[For NT600S-ST121(B)-V  
]
NT600S  
NT-AL001  
Host  
RS-232C  
RS-422A  
Terminal  
No.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Signal Name  
Ground for safety  
Signal ground  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
1
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SG  
Receive data (+)  
Receive data (--)  
Send data (+)  
SDB  
SDA  
RDB  
RDA  
CSB  
RS-422A  
interface  
RS-422A  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
Send data (--)  
Request to send (+)  
Request to send (--)  
+5V  
(150mA)  
*
*
--  
CSA  
SG  
SG  
Terminal block  
(9-pin)  
Shielding  
wire  
(9-pin)  
Shielding  
wire  
(*) CSB and CSA are connected when the NT600S requires RS/CS control for the host control method.  
ꢄꢈꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Making the Cable  
The procedure to make up the cable is described below.  
Refer to the following explanation when making an RS-422A cable also.  
Cable Preparation  
The preparation of the cable differs according to whether or not the shielding wire is to be connected to the FG.  
Cable with Shielding Wire Connected to FG  
(1) Cut the cable to the required length.  
(2) Remove the external vinyl insulation from the cable with a razor blade. Take care not to damage the shielding  
underneath.  
(3) Cut back the shielding wire with scissors.  
(4) Use wire strippers to strip the insulation from each wire.  
(5) Fold back the shielding wire.  
(6) Wrap aluminum foil tape around the folded-back shielding wire.  
(1)  
(2)  
40(1.57)(RS-232C)  
(3)  
10(0.39)  
(4)  
5(0.19)  
(5)  
(6)  
[Units: mm (in.)]  
Aluminum foil tape  
ꢄꢈꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Cable with Shielding Wire Not Connected to FG  
(1) Cut the cable to the required length.  
(2) Remove the external vinyl insulation from the cable with a razor blade. Take care not to damage the shielding  
underneath.  
(3) Cut back the shielding wire with scissors.  
(4) Use wire strippers to strip the insulation from each wire.  
(5) Wrap vinyl tape over the cut off end of the shielding wire.  
(1)  
(2)  
40(1.57)(RS-232C)  
(3)  
(4)  
5(0.19)  
(5)  
[Units: mm (in.)]  
Vinyl tape  
Soldering  
(1) Slide heat-shrink tube over each wire.  
(2) Pre-solder each wire and connector cable.  
(3) Solder each wire to the connector terminal.  
ng iron  
Heat-shrink tube  
(F, 1.5mm dia, l = 10mm)  
(4) Push the heat-shrink tube over the soldered joint and heat the tube to shrink it in place.  
Heat-shrink tube  
ꢄꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix E  
Connector Cover Assembly  
Assemble the connector covers as shown in the diagram below.  
Aluminum foil tape  
End connected to FG  
End not connected to FG  
Preparing RS-232C Connector Cables  
Prepare a connector cable to connect a NT600S to a HOST separated by more than 5 m so that the supplied con-  
nector cable (XW2Z-500P) cannot be used. The maximum cable length is 15 m.  
Recommended Parts  
Name  
Connector  
Model  
XM2A-0901  
Remarks  
9-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
9-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
Connector cover  
Cable  
XM2S-0911  
AWG28 5P  
IFVV-SB  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Fujikura, Ltd.  
CO-MA-VV-SB  
5P 28AWG  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Hitachi Cable, Ltd.  
On the other end of the cable use the type of connector and connector cover which matches the host computer  
connector type.  
Connection For Host  
Only the shielded wire on the host side is connected to the connector hood. The  
following diagram is for RS/CS control. If RS/CS control is not executed, RS and  
CS must be short-circuited (turned over) for both the NT600S and host side.  
NT600S  
HOST  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
ation  
Abbrevi-  
ation  
Pin  
number  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
--  
RD  
SD  
--  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
SG  
--  
RS  
CS  
--  
SG  
Shielding  
wire  
Note  
For some host computers the combination of pin numbers and signal names may  
differ from those shown in the diagram above. Refer to the Host instruction manu-  
al before wiring the connector.  
ꢄꢈꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix F  
APPENDIX F  
Connecting to an RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit (1:1)  
By using an RS-232C/RS-422 converter unit (NT-AL001), RS-232C can be converted to RS-422A, allowing long--  
distance communication of up to 500 m.  
Connection Method  
OMRON PC  
RS-232C cable  
(max. 2 m)  
RS-232C/RS-422  
converter unit,  
type NT-AL001  
RS-422A cable  
(max. 500 m)  
RS-232C/RS-422  
converter unit,  
type NT-AL001  
RS-232C cable  
(max. 2 m)  
NT600S  
Wiring  
Wiring of RS-232C cable  
PT or PC  
NT-AL001  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
Connector cover  
Connector cover  
2
3
4
5
6
9
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
SG  
2
3
4
5
6
9
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
SG  
RS-232C  
interface  
RS-232C  
interface  
Shielding  
wire  
Only connected at PC  
The pin numbers are the numbers at the NT600S.  
For the pin numbers at the PC, refer to the manual for the PC used.  
ꢄꢈꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix F  
RS-422A Cable Wiring  
NT-AL001  
NT-AL001  
Pin No.  
Abbrev.  
Abbrev.  
Pin No.  
1
3
4
5
6
FG  
FG  
1
3
4
5
6
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
RS-422A  
terminal  
block  
SDA  
SDB  
RDA  
RDB  
SDA  
SDB  
RDA  
RDB  
Shielding  
wire  
DIP Switch Settings at RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit  
ꢄꢈꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix G  
APPENDIX G  
Function Restrictions Depending on the Support Tool  
When using the direct connection function, screens can be created by using the conventional support tools indi-  
cated below.  
NT series NT20M/NT2000M/NT600M support tool (Ver.4.  
)
In addition, the NT series support tool (Ver.2. ) can be used with Ver.4 of the direct connection function.  
However, when the above support tools are used or Ver.4 direct connection is used, restrictions apply to some func-  
tions, as shown in the table below.  
The expressions used for support tools in the table have the following meanings.  
NTM V4  
NT V2  
: NT series NT20M/NT2000M/NT600M support (Ver.4.  
)
: NT series support tool (Ver.2.  
)
Support Tool Mode  
(NT600S memory  
switch)  
Support  
Tool  
Direct  
NT Model  
Communication Mode  
Restrictions  
Connection  
OMRON  
Thumbwheel numeral settings  
not possible, no upper/lower  
limits, hexadecimal input not  
possible, indirect specification  
not possible, touch switch input  
notification fixed as “momentary”,  
data transmission in screen units  
not possible.  
NTM V4  
NT600M  
NT600M  
--(Standard)  
Standard  
NT600M  
NT600M  
Ver. 4  
NT V2  
NT600S  
NT600S  
Ver. 4  
Ver. 5  
Standard/High-speed  
Standard/High-speed  
NT600S  
NT600S  
No restriction  
The NT600S cannot be used with combinations of support tools and settings other than those indicated above.  
Reference  
When using RS-232C communications, the NT series support tool (Ver.2. ).  
However, the NT series NT20M/NT200M/NT600M support tool (Ver.4. ) cannot  
be used.  
The necessary support tool and “Tool Mode” (NT600S memory switch) settings in  
this case are as follows:  
PT model  
: NT600S  
: No  
Direct setting  
Communication mode : Standard/High-speed  
Tool Mode : NT600S  
ꢄꢉꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix H  
APPENDIX H  
Making the Cable for Connection to the Support Tool  
Make the connection cable for connection to the support tool by referring to the following explanation.  
Parts Required  
The table below indicates the recommended parts for making the connection cable.  
Name  
Connector  
Model  
XM2A-2501  
Remarks  
25-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
XM2A-0901  
XM2D-0901  
XM2S-2511  
XM2S-0901  
9-pin (Plug), manufactured by OMRON  
9-pin (Socket), manufactured by OMRON  
25-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
Connector cover  
Cable  
9-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
AWG28 5P  
IFVV-SB  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Fujikura, Ltd  
CO-MA-VV-SB  
5P 28AWG  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Hitachi Cable, Ltd  
The recommended parts listed above are those applicable when the personal computer features a 25-pin DSub  
female connector. If the personal computer features another type of connector, prepare the appropriate parts by  
referring to its manual.  
Wiring Connections  
The connector at the NT600S used for connecting the support tool is also used as the connector for connecting the  
PC/Host.  
For the pin configuration, refer to NT600S Connector Specifications (page 267).  
The wiring connection is shown below.  
With a 25-pin Connector  
NT600S  
PC (RS-232C 25pin connector)  
Pin  
number  
Abbrevi-  
ation  
Abbrevi-  
ation  
Pin  
number  
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
+5V  
--  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
FG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
--  
3
RS-232C  
interface  
4
RS-232C  
interface  
5
6
7
SG  
--  
--  
8
Shielding  
wire  
SG  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
20  
ER  
Note  
For some host computers the combination of pin numbers and signal names may  
differ from those shown in the diagram above. Refer to the Host instruction manu-  
al before wiring the connector.  
ꢄꢉꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix H  
With a 9-pin Connector  
2
3
7
8
5
2
3
4
5
9
RD  
SD  
RS  
CS  
SG  
SD  
RD  
RS  
CS  
SG  
Personal  
computer  
side  
PT tool  
connector side  
1
Shielding  
wire  
When making the connection cable, use the following recommended parts.  
Name  
Connector  
Model  
XM2D-0901  
Remarks  
9-pin type, made by OMRON (personal computer side)  
9-pin type, made by OMRON (PT side)  
XM2A-0901  
XM2S-0911  
Connector cover  
Cable  
9-pin type, made by OMRON (two)  
AWG28 5P  
IFVV-SB  
Multi-core shielded cable (FUJIKURA, Ltd.)  
CO-MA-VV-SB  
5P 28AWG  
Multi-core shielded cable (HITACHI cable, Ltd.)  
ꢄꢉꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix I  
APPENDIX I  
NT600S Internal Processing  
When Host/NT link or C200H direct is used, the following processing is executed inside the NT600S. Processing is  
divided into two types: periodic processing and event processing.  
Periodic Processing (When Using Direct Connection)  
The following processing is executed inside the NT600S to enable high-speed control from the PC.  
Usually, the only data read from the PC area the elements used for the currently displayed screen. Even if the con-  
tents of the PC words allocated to memory tables are changed, these contents are not updated at the PT unless the  
memory table is used for the displayed screen.  
[NT600S (PT) processing]  
[Details of processing]  
PT power ON  
Initial processing  
Operation start  
Hardware check, communication status check, etc., executed.  
When the values registered in the NT600S are used as the  
initial values in the memory tables, these values are written into  
the allocated words of the PC.  
Initial values written to the memory  
tables  
(PT  
(PT  
PC)  
PC)  
Screen switching  
In order to enable fast batch processing, the elements used in  
the displayed screen are registered in the PC in advance.  
Approximately 120 words can be registered per screen.  
Screen element registration  
Reading of registered  
elements  
The statuses of the registered elements are read from the PC  
and the display is changed.  
(PT  
(PT  
(PT  
(PT  
(PT  
(PT  
(PT  
PC)  
The status of the elements that were in excess of the registrable  
number and could not be registered is read from the PC, and  
the display is changed. This processing is continued until the  
statuses of all the remaining elements has been read.  
Reading of elements  
that could not be  
registered.  
PC)  
PC)  
PC)  
PC)  
PC)  
PC)  
Reading of the  
elements that could not  
be registered.  
If the number of elements that could not be registered is large,  
the PT status control area is read after every two element  
readings.  
Reading the PT status  
control area  
Reading of elements  
that could not be  
registered  
Reading of elements  
that could not be  
registered  
Reading of the PT  
status control area  
: Processing performed if necessary  
ꢄꢉꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix I  
Number of words for screen element registration  
The number of words used for screen element registration is as follows.  
Allocated words: Number of words  
Allocated bits : Number of words calculated by summing the number of bits in  
each area and taking 1 word to be 16 bits.  
[Example]  
Character string memory tables : 3 of 12 allocated words each  
Numeral memory tables  
Allocated bits for control  
: 4 of 2 allocated words each  
: 19 I/O relays, 7 link relays (contiguous bits)  
The number of words assigned to character string memory tables and numeral  
memory tables is as follows:  
12 words X 3 + 2 words X 4 = 44 words  
The assignment for bits is as follows:  
19 I/O relays  
7 link relays  
16 = 1 word with a remainder of 3 bits  
16 = 0 words with a remainder of 7 bits  
2 words  
1 word  
The total is therefore 44 words + 2 words + 1 word = 47 words  
Elements occupying up to approximately 120 words, calculated in this way, can be  
registered. If the number of elements is larger than this, internal processing is in-  
creased in proportion to the excess number and this generates a delay in proces-  
sing.  
If the point where the registrable quantity is exceeded is in the middle of an ele-  
ment that spans several words (for example a character string memory table), reg-  
istration is quit without registering that element.  
Order of priority for registration  
Elements are registered in the following order of priority according to their type.  
(1) Allocated words of the PT status control area  
(2) Allocated bits for control (lamps, touch switches)  
(3) Allocated words of numeral memory tables  
(4) Allocated words of character string memory tables  
If there is more than one element for each of (2) through (4), the elements are reg-  
istered in accordance with the following priority of word and bit areas:  
(1) Data memory (DM)  
(2) I/O relays (CH)  
(3) Timers (TIM)  
(4) Counters (CNT)  
(5) Holding relays (HR)  
(6) Auxiliary relays (AR)  
Within each area, words and bits are allocated from the smallest number up.  
ꢄꢉꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix I  
Reference  
Only the bit and numeral/character-string memory table data of elements current-  
ly being used in the screen display is written to the PC. If the contents of a numer-  
al/character-string memory table that is not being used for display change, the  
new data is not written to the PC.  
Event Processing (When Using Direct Connection)  
When the status of the NT600S changes during operation, the processing for writing the changed data to the rele-  
vant area of the PC memory is executed.  
This kind of processing is only executed when statuses change. When changes occur simultaneously, the proces-  
sings are executed in accordance with the order of priority.  
[NT600S processing]  
[Details of processing]  
Writing to the PT status notify area in order to inform  
the PC of changes in the PT operating status.  
High  
(PTPC)  
Writing to the PT status notify area  
Writing to bits in order to inform the PC that a touch  
switch has been pressed.  
(PTPC)  
Bit writing  
Writing to numeral memory tables  
Writing to character string memory tables  
Changing the contents of words allocated to the PC  
when the value in a numeral memory table has  
changed.  
(PTPC)  
Changing the contents of words allocated to the PC  
when the value in a numeral memory table has  
changed.  
Low  
(PTPC)  
Reference  
Data is only written to PC bits and numeral/character string memory tables for ele-  
ments in screens currently being displayed. If the contents of numeral/character  
string memory tables that are not being displayed change, the changed contents  
are not written to the PC.  
ꢄꢉꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix J  
APPENDIX J  
Model List  
PT  
Model  
Specification  
NT600S-ST121-EV  
NT600S-ST121B-EV  
NT600S-ST211-EV  
NT600S-ST211B-EV  
Beige, LCD type  
Black, LCD type  
Beige, EL type  
Black, EL type  
Host Link Unit  
Model  
Specification  
Applicable PC  
C-series  
C120-LK201-V1  
CPU-mounted type with RS-232C connector  
3G2A6-LK201-EV1  
C120  
C200H  
C500(F)  
C1000H  
C120-LK202-V1  
3G2A6-LK202-EV1  
CPU-mounted type with RS-422 connector  
C2000 (H)  
C200H-LK101-PV1  
C200H-LK201-V1  
C200H-LK202-V1  
Rack-mounting Unit with optical-fiber cable connector for C200H C-series  
C200H  
Rack-mounting Unit with RS-232C connector for C200H  
Rack-mounting Unit with RS-422C connector for C200H  
Features an optical-fiber cable connector  
C200HS  
C200HE  
C200HG  
C200HX  
C500-LK101-(P)V1  
3G2A5-LK201-EV1  
C-series  
C500(F)  
C1000(H)  
C2000(H)  
C500-LK103(-P)  
Rack-mounting Unit for C500  
C500-LK201-V1  
Features a selectable RS232C/RS-422 connector  
3G2A5-LK101-(P)EV1  
C500-LK203  
Rack-mounting Unit for C500  
CV500-LK201  
Features an RS-232C connector and a selectable  
RS-232C/RS-422 connector  
CVM1/CV-series  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
Rack-mounting Unit for CVM1/CV  
ꢄꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix J  
CPUs (For Connection Via a Host Link)  
Model  
Specification  
PC Type  
C20H  
C28H  
C40H  
C60H  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
C20H  
C28H  
C40H  
C60H  
CPM1-10CDR-  
CPM1-20CDR-  
CPM1-30CDR-  
Connect an RS-232C adapter to the peripheral port.  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
CPM1  
CQM1-CPU21-E  
CQM1-CPU41-E  
CQM1-CPU42-E  
CQM1-CPU43-E  
CQM1-CPU44-E  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C-series  
CQM1  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU32-E(*)  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HE  
C200HG-CPU33-E(*)  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E(*)  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HG  
C200HX-CPU34-E(*)  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E(*)  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HX  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU01-EV  
CVM1-CPU11-EV  
CVM1-CPU21-EV  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
CVM1/CV-series  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1  
Note  
For CPU units marked (*), a communications port is required.  
ꢄꢉꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix J  
CPUs (For Connection Via an NT Link (1:1))  
Name  
Model  
PC Type  
CPM1-10CDR-  
CPM1-20CDR-  
CPM1-30CDR-  
Connect an RS-232C adapter to the peripheral port.  
C-series  
CPM1  
CQM1-CPU41-E  
CQM1-CPU42-E  
CQM1-CPU43-E  
CQM1-CPU44-E  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
C-series  
CQM1  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS-CPU33-E  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU32-E(*)  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HE  
C200HG-CPU33-E(*)  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E(*)  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HG  
C200HX-CPU34-E(*)  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E(*)  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HX  
CV500-CPU01-EV1  
CV1000-CPU01-EV1  
CV2000-CPU01-EV1  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
Features a 9-pin connector for RS-232C connections  
CV500  
CV1000  
CV2000  
CVM1-CPU01-EV1  
CVM1-CPU11-EV1  
CVM1-CPU21-EV1  
CVM1-series  
Note  
For CPU units marked (*), a communications port is required.  
CPUs (For Connection Via an NT Link (1:N))  
Model  
Specification  
PC Type  
C200HE-CPU32-E(*)  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HE  
C200HG-CPU33-E(*)  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E(*)  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HG  
C200HX-CPU34-E(*)  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E(*)  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
Features a connector for RS-232C connections  
(selectable/9-pin)  
C-series  
C200HX  
Note  
For CPU units marked (*), a communications port is required.  
ꢄꢉꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix J  
CPUs (For Connection Via a C200H Direct Communication)  
Name  
PC Type  
C20H  
C28H  
C40H  
C60H  
C-series  
C20H  
C28H  
C40H  
C60H  
C200H-CPU01-E  
C200H-CPU03-E  
C200H-CPU11-E  
C200H-CPU21-E  
C200H-CPU23-E  
C200H-CPU31-E  
C200H  
C200HS-CPU01-E  
C200HS-CPU03-E  
C200HS-CPU11-E  
C200HS-CPU21-E  
C200HS-CPU23-E  
C200HS-CPU31-E  
C200HS  
C200HE-CPU11-E  
C200HE-CPU32-E  
C200HE-CPU42-E  
C200HE  
C200HG  
C200HG-CPU33-E  
C200HG-CPU43-E  
C200HG-CPU53-E  
C200HG-CPU63-E  
C200HX-CPU34-E  
C200HX-CPU44-E  
C200HX-CPU54-E  
C200HX-CPU64-E  
C200HX  
Related Parts and Equipment for PT  
Name  
Support Tool  
Options  
Model  
NT-ZA3AT-EV2  
NT600S-CFL01  
NT600M-KBA04  
NT600S-KBA01  
3G2A9-BAT08  
NT-LB122  
Remarks  
3.5 inch FD for NT Series  
Replaceable backlight  
Reflection-suppressing protective sheet  
Chemical-resistant cover  
Battery  
C200H I/F Unit  
RS-232C/RS-422 Converter Unit  
Model  
Specification  
NT-AL001  
RS-232C : 9-pin connector  
RS-422A : 8-pin connector  
RS-232C Adapter  
Model  
Specification  
CPM1-CIF01  
Connect the RS-232C port of the NT600S and the peripheral port of the CPM1.  
ꢄꢉꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix J  
Parts Used for Connection  
Cables with connectors  
Model  
XW2Z-200S  
Cable Length  
2 m  
Applicable Units  
Communication Method  
Host link  
Host link units with 25-pin  
connectors  
XW2Z-500S  
XW2Z-200T  
XW2Z-500T  
C200H-CN311  
5 m  
2 m  
Host link units and CPU units with Host link,  
9-pin connectors  
NT link (1 to 1)  
5m  
30 cm  
NT20M-CNP711  
C200H-CN711  
70 cm  
2 m  
NT20M-CNP221  
C200H-CN221  
C200H, C200HS,  
C200HX/HG/HE  
NT20M-CNP521  
C200H-CN521  
5 m  
C200H direct communication  
NT20M-CNP131  
C200H-CN131  
10 m  
30 cm  
70 cm  
C20H-CN312  
NT20M-CNP712  
C20H-CN712  
C
H
NT20M-CNP222  
C20H-CN222  
2 m  
Connection cable  
Model  
Remarks  
AWG28 5P  
IFVV-SB  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Fujikura, Ltd.  
CO-MA-VV-SB  
5P 28AWG  
Multicore cable, manufactured by Hitachi Cable, Ltd.  
Applicable connectors  
Name  
Model  
XM2A-2501  
XM2A-0901  
Remark  
Connector  
25-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
9-pin (Plug), manufactured by OMRON  
9-pin (Socket), manufactured by OMRON  
25-pin, manufactured by JAE  
XM2D-0901  
DB-25P  
Connector cover  
XM2S-2511  
XM2S-0901  
DB-C2-J9  
25-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
9-pin, manufactured by OMRON  
25-pin, manufactured by JAE  
ꢄꢊꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix K  
APPENDIX K  
Option List  
Replaceable Backlight ... NT600S-CFL01  
This is a backlight for replacement purposes.  
Reflection-Suppressing Protective Sheet ... NT600M-KBA04  
Stuck to the display to prevent it from being soiled. The entire sheet is colorless and transparent.  
ꢄꢊꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix K  
Chemical-resistant Cover .. Type NT600S-KBA01  
Covers the front panel and protects it from chemical agents. The entire sheet is milky white and made of silicone  
rubber.  
The protection the cover affords is summarized below.  
Protects Against  
Does Not Protect Against  
Boric acid  
Hexane  
Sulfuric acid  
Nitric acid  
Lubricating oils  
Benzene  
Ammonia gas  
Carbon dioxide  
Phenol  
Butane  
Carbonic acid  
Chlorinated solvents  
Napthalene  
Soya oil  
Glycerin  
Ammonia water  
Calcium chloride  
Toluene  
Developing fluid (“hypo”)  
Acetaldehyde  
Lard  
For information on protection against chemical agents not included in the table above, please ask OMRON. (If it is a  
chemical agent to which silicone rubber is recognized to be resistant, the cover can be used with confidence even if  
that chemical agent is not listed in the “Protects Against” column above.  
Reference  
This cover does not afford protection against all chemical agents.  
Since the cover is milky white, it reduces the clarity of the display a little.  
This cover is intended to be affixed to the display in order to provide protection  
against chemical agents. It will not provide protection against chemical agents  
that enter through the installation panel or through the gap between the cover  
and the display.  
ꢄꢊꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix K  
C200H Interface Unit ... NT-LB122  
This is a host interface unit for executing direct communication.  
Battery ... 3G2A9-BAT08  
This is a lithium battery used for memory backup.  
Note  
The disposal of the batteries and backlight may be regulated by national or local  
authorities.  
Dispose of them in accordance with the laws and regulations of the relevant coun-  
try and local authority.  
ꢄꢊꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix L  
APPENDIX L  
PC Memory Map  
OMRON C-Series Memory Map  
Link Relay  
Area  
Timer/Count  
er Area  
Area  
IR Area  
HR Area  
AR Area  
DM Area  
Ladder type  
C20H  
C28H  
C40H  
C60H  
0000 to 0255 0000 to 0099 0000 to 0027 0000 to 0063 0000 to 0511 0000 to 1999  
C120  
0000 to 0063 0000 to 0031  
0000 to 0127 0000 to 0051  
C200H  
0000 to 0255 0000 to 0099 0000 to 0027 0000 to 0063 0000 to 0511 0000 to 1999  
C200HS  
C200HE  
C200HG  
C200HX  
0000 to 6655  
7000 to 9999  
0000 to 0511 0000 to 0099 0000 to 0027 0000 to 0063 0000 to 0511  
C500  
0000 to 0063 0000 to 0031  
0000 to 0031 0000 to 0127 0000 to 0511  
0000 to 4095  
C1000H  
0000 to 0255 0000 to 0099 0000 to 0027 0000 to 0063 0000 to 0051  
C2000(H)  
CQM1  
0000 to 6655  
0000 to 0019  
0200 to 0255  
0000 to 1023  
6144 to 6655  
CPM1  
0000 to 0019 0000 to 0015 0000 to 0015 0000 to 0127  
C500F  
0000 to 0063 0000 to 0031  
0000 to 0031 0000 to 0127 0000 to 0511  
Flow type  
C1000HF  
0000 to 0255 0000 to 0099 0000 to 0027 0000 to 0063 0000 to 0511 0000 to 4095  
OMRON CV-Series Memory Map  
Link Relay  
Area  
Timer/Counter  
Area  
Area  
IR Area  
HR Area (*1)  
AR Area  
DM Area  
CV500  
CVM1-CPU01-V  
0000 to 2555  
0000 to 0511  
0000 to 0511  
0000 to 8191  
CV1000  
CVM1-CPU11(-V  
CV2000  
CVM1-CPU21(-V  
)
)
0000 to 9999  
(*2)  
0000 to 2555  
0000 to 0511  
0000 to 1023  
(*1)  
(*2)  
Included in the IR area in the case of CVM1/CV-series PCs.  
This is the area that can be used with an NT600S. The DM area itself occupies the range 00000 to 24575.  
ꢄꢊꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix M  
APPENDIX M  
Special Characters  
English Character Codes  
Pin 2 of SW2 must be ON to enable English language messages to use the following codes.  
Example: Hex code is represented by 30, decimal code by 48, and character by 0.  
30  
48  
0
Code 20 and 32 in the table represents a space, as indicated by “SP”.  
ꢄꢊꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hex Digits  
1st  
2-  
3-  
4-  
5-  
6-  
7-  
8-  
9-  
2nd  
-0  
-1  
-2  
-3  
-4  
-5  
-6  
-7  
-8  
-9  
-A  
-B  
-C  
-D  
-E  
-F  
20  
32  
21  
33  
22  
34  
23  
35  
24  
36  
25  
37  
26  
38  
27  
39  
28  
40  
29  
41  
2A  
42  
2B  
43  
2C  
44  
2D  
45  
2E  
46  
2F  
47  
SP  
!
30  
48  
31  
49  
32  
50  
33  
51  
34  
52  
35  
53  
36  
54  
37  
55  
38  
56  
39  
57  
3A  
58  
3B  
59  
3C  
60  
3D  
61  
3E  
62  
3F  
63  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
:
40  
64  
41  
65  
42  
66  
43  
67  
44  
68  
45  
69  
46  
70  
47  
71  
48  
72  
49  
73  
4A  
74  
4B  
75  
4C  
76  
4D  
77  
4E  
78  
4F  
79  
@
A
B
C
D
E
F
50  
80  
51  
81  
52  
82  
53  
83  
54  
84  
55  
85  
56  
86  
57  
87  
58  
88  
59  
89  
5A  
90  
5B  
91  
5C  
92  
5D  
93  
5E  
94  
5F  
95  
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
[
60  
96  
a
b
c
d
e
f
70  
112  
71  
p
q
r
80  
128  
81  
Ç
ü
é
â
ä
à
å
ç
ê
ë
è
ï
90  
144  
91  
É
æ
Æ
ô
61  
97  
113  
72  
129  
82  
145  
92  
62  
98  
114  
73  
130  
83  
146  
93  
#
$
%
&
63  
s
t
99  
115  
74  
131  
84  
147  
94  
64  
ö
100  
65  
116  
75  
132  
85  
148  
95  
u
v
w
x
y
z
{
ò
101  
66  
117  
76  
133  
86  
149  
96  
û
102  
67  
118  
77  
134  
87  
150  
97  
G
H
I
g
h
i
ù
103  
68  
119  
78  
135  
88  
151  
98  
(
ÿ
104  
69  
120  
79  
136  
89  
152  
99  
)
Ö
Ü
¢
105  
6A  
106  
6B  
107  
6C  
108  
6D  
109  
6E  
110  
6F  
121  
7A  
137  
8A  
153  
9A  
*
J
j
122  
7B  
138  
8B  
154  
9B  
+
,
;
K
L
k
l
123  
7C  
124  
7D  
125  
7E  
139  
8C  
155  
9C  
<
=
>
?
\
|
î
£
140  
8D  
156  
9D  
-
M
N
O
]
m
n
o
}
ì
¥
141  
8E  
157  
9E  
.
^
~
Ä
Å
Pt  
ƒ
126  
7F  
142  
8F  
158  
9F  
/
_
111  
127  
143  
159  
ꢄꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix M  
Hex Digits  
1st  
A-  
B-  
C-  
D-  
E-  
F-  
2nd  
-0  
-1  
-2  
-3  
-4  
-5  
-6  
-7  
-8  
-9  
-A  
-B  
-C  
-D  
-E  
-F  
A0  
160  
A1  
á
í
B0  
176  
B1  
C0  
192  
C1  
D0  
208  
D1  
E0  
224  
E1  
F0  
α
β
Γ
240  
F1  
161  
A2  
177  
B2  
193  
C2  
209  
D2  
225  
E2  
241  
ó
ú
ñ
Ñ
a
o
¿
F2  
162  
A3  
178  
B3  
194  
C3  
210  
D3  
226  
E3  
242  
F3  
π
Σ
σ
163  
A4  
179  
B4  
195  
C4  
211  
D4  
227  
E4  
243  
F4  
164  
A5  
180  
B5  
196  
C5  
212  
D5  
228  
E5  
244  
F5  
165  
A6  
181  
B6  
197  
C6  
213  
D6  
229  
E6  
245  
F6  
÷
166  
A7  
182  
B7  
198  
C7  
214  
D7  
230  
E7  
246  
F7  
τ
Φ
Θ
167  
A8  
183  
B8  
199  
C8  
215  
D8  
231  
E8  
247  
F8  
168  
A9  
184  
B9  
200  
C9  
216  
D9  
232  
E9  
248  
.
F9  
169  
AA  
185  
BA  
201  
CA  
202  
CB  
203  
CC  
204  
CD  
205  
CE  
206  
CF  
217  
DA  
218  
DB  
219  
DC  
220  
DD  
221  
DE  
222  
DF  
233  
EA  
249  
FA  
170  
AB  
186  
BB  
234  
EB  
250  
FB  
1
/
/
δ
2
4
171  
AC  
172  
AD  
173  
AE  
187  
BC  
188  
BD  
189  
BE  
235  
EC  
236  
ED  
237  
EE  
251  
1
FC  
n
252  
2
¡
FD  
253  
FE  
«
»
ε
174  
AF  
190  
BF  
238  
EF  
254  
FF  
1
175  
191  
207  
223  
239  
255  
1: Used as the prefix for mark data codes (2 bytes).  
Note  
In order to input these characters using the support tool, enter the relevant char-  
acter code with the numeral keys while holding down the ALT key.  
ꢄꢊꢈ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢄꢊꢉ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
Character-string memory table . . . . . . . . . 128, 170  
A
Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8, 120, 128  
Checking the LCD display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104  
Checking the LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
Checking the buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
Checking the communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105  
Checking the touch switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
Child screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124, 125  
Classification of screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
Clear screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
Communication I/F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
Communication procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202  
Comparison between NT600S and NT600M . . . . 7  
Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Compatible PCs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31, 43  
Computer is reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
Connecting the NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32, 43  
Connector specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
Content upgrade memory table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190  
Continuous buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Continuous screens . . . . . . . . . 125, 147, 161, 163  
Contrast control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Control bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
Control timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195  
Controlling the NT600S status . . . . . . . . . 156, 192  
Controlling the display elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155  
Copy memory table setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
Copy memory table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211  
Copy type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175, 177  
Copying the memory table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
Allocatable bits and words . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
Allocated bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
Allocated word . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
Alternate (touch switch) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Automatic reset function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
Automatic reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245  
B
Backlight OFF function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Backlight mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194, 247  
Bar graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
Batch lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292  
Before operating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Buzzer attribute . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Buzzer during operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193  
C
C200H direct communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
CPU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40  
Cannot communicate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242  
Change the lamp display status . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181  
Changing displayed numerals or  
character-strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170, 172, 175  
Changing the contents of allocated bits . . . . . . . 181  
Changing the contents of allocated words  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170, 172, 179  
Changing the system settings etc. . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Character specify size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222  
Character string . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
ꢄꢊꢊ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Creating screen data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
Flash memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
Flash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135, 140  
Flashing display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121, 129  
Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
D
DIP switch settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
DIP switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28, 40  
Data memory (DM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
Decimal fraction parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148  
Description of parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
G
Graph frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Grounding terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
Guide display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Determine the upgraded numeral memory table  
number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
Determining touch switch status . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Direct connection data setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117  
Direct connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13, 115  
Direct information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
Display elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Display frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141  
Display history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110  
Display mode control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217  
Display specified screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208  
Draw circle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227  
Draw polyline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226  
H
Host I/F tool connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Host link method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31  
Host link unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33, 34  
Host link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13, 85  
I
I/O check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101  
IP65 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Image data memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
Initialization by using the DIP switch  
(Forced initialization) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
E
Initialization by using the system menu . . . . . . . . 73  
Initialization error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
ERR ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96  
Edit screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117  
End flashing display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225  
End inverse display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Enlarged display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121  
Equivalent to IP65 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Error message during the start-up . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
Initialization of the display history data  
memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76  
Initialization setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162, 167  
Initialize display history . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
Initializing memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
Initializing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
Integer parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148  
Intermittent buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Intermittent sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95, 126  
Internal processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282  
F
Factory setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
File units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79  
ꢅꢋꢋ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Normal display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Normal screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
Nothing is displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242  
Notification and control of touch switches . . . . . 205  
Notification of numbers to the PC . . . . . . . . . . . . 189  
Notify bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
Notifying the NT600S status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Notifying the PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185  
Notifying the display elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Notifying the display screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162  
Number of registration words . . . . . . . . . . 164, 166  
Numeral memory table . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 129, 169  
Numeral setting attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126, 144  
Numeral setting strobe flag . . . . . . . . . . . . 190, 198  
Numeral setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125, 143  
Numeric keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144  
Numeric values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
K
Key press sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93  
L
LCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
LSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 40, 41, 44  
Lamp and touch switch display status  
enquiry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213  
Lamp and touch switch display status  
response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219  
Lamp and touch switch display . . . . . . . . . 212, 213  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8, 16, 135  
Lid of CFL case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Lit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135, 140  
M
Maintenance mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Making the cable for connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266  
Mark data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
Marks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 120, 128  
O
100% value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Operating panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 27  
Operating status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2, 198  
Operation commands . . . . . . . . . 19, 207, 208, 218  
Operation modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Operation will be automatically reset . . . . . . . . . . 89  
Operations with the system menu . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Overlapping screen . . . . . . . . . . 124, 146, 161, 163  
Memory initialization by using the DIP  
switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
Memory initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
Memory size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
Memory switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
Menu tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Momentary (touch switch) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186  
Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
P
N
PC memory map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293  
PC system setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 40, 41, 45  
PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31  
% display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
POWER LED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242  
9-pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
NT link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13, 14, 43, 85  
NT600S cannot be normally started . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
NT600S . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
ꢅꢋꢃ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
PT battery status response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
PT operating status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
PT status control area . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 156, 192  
PT status enquiry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
PT status notify area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 158  
PT status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197  
PT type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
PT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Page number display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125  
Parent screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124, 125  
Percentage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Peripheral tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 40, 41, 45  
Power input terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25, 28  
Press . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
Production line status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Programmable terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2  
Screen data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 244  
Screen display control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208  
Screen display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194  
Screen list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116  
Screen number 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119, 242  
Screen number 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92  
Screen number response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218  
Screen number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Screen switch setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160  
Screen switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Screen switching strobe . . . . . . . . . . . 161, 162, 198  
Screen switching timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161  
Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Selecting communication speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86  
Selecting the host communication method . . . . . 85  
Selecting the menu items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
Set a screen number for a touch switch . . . . . . 142  
Set a system key function for a touch  
R
switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
RS-232C cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30  
RUN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68, 102  
Reflection-suppressing protective sheet . . . . . . 290  
Replaceable backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290  
Replacing the backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248  
Request screen number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209  
Reset switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
Reverse and flashing display . . . . . . . . . . . 121, 129  
Reverse display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121, 129, 135  
Set cursor position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225  
Set flashing display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Set inverse display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
Setting error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244  
Setting status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Setting the buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94  
Setting the support tool mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99  
Setting the support tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Setting the words for the character-string memory  
tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166  
Setting the words for the numeral memory tables  
number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167  
S
Screen attributes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
Screen data displayed on the NT600S . . . . . . . . . 9  
Screen data memory is initialized . . . . . . . . . 73, 74  
Set (touch switch) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186  
Sign display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132  
Smoothing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121, 129  
ꢅꢋꢄ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Solderless terminal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29  
Specify character enlargement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223  
Specify displayed characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226  
Standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Start-up screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
Start-up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
Statuses of touch switches are changed . . . . . . 185  
Stop the buzzer sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94, 102  
Support tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3, 30, 79, 115  
Transmit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68, 79  
Transmitting screen data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79, 118  
Turn ON the power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
25-pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32  
U
Unlit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135  
Upgrading bar graphs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179  
Use touch switches for notification to the  
PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183  
Switch predetermined values or character-strings  
according to the situation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175  
User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144  
W
Switching the continuous screens . . . . . . . . . . . . 126  
Switching the screen display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160  
Switching to the RUN mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92  
System key functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
System menu display permission . . . . . . . . . . . . 216  
System menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127  
Warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195  
Waterproofed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267  
Write character-string memory table . . . . . . . . . 209  
Write numeral memory table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210  
X
XON/XOFF control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63, 89  
T
Table of commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207  
Terminal commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19, 207, 222  
3-D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
Thumb-wheel numeral settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148  
Tool settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Tool transmit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
Touch switch bit output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220  
Touch switch disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Touch switch enable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214  
Touch switch number output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221  
Z
Zero suppress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130  
Touch switches used to call the system  
menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Touch switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 17, 70, 139  
Transmit mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71, 80  
ꢅꢋꢅ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢅꢋꢆ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Revision History  
NT-series  
Programmable Terminal  
Operation Manual  
A manual revision code appears as a suffix to the catalog number on the front cover of the manual.  
Cat. No. V022-E3-1  
Revision code  
The following table outlines the changes made to the manual during each revision. Page numbers refer to the  
previous version.  
Revision code  
E1-1  
Date  
Revised content  
5--1995  
9--1995  
Original production  
E1-2  
Additions relating to numeral input (numeral input using thumb wheel keys).  
Additions relating to operation for notification to the PC using touch switches (alternate/  
set/reset).  
Additions relating to additional functions when performing numeral input (upper/lower  
limit check, hexadecimal input).  
Additions relating to additional communication method (C200H direct communication).  
E1-3  
E3-1  
5--1997  
7--97  
Amendments relating to addition of the NT link (1:N) method communication function.  
Amendments relating to additions to safety notices and correction of errata.  
Amendments relating to addition of the Mitsubishi A computer link communication func-  
tion, addition of an applicable PC (CPM1), additional explanations and correction of  
errata.  
Some reformat required for printing. Cable wiring drawings corrected in Sec 2-6, pages 51  
and 52.  
ꢅꢋꢇ  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Miele Cooktop DA 289 4 User Manual
Milan Technology Switch MIL S8001TG User Manual
Nexstar Digital Photo Frame N3 511 User Manual
Novatel TV Antenna 42GOXX16A4 XT 1 1 User Manual
Olympus MP3 Player DM 1 User Manual
Oregon Clock Radio JM888 User Manual
Oregon Scientific Thermometer SL101 User Manual
Palm Network Card ETHERNET HUB User Manual
Panasonic Fax Machine KX PW507DL User Manual
Panasonic IP Phone KX NT300 User Manual